Columbia Driver's Manual PDF

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 180

COLUMBIA

Drivers Manual
STI-405-2
A24-01034-000
Foreword

Introduction dination, or Fleetpack assistance. Our people are


knowledgeable, professional, and committed to fol-
This manual provides information needed to operate lowing through to help you keep your truck moving.
and understand the vehicle and its components.
More detailed information is contained in the Owners
Warranty Information for North America booklet, and
Reporting Safety Defects
in the vehicles workshop and maintenance manuals. If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which
could cause a crash or could cause injury or
Custom-built Freightliner vehicles are equipped with
death, you should immediately inform the National
various chassis and cab components. Not all of the
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in
information contained in this manual applies to every
vehicle. For details about components in your ve- addition to notifying Daimler Trucks North America
hicle, refer to the chassis specification pages in- LLC.
cluded in all new vehicles and to the vehicle specifi- If the NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may
cation decal, located inside the vehicle. open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety
For your reference, keep this manual in the vehicle defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a
at all times. recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA
cannot become involved in individual problems
IMPORTANT: Descriptions and specifications in this between you, your dealer, or Daimler Trucks North
manual were in effect at the time of printing. Freight-
America LLC.
liner Trucks reserves the right to discontinue models
and to change specifications or design at any time To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle
without notice and without incurring obligation. De- Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY:
scriptions and specifications contained in this publi- 1-800-424-9153); go to www.safercar.gov; or
cation provide no warranty, expressed or implied, write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey
and are subject to revisions and editions without no- Avenue, SE, Washington, DC 20590. You can also
tice. obtain other information about motor vehicle safety
from www.safercar.gov.
Environmental Concerns and
Canadian customers who wish to report a safety-
Recommendations related defect to Transport Canada, Defect Investi-
Whenever you see instructions in this manual to dis- gations and Recalls, may telephone the toll-free
card materials, you should first attempt to reclaim hotline 1-800-333-0510, or contact Transport
and recycle them. To preserve our environment, fol- Canada by mail at: Transport Canada, ASFAD,
low appropriate environmental rules and regulations Place de Ville Tower C, 330 Sparks Street,
when disposing of materials. Ottawa, Ontario, Canada K1A 0N5.
For additional road safety information, please visit
Event Data Recorder the Road Safety website at: www.tc.gc.ca/
roadsafety.
This vehicle is equipped with one or more devices
that record specific vehicle data. The type and
amount of data recorded varies depending on how
the vehicle is equipped (such as the brand of engine,
if an air bag is installed, or if the vehicle features a
collision avoidance system, etc.).

Customer Assistance Center


Having trouble finding service? Call the Customer
Assistance Center at 1-800-385-4357 or 1-800-FTL-
HELP. Call night or day, weekdays or weekends, for
dealer referral, vehicle information, breakdown coor-

STI-405-2 (12/12)
A24-01034-000
Printed in U.S.A.
Foreword

20012012 Daimler Trucks North America LLC. All rights reserved. Daimler Trucks North America LLC is a Daimler
company.
No part of this publication, in whole or part, may be translated, reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted
in any form by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or otherwise, without the prior written per-
mission of Daimler Trucks North America LLC. For additional information, please contact Daimler Trucks North
America LLC, Service Systems and Documentation, P.O. Box 3849, Portland OR 972083849 U.S.A. or refer to
www.Daimler-TrucksNorthAmerica.comand www.FreightlinerTrucks.com.
Contents
Chapter Page
Introduction, Environmental Concerns and Recommendations,
Event Data Recorder, Customer Assistance Center, Reporting
Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Foreword
1 Vehicle Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1
2 Instruments and Controls Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.1
3 Vehicle Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1
4 Heater and Air Conditioner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1
5 Seats and Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1
6 Steering and Brake Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1
7 Engines and Clutches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.1
8 Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.1
9 Rear Axles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.1
10 Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.1
11 Pretrip and Post-Trip Inspections and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.1
12 Cab Appearance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.1
13 In an Emergency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.1
14 Headlight Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.1
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I.1
1
Vehicle Identification
Vehicle Specification Decal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1
Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard (FMVSS) Labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1
Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard (CMVSS) Labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
Tire and Rim Labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
EPA Emission Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
Vehicle Identification

Vehicle Specification Decal 1 2 3


The vehicle specification decal lists the vehicle
model, identification number, and major component
models. It also recaps the major assemblies and in-
stallations shown on the chassis specification sheet.
11/21/96 f080053
One copy of the specification decal is attached to the
inside of the sliding storage/waste drawer; another 1. Date of Manufacture: by month and year
copy is inside the rear cover of the Owners Warranty 2. Gross Vehicle Weight Rating: developed by taking
the sum of all the vehicles gross axle ratings
Information for North America booklet. An illustration
3. Gross Axle Weight Ratings: developed by
of the decal is shown in Fig. 1.1. considering each component in an axle system -
including suspension, axle, wheels, and tires - and
using the lowest component capacity as the value
COMPONENT INFORMATION for the system
MANUFACTURED BY USE VEHICLE ID NO.
WHEN ORDERING PARTS Fig. 1.2, Certification Label, U.S.
MODEL
VEHICLE ID NO.
WHEELBASE
DATE OF MFR ENGINE NO.
ENGINE MODEL TRANS NO.
TRANS MODEL MAIN FRT AXLE NO.
FRONT AXLE MODEL REAR AXLE NO.
REAR AXLE MODEL REAR AXLE NO.
RATIO
IMRON PAINTCAB
PAINT MFR CAB COLOR A: WHITE (4775) FOR COMPLETE PAINT INFORMATION
PAINT NO. CAB COLOR B: BROWN (3295) SEE VEHICLE SPECIFICATION SHEET
CAB COLOR C: BROWN (29607) 1
CAB COLOR D: DARK BROWN (7444)
PART NO. 2400273010

11/21/96 f080021

Fig. 1.1, Vehicle Specification Decal (U.S.-built vehicle


shown)

NOTE: Labels shown in this chapter are ex-


amples only. Actual specifications may vary from
vehicle to vehicle. 2

Federal Motor Vehicle Safety


Standard (FMVSS) Labels
NOTE: Due to the variety of FMVSS certification
requirements, not all of the labels shown will
apply to your vehicle. 11/01/95 f601086

Tractors with or without fifth wheels purchased in the 1. Tire and Rim Labels 2. Certification Label
U.S. are certified by means of a certification label Fig. 1.3, Labels Location
(Fig. 1.2) and the tire and rim labels. These labels
are attached to the left rear door post, as shown in
Fig. 1.3.
If purchased for service in the U.S., trucks built with-
out a cargo body have a certification label (Fig. 1.4) 09/28/98 f080023
attached to the left rear door post. See Fig. 1.3. In
addition, after completion of the vehicle, a certifica- Fig. 1.4, Incomplete Vehicle Certification Label, U.S.
tion label similar to that shown in Fig. 1.2 must be
attached by the final-stage manufacturer. This label that the vehicle conforms to all applicable FMVSS
will be located on the left rear door post and certifies regulations in effect on the date of completion.

1.1
Vehicle Identification

Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Tire and Rim Labels


Standard (CMVSS) Labels Tire and rim labels certify suitable tire and rim combi-
nations that can be installed on the vehicle, for the
In Canada, tractors with fifth wheels are certified by given gross axle weight rating. Tires and rims in-
means of a "Statement of Compliance" label and the stalled on the vehicle at the time of manufacture may
Canadian National Safety Mark (Fig. 1.5), which are have a higher load capacity than that certified by the
attached to the left rear door post. In addition, tire tire and rim label. If the tires and rims currently on
and rim labels (Fig. 1.6) are also attached to the left the vehicle have a lower load capacity than that
rear door post. shown on the tire and rim label, then the tires and
rims determine the load limitations on each of the
axles.
See Fig. 1.6 for U.S. and Canadian tire and rim la-
bels.

EPA Emission Control


Vehicle Noise Emission Control Label
10/10/2006 f080024
A vehicle noise emission control label (Fig. 1.7) is
attached either to the left side of the dashboard or to
Fig. 1.5, Canadian National Safety Mark
the top-right surface of the frontwall between the
dash and the windshield.
1 2 3
GAWR TIRES RIMS PSI COLD
VEHICLE NOISE EMISSION CONTROL INFORMATION
DATE OF MANUFACTURE 01/96
VEHICLE ID NO. FRONT AXLE
DATE OF MFR FIRST INTERMEDIATE AXLE FREIGHTLINER CORPORATION
GVWR SECOND INTERMEDIATE AXLE THIS VEHICLE CONFORMS TO U.S. EPA REGULATIONS FOR NOISE EMISSION
THIRD INTERMEDIATE AXLE
REAR AXLE
APPLICABLE TO MEDIUM AND HEAVY TRUCKS.
THE FOLLOWING ACTS OR THE CAUSING THEREOF BY ANY PERSON ARE PROHIBITED BY
TIRES AND RIMS LISTED ARE NOT NECESSARILY THOSE INSTALLED ON THE VEHICLE. 2400273040
THE NOISE CONTROL ACT OF 1972:
A. THE REMOVAL OR RENDERING INOPERATIVE, OTHER THAN FOR PURPOSES OF
MAINTENANCE, REPAIR, OR REPLACEMENT, OF ANY NOISE CONTROL DEVICE OR
ELEMENT OF DESIGN (LISTED IN THE OWNERS MANUAL) INCORPORATED INTO THIS
10/31/95 f080054 VEHICLE IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE NOISE CONTROL ACT.
B. THE USE THIS VEHICLE AFTER SUCH DEVICE OR ELEMENT OF DESIGN HAS
BEEN REMOVED OR RENDERED INOPERATIVE. 2400273020

1. Date of Manufacture: by month and year


10/06/98 f080026
2. Gross Vehicle Weight Rating: developed by taking
the sum of all the vehicles gross axle ratings
3. Gross Axle Weight Ratings: developed by Fig. 1.7, Vehicle Noise Emission Control Label
considering each component in an axle system
including suspension, axle, wheels, and tires and IMPORTANT: Certain Freightliner incomplete
using the lowest component capacity as the value vehicles may be produced with incomplete noise
for the system control hardware. Such vehicles will not have a
Fig. 1.6, Tire and Rim Label
vehicle noise emission control information label.
For such vehicles, it is the final-stage manufac-
If purchased for service in Canada, trucks built with- turers responsibility to complete the vehicle in
out a cargo body and tractors built without a fifth conformity to U.S. EPA regulations (40 CFR Part
wheel are certified by a "Statement of Compliance" 205) and label it for compliance.
label, similar to Fig. 1.2. This label must be attached
by the final-stage manufacturer after completion of EPA07 Exhaust Emissions
the vehicle. The label is located on the left rear door
post, and certifies that the vehicle conforms to all To meet January 2007 emissions regulations, ve-
applicable CMVSS regulations in effect on the date hicles with engines manufactured after January 1,
of completion. 2007, are equipped with an emission aftertreatment
device. There is a warning label on the drivers sun-
visor, explaining important new warning indicators in
the drivers message display, that pertain to the after-
treatment system. See Fig. 1.8.

1.2
Vehicle Identification

EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM INFORMATION


INDICATOR WARNING
CHECK CHECK STOP
LAMP(S)
(Solid) (Flashing) (Flashing) (Flashing)
Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Level 4
Indicator Lamp Filter Regeneration Filter Regeneration Parked Regeneration Parked Regeneration Required HEST (High Exhaust
Message(s) Recommended Necessary Required Engine Engine Shut Down System Temperature)
Derate
Diesel Particulate Filter is reaching Filter is now Filter has reached Filter has exceeded Flashing
Filter Condition capacity. reaching maximum maximum capacity. maximum capacity. A regeneration is in
Switch.
capacity. progress.
Required Action Bring vehicle to To avoid engine Vehicle must be Vehicle must be parked and a
highway speeds to derate bring vehicle parked and a Parked Parked Regeneration or Service Solid
allow for an Automatic to highway speeds Regeneration must Regeneration must be performed. Exhaust Components
Regeneration or to allow for an be performed Check engine operators manual and exhaust gas are
perform a Parked Automatic engine will begin for details engine will shut down. at high temperature.
Regeneration. Regeneration or derate. When stationary, keep
perform a Parked away from people and
Regeneration as flammable materials
soon as possible. or vapors.

For a driver performed Parked Regeneration, vehicle must be equipped with a dash mounted Regeneration Switch.

See Engine Operators Manual for complete Regeneration Instructions.


2401583000B

06/29/2009 f080147

Fig. 1.8, Sunvisor Warning Label

It is a violation of federal law to alter exhaust plumb-


ing or aftertreatment in any way that would bring the
engine out of compliance with certification require-
ments. (Ref: 42 U.S.C. S7522(a) (3).) It is the own-
ers responsibility to maintain the vehicle so that it
conforms to EPA regulations.

1.3
2
Instruments and Controls
Identification
Instrumentation Control Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.1
Warning and Indicator Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3
Driver Message Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.7
Instruments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.17
Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.21
Roll Stability Advisor and Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.28
Instruments and Controls Identification

Instrumentation Control Units "Instruments"

The instrumentation control unit (ICU) provides the Ignition Sequence


driver with engine and vehicle information. It is com-
prised of standard and optional gauges, an audible When the ignition is turned on, the ICU runs a self-
warning, a driver message center, and a lightbar con- check. Observing the ignition sequence is a good
taining warning and indicator lamps (also known as way to ensure the ICU is functioning properly.
telltales). Warning and indicator lamps illuminate in IMPORTANT: Do not crank the engine until the
red (danger), amber (caution), green (status advi- ICU gauge sweep is complete.
sory), or blue (high-beam headlights activated).
NOTE: Air gauges do not complete a sweep of
Columbia vehicles are equipped with either an ICU3
(Fig. 2.1), ICU4 (Fig. 2.2), or ICU4M (Fig. 2.3).
their dials during the ignition sequence.
When the ignition is turned on, the following actions
The following headings in this chapter provide addi-
should occur:
tional information and operating instructions for ICU
components: electronic gauges complete a full sweep of
their dials
"Warning and Indicator Lights"
"Driver Message Center"

1 2 3 4 5

OPT OPT OPT OPT OPT OPT OPT OPT OPT


50 1/2
CHECK STOP ABS ABS

PSI
BRAKE
0 100 E F
OIL FUEL

150 200
20 25 45 50 100
6
F
15 35 55 PSI
70
100 250
30 25 50
90
65 0 150
WATER
10 30
110 AIR
PUSH
MODE
7
15 75 HOLD
RESET

225 130
12 5 10 50 100
8
F 5 85 PSI

0 RPM km/h
100 350
X100 MPH 0 150
TRANS AIR

10/26/2006 11 10 9 f610837b
1. Engine Oil Pressure Gauge 6. Primary Air Pressure Gauge 10. Tachometer
2. Dash Message Center 7. Mode/Reset Switch 11. Tranismission Fluid Temperature
3. Headlight High-Beam Indicator 8. Secondary Air Pressure Gauge Gauge
4. Dash Message Center 9. Speedometer 12. Coolant Temperature Gauge
5. Fuel Level Gauge
Fig. 2.1, ICU3 Instrument Cluster

2.1
Instruments and Controls Identification

40 60 100 60 100
150 200
PSI F PSI P PSI S

0
OIL
100 100
WATER
250
7 8 0
AIR
160 0
AIR
160

1 2 11 12
15 45 55
200 12 35 1/2 200
10 RPM 20
F X 100 25 50
70
90 65 F

100 300 8 16 E F 100 300


110 FUEL AXLE
OIL VOLTS 30
5 25 15 75
3 4 10
130
13 14
5 85
0 30 200
90 40
MPH km/h 190 270
F F
F PSI
10
110 350 100
30
PYRO
150 0
TURBO
80
9 10 TRANS AXLE
300

5 6 15 16

04/01/2004 f610706
1. Engine Oil Pressure Gauge 6. Turbo Boost Air Pressure Gauge 12. Secondary Air Pressure Gauge
2. Engine Coolant Temperature 7. Dash Message Center 13. Fuel Level Gauge
Gauge 8. Mode/Reset Switch 14. Axle Temperature Gauge
3. Engine Oil Temperature Gauge 9. Tachometer 15. Transmission Oil Temperature
4. Battery Voltage Gauge 10. Speedometer Gauge
5. Pyrometer 11. Primary Air Pressure Gauge 16. Axle Temperature Gauge

Fig. 2.2, ICU4 Instrument Cluster

some warning and indicator lamps illuminate, If the ICU receives active fault codes, it displays
then are extinguished them one after the other until the parking brake is
released or the ignition is turned off. Once the park-
audible alert sounds until sufficient air pressure
ing brake is completely released, the ICU displays
builds up in the primary and secondary air sys-
the odometer. If there are no active faults, the ICU
tems
displays the odometer after the self-check completes.
software revision level of the ICU is displayed When the self-check is complete on an ICU4M, the
on the driver message center, followed by any fasten seat belt screen displays if the engine is off. If
active faults the engine is running, the idle hours screen displays.
IMPORTANT: If any red or amber warning or
indicator lamps do not illuminate during the ICU Audible Alerts
self-check or do not extinguish after the self- An audible alert sounds during the ignition sequence
check completes, take the action outlined in and whenever one of the following conditions exists:
Table 2.1, or take the vehicle to an authorized Engine oil pressure falls below the minimum
Daimler Trucks service facility as soon as pos- preset value.
sible.
Coolant temperature rises above the maximum
NOTE: If active faults are present, take the ve- preset value.
hicle to an authorized Daimler Trucks service
Air pressure falls below approximately 70 psi
facility as soon as possible.
(483 kPa).

2.2
Instruments and Controls Identification

8 8
7
OPT OPT OPT OPT OPT OPT OPT OPT
40 60 100 60 100
150 200
CHECK STOP
FASTEN SEATBELTS ABS ABS
OPT
PSI F 0000432 MILES IDLE PSI P PSI S

100 250 !
0 100 0 160 0 160
BRAKE
OIL WATER AIR AIR

1 2 11 12
15 45 55
200 12 35 1/2
10 RPM 20 190 270

F X 100 25 50
70
90 65 F

100 8 E F 110 350


300 16 110 FUEL TRANS
OIL VOLTS 30
5 25 15 75
3 4 10
130
13 14
5 85
0 30 200 200
40 90 MPH km/h
F F
PSI F
10
100 100
0
TURBO
80 30
PYRO
150
9 10 AXLE
300
AXLE
300

5 6 15 16

09/29/2010 f610706b
1. Engine Oil Pressure Gauge 7. Dash Message Center 14. Transmission Fluid Temperature
2. Engine Coolant Temperature 8. Warning and Indicator Lights Gauge
Gauge 9. Tachometer 15. Forward Drive Axle Temperature
3. Engine Oil Temperature Gauge 10. Speedometer Gauge
4. Battery Voltage Gauge 11. Primary Air Pressure Gauge 16. Rearmost Drive Axle Temperature
5. Turbo Boost Air Pressure Gauge 12. Secondary Air Pressure Gauge Gauge
6. Pyrometer 13. Fuel Level Gauge
Fig. 2.3, ICU4M Instrument Cluster

Parking brake is set with the vehicle moving IMPORTANT: Depending upon local jurisdic-
faster than two miles per hour. tional emissions guidelines, vehicles may not be
System voltage falls below 12 equipped with all of the lamps shown in
Table 2.1.
volts.
Door is open or the headlights are on, with the Engine Protection System
parking brake off.
WARNING
Warning and Indicator Lights
When the red STOP engine lamp illuminates,
The ICU lightbar has three or four rows of warning most engines are programmed to shut down au-
and indicator lights with icon symbols, depending on tomatically within 30 seconds. The driver must
the ICU. The positions of the lights may vary for the immediately move the vehicle to a safe location
different ICUs, but the telltales are standard for all at the side of the road to prevent causing a haz-
applications. See Table 2.1 for a listing of standard ardous situation that could cause bodily injury,
and commonly used warning and indicator lamps. property damage, or severe damage to the en-
Warning and indicator lamps illuminate in red (dan- gine.
ger), amber (caution), green (status advisory), or See Fig. 2.4 for an explanation of the aftertreatment
blue (high-beam headlights active). system (ATS) warning indicators, and actions re-
quired to avoid further engine protection steps.

2.3
Instruments and Controls Identification

The STOP engine lamp illuminates when the engine gine as soon as the red light is seen. If the en-
protection system is activated in one of two ways. On gine shuts down while the vehicle is in a haz-
some engines, the engine protection system derates ardous location, turn the key to the OFF position
the engine, allowing it to run at lower rpm and slower for a few seconds, then restart the engine and
vehicle speed. Drive the vehicle to a safe location or move the vehicle to a safer location.
to a service facility.
IMPORTANT: Safely bring the vehicle to a stop
on the side of the road and shut down the en-

Common Warning and Indicator Lamps


Lamp Description Color
Indicates a serious fault that requires engine shutdown
immediately. The engine protection system reduces the
maximum engine torque and speed, and, if the condition
does not improve, shuts down the engine within 30 to 60
seconds.
STOP STOP Engine * Safely bring the vehicle to a stop on the side of the road
and shut down the engine as soon as the red light is seen.
IMPORTANT: If the engine shuts down while the vehicle
is in a hazardous location, turn the key to the OFF
position for a few seconds, then restart the engine and
move the vehicle to a safer location.

Indicates the coolant temperature is above the maximum


High Coolant Temperature
allowable temperature.

Indicates air pressure in the primary or secondary reservoir


Low Air Pressure Red
is below 70 psi (483 kPa).

Indicates the engine oil pressure is below the minimum


Low Engine Oil Pressure
allowable pressure.

Indicates the parking brake is engaged. An audible alert


Parking Brake activates when the vehicle is moving over 2 mph (3 km/h)
BRAKE
with the parking brake set.

Low Battery Voltage Indicates that battery voltage is 11.9 volts or less.

Activates with an audible alert when the system detects that


the parking brake is off and the driver seat belt is not
Unfastened Seat Belt fastened on some vehicles. On other vehicles, this lamp
illuminates for 15 seconds when the ignition is first turned
on.
Indicates an engine condition (low oil pressure, low coolant
level, high coolant temperature, high DPF soot level, or
CHECK CHECK Engine * uncontrolled DPF regeneration) that requires correction. Amber
Correct the condition as soon as possible. If the condition
worsens, the STOP engine lamp illuminates.

2.4
Instruments and Controls Identification

Common Warning and Indicator Lamps


Lamp Description Color
Slow (10-second) flashing indicates a regeneration (regen)
is in progress.
High Exhaust System IMPORTANT: When the HEST lamp is illuminated, do
Temperature (HEST) * not park the vehicle near flammable material.
Solid illumination indicates high exhaust temperatures at the
outlet of the tail pipe when speed is below 5 mph (8 km/h).
Solid illumination indicates a regen is required. Change to a
more challenging duty cycle (such as highway driving) to
Diesel Particulate Filter raise exhaust temperatures for at least twenty minutes, or
(DPF) Status perform a parked regen.
Blinking indicates that a parked regen is required
immediately. An engine derate and shutdown occurs.

Malfunction Indicator Indicates an emissions-related fault. See the engine


Lamp (MIL) operation manual for details.

Momentary illumination indicates the vehicle ABS is


engaged.
Vehicle ABS Solid illumination indicates a problem with the vehicle ABS.
Repair the ABS immediately to ensure full braking
capability.
Momentary illumination indicates the trailer ABS is engaged.

Trailer ABS Solid illumination indicates a problem with the trailer ABS.
Amber
Repair the ABS immediately to ensure full braking
capability.

NO Indicates the alternator is not properly powering the


CHARGE No Charge
electrical system.

Indicates the fuel may contain water. Drain any water


Water in Fuel
collected in the fuel/water separators.

Fuel Filter Restriction Indicates the fuel filter is clogged and requires service.

Check Transmission Indicates an undesirable transmission condition.

Transmission Overheat Indicates high transmission temperature.

Flashing indicates the ATC system is active, or the ATC


button has been pressed to allow wheel slip.
WHEEL
SPIN Wheel Spin Solid illumination indicates a problem with the ATC system.
Repair the ATC system immediately to ensure full braking
capability.

2.5
Instruments and Controls Identification

Common Warning and Indicator Lamps


Lamp Description Color

Engine Brake Indicates the engine brake is enabled.

Flashing indicates the outside left-turn signal lights are


Left-Turn Signal Green
activated.

Flashing indicates the outside right-turn signal lights are


Right-Turn Signal
activated.

High-Beam Headlights Indicates the high-beam headlights are on. Blue

* See Fig. 2.4 for an explanation of the aftertreatment system (ATS) warning indicators, and actions required to avoid further engine protection steps.

Table 2.1, Common Warning and Indicator Lamps

EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM INFORMATION


INDICATOR WARNING
CHECK STOP
LAMP(S)
(Solid) (Flashing) (Flashing)
Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Level 4
Indicator Lamp Filter Regeneration Filter Parked Regeneration Service Regeneration Required. HEST (High Exhaust
Message(s) Recommended. Regeneration Required Engine Engine Derate To Idle Only. System Temperature)
Necessary Derate
Diesel Particulate Filter is reaching Filter is now Filter has reached Filter has exceeded maximum Flashing
Filter Condition capacity. reaching maximum maximum capacity. capacity. A regeneration is in
Switch.
capacity. progress.
Required Action Bring vehicle to To avoid engine Vehicle must be Vehicle must be parked, and a
highway speeds to derate, bring vehicle parked, and a Parked Service Regeneration must be Solid
allow for an to highway speeds Regeneration must performed. Check engine Exhaust components
Automatic to allow for an be performed. operators manual for details. and exhaust gas are at
Regeneration or Automatic Engine will begin Engine will shut down. high temperature. When
perform a Parked Regeneration, or derate. stationary, keep away
Regeneration. perform a Parked from people and
Regeneration as flammable materials or
soon as possible. vapors.

For a driver performed Parked Regeneration, vehicle must be equipped with a dash mounted Regeneration Switch.

02/20/2009 f080156

Fig. 2.4, ATS Warning Lamps

On other engines, the engine protection system Some vehicles may have a shutdown-override
shuts down the engine. It first derates the engine, switch, which may be used to momentarily override
then shuts it down completely 30 to 60 seconds after the shutdown sequence. See Chapter 7 for detailed
the indicator illuminates (depending on the critical information regarding the shutdown process.
fault type) if the condition does not improve. Bring
the vehicle to a stop on the side of the road before
the engine shuts down.

2.6
Instruments and Controls Identification

IMPORTANT: Do not attempt to restart the en- i. Odometer


gine while the vehicle is moving. Bring the ve- ii. Trip distance
hicle to a safe stop, then restart the engine.
iii. Trip hours
To restart the engine, turn the ignition switch to OFF
for a few seconds, then turn the ignition switch to ON iv. Select units
and let the gauge sweep complete before starting the v. Diagnostics
engine. The engine will run for a short period and
shut down again if the condition does not improve. vi. Clear screen (on vehicles with less than 255
miles on the odometer)
Driver Message Center vii. Engine miles
The dash message centers for the following instru- viii. Engine hours
ment clusters are described below:
ix. Engine oil level
ICU3
x. Setup
ICU4
xi. Back to odometer
ICU4M
Trip Distance
ICU3 When the odometer reading is displayed, tap the
A mode/reset button, located on the right side of the mode/reset button once for trip distance. Press and
ICU instrument cluster, is used to control the driver hold the mode/reset button to reset trip miles to zero.
message center. See Fig. 2.1. Tap the mode/reset
button to advance one screen; press and hold the Trip Hours
button to select a menu choice or reset the display. When trip distance is displayed, tap the mode/reset
When the display resets, an audible chirp sounds. button once for trip hours. Press and hold the mode/
reset button to reset trip hours to zero.
Only four screens are accessible when the parking
brake is off (mobile screens). All screens are acces-
sible when the parking brake is on (stationary
Diagnostic Information
screens). When the DIAG screen is displayed, press and hold
the mode/reset button to access the various diagnos-
Mobile Screens tic screens.
The following screens are available when the parking Trained technicians use the diagnostic screens to
brake is off (when the vehicle is mobile) and no ac- retrieve fault codes and other diagnostic information
tive fault codes are found. Tap the mode/reset button pertaining to the vehicle. If active fault codes display
to scroll through the mobile screens. during start-up or at any other time, make a note of
the fault code and take the vehicle to an authorized
i. Odometer Freightliner service facility as soon as possible.
ii. Trip distance If fault codes are displayed, press and hold the
iii. Trip hours mode/reset button to view the next fault code until
reaching the DIAG screen.
iv. Back to odometer
If service intervals are enabled and service distance
Stationary Screens or time has been exceeded, the text SERVICE
HOUR/MI (KM) will display at start-up to indicate ve-
The following screens are available when the parking hicle service is required.
brake is on (when the vehicle is stationary) and no
active fault codes are found. Tap the mode/reset but- Engine Information
ton to scroll through the stationary screens. See
Fig. 2.5. When the DIAG screen is displayed, tap the mode/
reset button once to access the engine miles/hours

2.7
Instruments and Controls Identification

123456.7
Default Odometer CLEAr
MI Hold Clear Defaults
12.3 VOLTS Dispay Screen

Push Push

123456.7 123456.7
TRIP MI Hold MI To Dispay Total Engine Miles
To Reset Trip Miles
12.3 VOLTS EC EC = Engine Control

Push Push

123456.7 123456.7
TRIP HOURS Hold To Reset Trip Hours HOURS To Dispay Total Engine Hours
12.3 VOLTS EC EC = Engine Control

Push Push

SELECt To Toggle between Units EnG oIL


Hold Hold Dispay Oil Level
MI MI<>KM *Lo
*Lo = Oil Level Low
HI = Oil Level High
Push Push Blank = Oil Level OK
= No Message

dIAG SEtUP
MI HOURS Hold **MI **HOURS Hold Dispay Service Interval
Dispay Diagnostics
n **no Cycle Screens
n = Number of Active Fault Codes **MI = CYCLE Miles Active Mode
MI = CYCLE Miles Enabled **HOURS = CYCLE Hours Active Mode
Push HOURS = Cycle Hours Enabled Push **no = Service CYCLE Inactive

03/26/2004 f040636a

Note: The engine oil level screen displays for Mercedes-Benz engines only (if equipped and enabled).
Fig. 2.5, ICU3 Stationary Screens

screen. When the engine miles/hours screen is dis- ICU4


played, press and hold the mode/reset button to ac-
cess the engines screen sub-menu. Functions
The mode/reset button, located on the right side of
Setup Information the lightbar, controls the driver message center. See
The setup screen allows the driver to manage ICU Fig. 2.2. Press the mode/reset button to advance
parameters. When the engine hours/miles screen is one screen; hold the button down to select a menu
displayed, tap the mode/reset button to access the choice or reset the display. When the display is
setup screen. The setup screen submenu allows the reset, an audible chirp sounds.
driver to enable and change service intervals.
For each parameter, press and hold the mode/reset
Direct Access Screens
button to navigate to the parameter change screen. When the parking brake is not set, pressing the
In each change screen, tap the mode/reset button to mode/reset button will scroll through the direct ac-
toggle between options. cess screens.
When the setup screen is displayed again, tap the i. Trip distance
mode/reset button to view the odometer.
ii. Trip hours
iii. Outside temperature
iv. Back to odometer

2.8
Instruments and Controls Identification

Stationary Access Screens Trip Information


When the parking brake is set, pressing the mode/ Trip information allows you to view trip mileage and
reset button will scroll through the stationary access time.
screens. See Fig. 2.6.
When the odometer reading is displayed, press the
i. Odometer mode/reset button once for trip distance. Press the
mode/reset button a second time for trip hours (en-
ii. Trip distance gine hours).
iii. Trip hours
Press and hold the mode/reset button to reset trip
iv. Outside temperature miles or hours to zero.
v. Diagnostic screen Ambient Air Temperature
vi. Engine miles/hours/oil level When the ambient air temperature drops below 35F
vii. Setup screen (1.7C), the ICU displays a caution text at 1-second
intervals for five seconds and a chime sounds if the
viii. Back to odometer

Push

Go to the Diagnostic
Default Odometer and Engine Display
Hold
Display Screen Screens figure.

Push Push

Go to the Diagnostic
With park brake off

Hold To Reset Trip Miles Hold and Engine Display


Screens figure.

Push Push

Hold To Reset Trip Hours

Push Push Hold For setup screens.


With park brake on

If "SERVICE" is displayed Service Cycle screens are enabled and either "MI" or "HOURS" is also displayed.
On some vehicles "OIL LVL" appears in the top row of the display, if equipped and enabled.
02/06/2007 f040756

Fig. 2.6, ICU4 Stationary Access Screens

2.9
Instruments and Controls Identification

ambient temperature alarm is enabled. The driver To access the engine screens, press and hold the
can acknowledge the message by pressing the mode/reset button when the engine miles/hours
mode/reset button. The chime will not sound again screen is displayed.
unless the temperature cycles above 37F (4C) and
back below 35F (1.7C). Setup Screens
When the parking brake is set, the ambient air tem- The setup screens are used to manage ICU4 param-
perature display can be changed from F to C by eters. See Fig. 2.8.
changing the MI or KM selection in the SETUP
menus. The warning message can be disabled or To access the setup screens, press and hold the
enabled in the SETUP menus. mode/reset button when the SETUP screen is dis-
played.
Diagnostic Screens For each parameter, press and hold the mode/reset
The diagnostic screens are used by trained techni- button to navigate to the parameter change screen.
cians to retrieve fault codes and other diagnostic in- In each change screen, use the mode/reset button to
formation pertaining to the vehicle. Active faults are toggle between options.
current problems that require attention. If active fault The last screen in the setup menu, RESET EE, is for
codes display during start-up or at any other time, resetting certain parameters to the original settings.
make a note of the fault code and text message, Hold the mode/reset button to reset the antilock brak-
then call an authorized Freightliner service facility for ing system (ABS), SAMS roll call, automated trans-
assistance. mission display, transmission heartbeat, sensor fault
During vehicle start-up, with the parking brake set, codes, and engine oil level screens. Press the mode/
the ICU4 will display any active fault codes for three reset button to sequence back to the odometer.
seconds each until the parking brake is released. If
service cycle screens are enabled and service dis- ICU4M
tance or time has been exceeded, the text SERVICE Functions
HOUR/MI (KM) will be displayed to inform the driver
that the service interval has been exceeded and ve- A keypad located on the auxiliary dash panel controls
hicle service is required. See Fig. 2.7 for a diagram the ICU4M. See Fig. 2.9.
of the diagnostic and engine display screens. Main features of the ICU4M include:
To access the diagnostic screens, press and hold the Gauges that sweep 270 degrees and have
mode/reset button when the DIAG screen is pointers lit by an LED.
displayed.
Service intervals that are programmable via the
If the word SERVICE appears on the diagnostic mes- keypad.
sage display screen, service cycle screens are en-
abled. Either service miles or hours can be enabled, An audible warning and alert message to warn
but not both. Hold the mode/reset button to display the driver if the door is opened without first set-
miles or hours remaining until the next scheduled ting the parking brake.
service. If MI (KM) appears on the DIAG screen, ser- A flashing alert message that appears on the
vice miles are enabled; if HOURS appears on the driver message center in low engine oil pres-
screen, service hours are enabled. If service miles or sure or high coolant temperature conditions.
hours have been exceeded, the number flashes to
indicate service is overdue. With the parking brake off, only the odometer and
alert screens will display. Park the vehicle and set
Engine Screens the parking brake to access additional screens.
The engine screen displays total engine miles or The dash message center displays alert screens
hours. Press and hold the mode/reset button to dis- when certain conditions occur. They are warnings,
play total engine miles. Press and hold it a second cautions, or other messages that require the drivers
time to display total engine hours.

2.10
Instruments and Controls Identification

From Temperature Screen

n = Number of *If fault goes inactive, *If fault goes inactive,


Active Fault Codes display "noFault 1" display "noFault n"

dlAG *FAULT *FAULT


Press & Hold Press & Hold Press & Hold

n 01 nn

Tap Tap Tap

AbS 11 ECU 0
Press & Hold
To Engine
Miles/Hour

Tap Tap

123456 123456
Press & Hold

SPN SPN

Tap Tap

FAIL 03 FAIL 00
Press & Hold

Tap Tap
08/13/2012 f040802a

Fig. 2.7, ICU4 Diagnostic and Engine Display Screens

attention, but not all of them are critical to the opera- 6. turn signal on
tion of the vehicle. Warning messages always display
7. service warnings
at full brightness.
8. no datalink activity
More important messages take priority over less im-
portant messages. The order of priority is:
Alert Screens
1. parking brake set (with the vehicle moving)
NOTE: If there is more than one alert message
2. parking brake off (with the door open) to display, tap any key to access the next mes-
3. low oil pressure or high coolant temperature sage, and so on, until all the messages have
been viewed.
4. hard brake warnings (if equipped with roll stabil-
ity advisor)
5. low battery voltage

2.11
Instruments and Controls Identification

From Engine
Miles/Hours Screen

SET UP SELECT
Press & Hold *MI Press & Hold To toggle
MI KM

Tap Tap

To toggle
T WARN ON OFF
Press & Hold To toggle
*on ON OFF
LCD LMP
Tap Press & Hold
*on

Tap

Press & Hold to reset all


Service Interval counters
SET UP RESET SELECT
**MI **HOURS Press & Hold **MI **HOURS Press & Hold *MI *HOURS Press & Hold
**no SERVICE *no SERVICE *no SERVICE
To toggle
Tap Tap Tap MI
HOURS
no

*12345 *12345
Press & Hold MI MI Selection? HRS HOURS Press & Hold
SERVICE SERVICE

Tap Select NO Tap


to disable
no Service Intervals

RESET DONE
Press & Hold
EE
Tap Tap NOTE:
* Flash screen text
To Odometer
**Display active mode
01/30/2012 f040755

Fig. 2.8, ICU4 Setup Screens

Parking Brake On parking brake is released, or speed is reduced below


2 mph.
This warning message and an audible warning come
on whenever the parking brake is applied and the
vehicle is moving faster than 2 mph (3 km/h). The
screen and audible warning go away only when the

2.12
Instruments and Controls Identification

Automated Transmission Display


The ICU4M can display current gear information for
vehicles with an automated transmission. The last
three digits at the far right on the lower line of the
Dedicated Keys General Keys Control Keys driver display screen are reserved for this informa-
08/08/96 f601009 tion.
To reset a value, press the SET/RESET button twice. If there is a request to shift, an up or down arrow is
Fig. 2.9, ICU4M Keypad also displayed, depending on the shift direction.
On vehicles with conventional manual or automatic
Low Oil Pressure transmissions, the gear and shift direction are not
This warning message and an audible warning come displayed. For more information about specific
on whenever the oil pressure falls below the mini- models of automated transmissions, see Chapter 8.
mum oil pressure, whether the vehicle is idling or in
motion. Tap any key to dismiss the message. Mobile Screens
If the fault is still active 30 seconds after the mes- The following screens are available when the parking
sage is dismissed, the warning message will come brake is off (when the vehicle is mobile).
on again. i. Fasten seat belt (rpm<100)
High Coolant Temp ii. Fuel economy (rpm>100)
This message and an audible warning come on iii. Odometer
whenever the engine coolant temperature exceeds
the maximum allowable temperature. iv. Trip distance/hours

If the fault is still active 30 seconds after the mes- v. Trip advisory
sage is dismissed, the warning message will come vi. Leg distance/hours
on again.
vii. Leg advisory
Low Voltage viii. Outside air temperature
On some vehicles, this optional message and an au- ix. Fuel used/average MPG (KM/L)
dible warning come on whenever the ICU detects a
low voltage condition. Stationary Screens
Turn Signal On NOTE: Metric unit screens are similar. AMT=
This warning message and audible warning come on Current gear information for automated manual
whenever the turn signal remains on for four minutes transmissions.
or five miles of travel. The following screens are available when the parking
To dismiss this message, either turn off the turn sig- brake is on (when the vehicle is stationary).
nal or tap any key. i. Odometer
Service Warnings ii. Trip information including trip miles/hours, idle
Service warning screens display during the ignition hours, average speed, leg miles/hours
sequence and indicate that a service interval has iii. Fuel information including fuel used, fuel
been reached or exceeded and maintenance is re- economy, idle/PTO fuel usage
quired. The messages may indicate the number of
miles (KM) or hours until the next required service or, iv. Engine information including engine miles/hours,
once passed, the number of miles (KM) or hours ago engine/PTO gallons, oil level
that maintenance should have been performed. v. Diagnostic information

2.13
Instruments and Controls Identification

vi. Service information including mileage or time to Tap the arrow keys on the 10-key keypad to advance
next service through the screens. Press and hold the SET/RESET
key to reset any of the screens.
vii. Setup information
viii. Vehicle information including Datalink status, ICU Fuel Information
serial number, software version Fuel information allows you to view total fuel usage
ix. Fasten seat belt warning since the last reset, fuel mileage, and fuel consumed
while idling or running the PTO. See Fig. 2.11. Tap
Trip Information the arrow keys on the 10-key keypad to advance
through the screens. Press and hold the SET/RESET
When idle hours are displayed, tap the any key to key to reset any of the screens.
access the main trip information screen. See
Fig. 2.10.

FASTEN SEATBELTS
123456.7 MILES AMT

Engine Idling Press Right Arrow Key and Set the Parking Brake
(100 RPM or more)

IDLE HOURS 1234:56


12.3GAL123456.7MI AMT

TRIP TRIP MILES 123456.7 IDLE HOURS 1234:56 LEG MILES 123456.7
INFORMATION AMT TRIP HR 1234:56 AMT AVG MPH 12.3 AMT LEG HR 1234:56 AMT
R R R

12/01/2004 Go to Fuel Information Screens f040699

Fig. 2.10, ICU4M Trip Information Screens

Return to
Idle Hours From Trip
Screen Information

FUEL FUEL USED 12345.6 IDLE GALLONS 12.3


INFORMATION AMT AVG MPG 12.34 AMT PTO GAL 12345.6 AMT
R R

Go to Engine Information Screens


12/17/2004 f040700

Fig. 2.11, ICU4M Fuel Information Screens

2.14
Instruments and Controls Identification

Engine Information Setup Information


The engine information screens allow you to view See Fig. 2.15 and Fig. 2.16 for diagrams of the
engine mileage and hours, and total fuel consump- setup information screens.
tion. See Fig. 2.12. Tap the arrow keys on the 10-
Setup information allows you to program various fea-
key keypad to advance through the screens. Press
and hold the SET/RESET key to reset any of the tures of the ICU4M environment, including:
screens. A. Service intervals (OFF/MILES/HOURS);

Diagnostic Information B. Target MPG;

If active fault codes are displayed on the diagnostic C. LCD Lamp (ON/OFF);
information screensSee Fig. 2.13, make a note of D. Driver message center brightness;
the fault code and text message, then take the ve-
hicle to an authorized Freightliner service facility as E. Language (English/French/Spanish);
soon as possible. F. Units of measurement (English/Metric);
Service Information G. Driver select (ON/OFF)
Service information allows you to view the next re- H. Reset parameters to original settings.
curring service interval, expressed in either miles or
hours. See Fig. 2.14. Service intervals can also be Vehicle Information Screens
deactivated, so they do not display at all.
The vehicle information screens display hardware
For programming service intervals, see Setup Infor- and software information, including the Freightliner
mation, below. part number and switch ID of the ICU. See Fig. 2.17.
NOTE: If the vehicle has gone past the service
interval, the miles (km)/hours remaining
screen is replaced by the service was due
screen, followed by the number of miles(km)/
hours since the service was due.

Return to
Idle Hours From Fuel
Screen Information

ENGINE ENG MILES 123456.7 ENG GALLONS 123456.7 ENG OIL LEVEL
INFORMATION AMT ENG HOUR1234:78AMT PTO GAL 12345.6 AMT LO 1 QTS AMT

ENG OIL LEVEL


If Oil Level Low
LO 1 QTS AMT

ENG OIL LEVEL


Go to Diagnostic Information Screens If Oil Level OK
OK AMT

ENG OIL LEVEL


If Oil Level High
HI 1 QTS AMT
12/01/2004 f040701

Fig. 2.12, ICU4M Engine Information Screens

2.15
Instruments and Controls Identification

Return to
Idle Hours From Engine
Screen Information

Fault # 1 Fault # n
DIAGNOSTIC ACTIVE FAULTS MID(text) PID/SID(text) MID(text) PID/SID(text)
INFORMATION AMT 12 or NONE AMT FMI(text) MID#sPID#FMI#AMT FMI(text) MID#sPID#FMI#AMT

Hist Fault # 1 Hist Fault # n


12 HIST DASH FAULTS MID(text) PID/SID(text) MID(text) PID/SID(text)
LAST CLR 123456.7AMT FMI(text) MID#sPID#FMI#AMT FMI(text) MID#sPID#FMI#AMT

LAST OCCUR 123456.7 LAST OCCUR 123456.7


1234 TIMES AMT 1234 TIMES AMT

FIRST OCCUR 123456.7 FIRST OCCUR 123456.7


1234 TIMES AMT 1234 TIMES AMT

2 PUSH RESET TO
CLEAR DASH FAULTS AMT
R

ALL FAULTS
CLEARED AMT

12/17/2004 Go to Service Information Screens f040702

Fig. 2.13, ICU4M Diagnostic Information Screens

Return to
Idle Hours From Diagnostic
Screen Information

Distance prior to reaching the Distance traveled beyond the


set Service Interval set Service Interval
SERVICE INTERVAL IS SET TO 12345 MILES SERVICE WAS DUE
INFORMATION AMT XXXXX MILES AMT TO NEXT SERVICE AMT OR 12345 MILES AGO AMT
R R

Go to Setup Information Screens


Time prior to reaching the Time accumulated beyond the
set Service Interval set Service Interval
SERVICE INTERVAL IS SET TO 1234 HOURS SERVICE WAS DUE
INFORMATION AMT XXXX HOURS AMT TO NEXT SERVICE AMT OR 1234 HOURS AGO AMT
R R

Go to Setup Information Screens


12/17/2004 f040703

NOTE: Service information screens only appear if the service interval is set to MILES or HOURS in Setup Information.

Fig. 2.14, ICU4M Service Information Screens

2.16
Instruments and Controls Identification

PUSH SET KEY TO SERVICE INTERVAL


S
CHANGE SERVICE AMT OFF/ MILES/HOURS AMT
Return to
Idle Hours From Service
Screen Information If Service Interval is set to MILES
PUSH SET KEY TO INTERVAL XXXXX MILES
S
CHANGE SERVICE MI AMT <LESS MORE> AMT
SETUP
INFORMATION AMT

OR

SERVICE INTERVAL
S
OFF/ MILES /HOURS AMT

If Service Interval is set to HOURS

Go to Vehicle Information Screens PUSH SET KEY TO INTERVAL XXXX HOURS


S
CHANGE SERVICE HR AMT <LESS MORE> AMT

To more Setup Information


12/17/2004 f040704

Fig. 2.15, ICU4M Setup Information Screens (for service intervals)

Go to Setup Information Screens iary dash panel or right-hand control panel, are not
12.3
found on every vehicle. Instruments are listed here in
PUSH SET KEY TO TARGET MPG:
CHANGE TARGET MPG AMT
S <LESS MORE>AMT alphabetical order to make the information easier to
find.
PUSH SET KEY TO
CHANGE LCD LAMP AMT S <OFF
LCD LAMP
ON > AMT Air Intake Restriction Gauge
The air intake restriction gauge indicates the vacuum
PUSH SET KEY TO
S
DISPLAY BRIGHTNESS on the engine side of the air cleaner. See Fig. 2.18.
CHANGE BRIGHTNESS AMT <DARK LIGHT>AMT
On standard installations, it is mounted on the air
cleaner. As an option for easier viewing, an air intake
PUSH SET KEY TO
S
LANGUAGE: ENGLISH restriction indicator can be mounted on the auxiliary
CHANGE LANGUAGE AMT FRENCH/SPANISH AMT
dash panel.
NOTE: Rain or snow can wet the filter element
PUSH SET KEY TO
CHANGE UNITS AMT S
UNITS
ENGLISH / METRIC AMT and cause a temporary high reading.
Air intake restriction vacuum is measured in inches
PUSH SET KEY TO RESET PARAMETERS of water (inH 2O). For vehicles equipped with a
CHANGE PARAMETERS AMT S < YES NO> AMT
graduated indicator or a restriction gauge on the
dash, check the gauge with the engine off. If the yel-
Go to Vehicle Information Screens low signal stays locked in the red zone once the en-
12/17/2004 f040705 gine is shut down, or is at or above the values
shown in Table 2.2, the air cleaner element requires
Fig. 2.16, Other Setup Information
replacement.
Instruments Vehicles may be equipped with a go/no-go restriction
indicator without graduations (see Fig. 2.19) instead
Standard instruments are present on every vehicle. of a graduated indicator.
Optional instruments, typically located on the auxil-

2.17
Instruments and Controls Identification

Return to
Idle Hours From Setup
Screen Information

VEHICLE DATALINK ACTIVE DATA LINK STATUS DASH# XXXXXXXXXXX


INFORMATION AMT AMT USAGE 12% ERR1%AMT SW# P1.2.3 AMT

Return to Trip Information Screens


01/11/2005 f040706

Fig. 2.17, ICU4M Vehicle Information Screens

04/08/2005 f090431

Fig. 2.19, Manual-Reset Air Restriction Indicator, Go/


No-Go

the engine operation manual for more information on


rated rpm for your engine.
10/10/2001 f610568
If air restriction exceeds the maximum value again,
Fig. 2.18, Air Intake Restriction Indicator replace the air cleaner element. For instructions,
refer to Group 09 of the Century Class Trucks Work-
Air Intake Maximum Restriction Values: (inH2O) shop Manual.
Pre-EPA07
Engine Make
Engines
EPA07 Engines Application Air Pressure Gauge
Caterpillar 25 An application air pressure gauge registers the air
Cummins 25 25 pressure being used to apply the brakes, and should
Detroit 20 22 be used for reference only. The gauge will not regis-
Mercedes-Benz 22 22 ter air pressure until the foot brake pedal is de-
Table 2.2, Air Intake Maximum Restriction Values pressed or the trailer hand brake is applied.

If air restriction exceeds the maximum allowable


value, operate the vehicle for one more day, making
sure not to run the engine over rated rpm. Refer to

2.18
Instruments and Controls Identification

Coolant Temperature Gauge During normal operation, forward-rear and rear-rear


axle oil temperature gauges should read between:
NOTICE 160 to 220F (71 to 104C) for Meritor drive
axles;
A sudden increase in coolant temperature may 180 to 200F (82 to 93C) for Dana Spicer
indicate engine or cooling system failure. Bring drive axles.
the vehicle to a safe stop and investigate the
cause to prevent further damage. Do not operate Under heavy loads, such as when climbing steep
the engine until the cause has been determined grades, temperatures that exceed the normal oil tem-
and corrected. perature range for a short period are not unusual. If
the temperature returns to normal when the load de-
During normal engine operation, the coolant tem- creases, there is no problem.
perature gauge should read between 175 and 195F
(79 and 91C). If the temperature remains below
160F (71C), inspect the cooling system to deter-
Engine Oil Pressure Gauge
mine the cause.
If the temperature exceeds the maximum tempera-
NOTICE
ture shown in Table 2.3, inspect the cooling system A sudden decrease or absence of oil pressure
to determine the cause. See the Century Class may indicate mechanical failure. Bring the vehicle
Trucks Workshop Manual for troubleshooting and to a safe stop and investigate the cause to pre-
repair procedures. vent further damage. Do not operate the engine
until the cause has been determined and cor-
Maximum Coolant Temperature rected.
Engine Make Temperature: F (C)
Caterpillar 215 (101) The engine oil pressure gauge displays the current
engine oil pressure. If engine oil pressure falls below
Cummins 225 (107)
the minimum levels shown in Table 2.4, the CHECK
Detroit 215 (101)
engine lamp will illuminate. If the condition does not
Mercedes-Benz 221 (105) improve, the STOP engine lamp will also illuminate
Table 2.3, Maximum Coolant Temperature and an audible warning will sound. The engine will
then derate or shut down, depending on the type of
If coolant temperature rises above the maximum engine protection system installed.
temperature listed in Table 2.3 on EPA07 engines,
the CHECK engine lamp will illuminate. If the condi- Minimum Oil Pressure*
tion does not improve, the STOP engine lamp will At Idle Speed: At Rated RPM:
Engine Model
also illuminate and an audible warning will sound. psi (kPa) psi (kPa)
The engine will then derate or shut down, depending Caterpillar 1020 (69138) 3045 (207310)
on the type of engine protection system installed. Cummins 15 (103) 35 (241)
Detroit 14 (97) 55 (350)
Drive Axle Oil Temperature Gauges Mercedes-Benz 7 (50) 36 (250)
* Pressures apply with the engine at operating temperature. Oil pressure
may be higher on a cold engine. Observe and record pressures when the
NOTICE engine is new to create a guide for checking engine condition.
Table 2.4, Minimum Engine Oil Pressure
A sudden increase in oil temperature that is not
caused by a load increase may indicate mechani-
cal failure. Bring the vehicle to a safe stop and
investigate the cause to prevent further damage.
Do not operate the vehicle until the cause has
been determined and corrected.

2.19
Instruments and Controls Identification

Engine Oil Temperature Gauge A low-air-pressure warning light and audible alert,
connected to both the primary and secondary sys-
tems, activate when air pressure in either system
NOTICE drops below 64 to 76 psi (441 to 524 kPa).
A sudden increase in oil temperature that is not When the engine is started, the warning light and
caused by a load increase may indicate mechani- audible warning remain on until air pressure in both
cal failure. Bring the vehicle to a safe stop and systems exceeds minimum pressure.
investigate the cause to prevent further damage.
Do not operate the engine until the cause has Pyrometer
been determined and corrected.
A pyrometer registers the exhaust temperature near
During normal operation, the optional engine oil tem- the turbocharger. Variations in engine load can cause
perature gauge should read: exhaust temperatures to vary. If the pyrometer read-
190 to 220F (88 to 104C) for Caterpillar en-
ing shows that exhaust temperature exceeds normal,
reduce fuel to the engine until the exhaust tempera-
gines;
ture is reduced. Shift to a lower gear if the engine is
200 to 260F (93 to 126C) for Detroit and overloaded.
Cummins engines
177 to 203F (81 to 95C) for Mercedes-Benz
Speedometer
engines The speedometer registers speed in both miles per
Under heavy loads, such as when climbing steep hour (mph) and kilometers per hour (km/h).
grades, temperatures that exceed the normal oil tem-
perature range for a short period are not unusual. If Tachometer
the temperature returns to normal when the load de- The tachometer indicates engine speed in revolutions
creases, there is no problem. per minute (rpm) and serves as a guide for shifting
the transmission and keeping the engine in the ap-
Fuel Gauge propriate rpm range. For low idle and rated rpm, see
The fuel gauge indicates the level of fuel in the fuel the engine identification plate.
tank(s). A single fuel gauge is standard. If equipped
with an optional second fuel tank, each fuel tank Transmission Fluid Temperature
level is indicated on a separate gauge. Gauge
Primary and Secondary Air Pressure The transmission fluid temperature gauge indicates
the transmission lubricant operating temperature.
Gauges Temperatures vary by application, but the transmis-
sion fluid temperature gauge reading should not ex-
WARNING ceed 250F (121C).
Under heavy loads, such as when climbing steep
If air pressure falls below minimum pressure, the grades, temperatures that exceed the normal oil tem-
braking ability of the vehicle will be limited. Slow perature range for a short period are not unusual. If
the vehicle down and bring it to a gradual stop. the temperature returns to normal when the load de-
Do not attempt to move the vehicle until air pres- creases, there is no problem.
sure has risen above the minimum level. Moving
a vehicle without adequate braking power could
cause an accident resulting in personal injury or NOTICE
death.
A sudden increase in transmission fluid tempera-
Air pressure gauges register the pressure in the pri- ture that is not caused by a load increase may
mary and secondary air systems. Normal pressure, indicate mechanical failure. Bring the vehicle to a
with the engine running, is 100 to 120 psi (689 to safe stop and investigate the cause to prevent
827 kPa) in both systems.

2.20
Instruments and Controls Identification

further damage. Do not operate the vehicle until


the cause has been determined and corrected.

Turbocharger Boost Pressure Gauge


1
A turbocharger boost pressure gauge indicates the
pressure in the intake manifold, in excess of atmos-
pheric pressure, being created by the turbocharger.

Voltmeter
2
The voltmeter indicates the vehicle charging system
voltage when the engine is running and the battery
voltage when the engine is off. By monitoring the
voltmeter, the driver can stay aware of potential bat-
tery charging problems and have them fixed before
the batteries discharge enough to create starting diffi- 3
culties. Vehicles are equipped with either a voltmeter
gauge, or a digital voltmeter readout located on the
bottom line of the dash message center.
The voltmeter will normally show approximately 13.7
to 14.1 volts when the engine is running. The voltage
of a fully charged battery is 12.7 to 12.8 volts when 4
the engine is off. Battery voltage under 12.0 volts is
considered a low battery, and a completely dis-
charged battery will produce only about 11.0 volts.
If the voltmeter shows an undercharged or over-
charged condition for an extended period, have the
charging system and batteries checked at an autho- 01/05/2012 f611158
rized Freightliner service facility. 1. Interaxle Differential Lock Switch
On a vehicle equipped with a battery isolator system, 2. Fifth Wheel Slide Switch
3. Rearmost Axle Differential Lock Switch
the voltmeter measures the average voltage of all the
4. Air Suspension Dump Control Switch
batteries when the engine is running. When the en-
gine is off, the voltmeter shows only the isolated bat- Fig. 2.20, Axle and Suspension Switches
tery voltage and does not indicate the voltage of the
engine-starting batteries. Interaxle Lock Switch
The interaxle lock, standard on all dual-drive ve-
Controls hicles, is driver-actuated by means of a LOCK/
Controls and switches are listed here in alphabetical UNLOCK control valve switch. See Fig. 2.20. A red
order. indicator illuminates when the interaxle lock is en-
gaged.
Axle Switches
NOTICE
Differential Lock Switch
The differential lock switch provides maximum trac- The interaxle lock should only be engaged when
tion for slippery conditions by forcing the wheels on the vehicle is moving slowly at low throttle. En-
each drive axle governed by the switch to rotate to- gagement at high speed or power can damage
gether. Engagement can be at any speed, provided the axle(s).
the wheels are not slipping or spinning. See Do not permit rear wheels to spin freely for more
Fig. 2.20. than ten seconds when traction is lost. Shift into

2.21
Instruments and Controls Identification

LOCK to prevent damage to interaxle and main ply system and release the trailer spring parking
differentials. brakes. Pull the trailer air supply valve out before
disconnecting a trailer or when operating a vehicle
Brake Controls without a trailer.
NOTE: See Chapter 6 for detailed information Trailer Brake Lever
about brake systems.
The trailer brake lever is used to apply the trailer ser-
Parking Brake Control Valve vice brakes without applying the truck or tractor ser-
vice brakes. It is usually mounted on the right-hand
control panel. See Fig. 2.22. The valve can be par-
NOTICE tially or fully applied, but in any partially on position it
will be overridden by a full application of the service
Do not step on the service brake pedal while the brake pedal. Move the lever down to apply the trailer
parking brakes are applied. To do so can cause brakes; move the lever up to release the trailer
damage to the brake mechanisms. brakes. The lever will automatically return to the up
The yellow diamond-shaped knob operates the park- position when it is released.
ing brake valve. See Fig. 2.21. Pull the knob out to
apply the tractor and the trailer spring parking
brakes. Push the knob in to release the spring park-
ing brakes. Before the spring parking brakes can be
released, the air pressure in either air brake system
must be at least 65 psi (447 kPa).
If the trailer is not equipped with spring parking
brakes, pull the parking brake valve out to apply the
tractor parking brakes and the trailer service brakes.

1
2
10/17/2001 f610591

Fig. 2.22, Trailer Brake Lever

Engine Brake Switch


The Hi/Med/Lo engine brake 3-position switch con-
03/10/99 f610291 trols the amount of engine braking. Press the lower
1. Trailer Air Supply Valve (red knob) third of the switch for low, center for medium, and
2. Parking Brake Control Valve (yellow knob) upper third for high. See Fig. 2.23.
Fig. 2.21, Brake Valve Control Knobs
Cruise Control
Trailer Air Supply Valve
The red octagonal-shaped knob operates the trailer
WARNING
air supply valve, which charges the trailer air supply Do not use the cruise control system when driv-
system and releases the trailer spring parking ing conditions do not permit maintaining a con-
brakes. See Fig. 2.21. stant speed, such as in heavy traffic or on roads
After the vehicle and its air hoses are connected to a that are winding, icy, snow-covered, slippery, or
trailer and the pressure in the air system is at least roads with a loose driving surface. Failure to fol-
65 psi (447 kPa), push the trailer air supply valve low this precaution could cause a collision or
knob in (and leave it in) to charge the trailer air sup-

2.22
Instruments and Controls Identification

3. Press the lower half of the Set/Resume/


Accelerate/Decelerate switch momentarily to set
the cruise speed (with the vehicle moving at the
desired speed).
To decrease cruise speed, press and hold the
lower half of the Set/Resume/Accelerate/
Decelerate switch to decelerate slowly. Release
the switch when the desired speed is achieved.
To increase cruise speed, press and hold the
upper half of the Set/Resume/Accelerate/
06/04/2012 f611176
Decelerate switch to accelerate slowly. Release
Fig. 2.23, Engine Brake Switch the switch when the desired speed is achieved.

loss of vehicle control, possibly resulting in per- Disengage Cruise Control


sonal injury or property damage. NOTE: The speed memory is lost whenever the
ignition is turned off or the cruise control system
NOTICE is turned off.
When the cruise control is engaged, do not at- 1. Depress the brake pedal (automatic or manual
tempt to shift gears without using the clutch transmissions)
pedal. Failure to follow this precaution will result or
in a temporarily uncontrolled increase in engine
speed. Transmission damage and gear stripping Depress the clutch pedal (manual transmissions
could result. only).
Cruise control is activated by two dash-mounted 2. Press the lower half of the On/Off switch.
switches: an On/Off switch and a Set/Decelerate/
NOTE: To resume the preselected cruise speed,
Resume/Accelerate switch. See Fig. 2.24.
increase vehicle speed to above minimum
cruise control speed and momentarily press the
upper half of the Set/Resume/Accelerate/
Decelerate switch. Cruise will return to the last
speed selected.
2
1 Engine Fan Switch
To turn the engine fan on, press the upper half of the
engine fan switch. See Fig. 2.25. The fan will con-
tinue to operate for a set amount of time and then
turn off unless the coolant temperature is high
04/24/2012 f611181 enough to continue fan operation. To turn the fan off
1. Set/Decelerate/Resume/Accelerate Switch before the set time period ends, press the lower half
2. Cruise Control On/Off Switch of the switch.
Fig. 2.24, Cruise Control Switches
Ignition Switch
Cruise At a Set Speed The ignition switch has four positions: OFF, ACC (ac-
1. cessory), ON, and START. The ignition key also
Press the upper part of the cruise control On/Off
locks and unlocks the cab doors, baggage door(s),
switch to turn cruise control on.
and if equipped, the bunk door(s).
2. Hold the accelerator pedal down until the speed-
ometer reaches the desired speed.

2.23
Instruments and Controls Identification

Turn the key counterclockwise to reach the ACC po-


sition. In addition to all the functions that are oper-
able in the OFF position, the following functions are
operable when the switch is in the ACC position:
radio/stereo system
heater and A/C fan
mirror defog
windshield fan
04/24/2012 f611178 ether start system

Fig. 2.25, Engine Fan Switch air dryer


backup lights
In the OFF position, the ignition switch is vertical.
The key can be inserted and removed only in the Turn the key clockwise past the OFF position to
OFF position. reach the ON position. When the ignition is turned
The following functions are operable when the igni- on, the following actions should occur:
tion switch is in the OFF position (regardless of electronic gauges complete a full sweep of
whether the key is inserted): their dials
low-beam headlights warning and indicator lamps illuminate, then
taillights are extinguished
audible alert sounds for approximately four
brake lights
seconds or until sufficient air pressure builds
road lights up in the primary and secondary air systems
dome lights software revision level of the ICU is displayed
on the driver message center, followed by any
clearance lights
active faults
hazard warning lights
IMPORTANT: Do not crank the engine until the
turn signals ICU gauge sweep is complete.
utility lights Turn the key clockwise past the ON position to reach
the START position to start the engine. Release the
baggage compartment lights
key the moment the engine starts. Do not operate
spotlights the starter longer than thirty seconds, then allow the
starter to cool between attempts. If the starter over-
horn heats, the starter protection system will prevent op-
clock eration of the starter until it has cooled. Release the
key the moment the engine starts.
refrigerator
CB radio Lighting Controls
power mirrors Exterior Lighting Controls
power receptacle Exterior light controls are listed here in alphabetical
order.
fuel heater
electric oil pan heater
electric or diesel-fired engine coolant pre-
heater

2.24
Instruments and Controls Identification

Backup Lights The low-beam headlights must be on in order to turn


the fog lights on. Press the upper half of the switch
Backup lights provide a warning to pedestrians and to activate the fog lights. See Fig. 2.26.
other drivers that the vehicle is, or is about to, back
up. Hazard Warning Lights
Daytime Running Lights The hazard warning light switch tab is located below
the turn signal lever. Pull the tab out to activate the
The daytime running lights (DRL), if equipped, are hazard warning lights. When the hazard warning
automatically activated when the ignition is switched lights flash, all turn signal lamps and both of the indi-
on and the parking brake is released. The DRL oper- cator lights on the control panel will flash. Move the
ate until the parking brake is applied or the head- turn signal lever up or down to cancel the warning
lights are turned on. lights.
Some vehicles may be equipped with a momentary
DRL override switch. See Fig. 2.26. Press the upper Headlights
half of the switch to briefly deactivate the DRL. A three-position paddle switch is used to operate the
exterior lights. See Fig. 2.26. Move the paddle switch
Fog Lights up to activate the headlights, instrument panel, clear-
Fog lights are designed to reduce glare in foggy con- ance lights, marker lights, and taillights. To deactivate
ditions. all vehicle lighting, ensure the switch is in the middle

1 2 3 4 5

6 7 8 9 10
04/24/2012 f611174
1. Spotlight Switch 5. Road Lights Switch 8. Fog Lights Switch
2. Dome Light Switch 6. Rear Strobe Light Switch 9. Headlights/Marker Lights Switch
3. Utility Lights Switch 7. Front Strobe Light Switch 10. DRL Override Switch
4. Foot Well Lights Switch
Fig. 2.26, Typical Light Controls

2.25
Instruments and Controls Identification

position. Move the paddle switch down to activate upper half of the switch to activate the utility lights.
only the clearance, instrument panel, marker lights, See Fig. 2.26. Press the lower half of the switch to
and the taillights. turn the utility lights off. When activated, a red indica-
tor light in the switch is illuminated, if equipped
High-Beam Headlights
To activate the high-beam headlights, pull the turn Interior Lighting Controls
signal lever towards the driver while the low-beam Interior light controls are listed here in alphabetical
headlights are on. Pull the turn signal lever back order.
again to deactivate the high beams and return to low
beam headlights. Baggage Compartment Lights
When the high-beam headlights are on, a blue light Baggage compartment lights are located on the un-
illuminates on the instrument cluster. derside of the lower bunk, on both sides. Both lights
turn on when either baggage compartment door is
NOTE: The ignition switch must be on for the opened to illuminate the baggage compartment. The
high beams to work. lights also come on when the lower bunk is raised.
Marker Light Interrupt Cab Overhead Console Lights
A momentary interrupt switch temporarily deactivates The overhead console includes a clear reading light,
the marker lights and taillights. With the vehicle lights a clear dome light, and a red map light. The dome
on, press and release the interrupt switch to briefly lights illuminate when a door opens, then stay on for
turn the marker lights and taillights off. To alert the a short time after both doors are closed. Press the
driver that the switch is functioning, the dash lights lens of the reading light, dome light, or map light to
will flash with the marker lights when the switch is activate each one.
actuated.
Foot Well Lights
Road Lights
When the driver or passenger doors are opened, red
Press the upper half of the road light switch to acti- lights illuminate both foot wells. These lights can also
vate the road lights mounted on the bottom edge of be activated with the foot well light switch. See
the front bumper or recessed in the front bumper. Fig. 2.26. Press the upper half of the switch to turn
See Fig. 2.26. the foot well lights on, press the lower half of the
switch to turn them off.
Spotlight
The sleeper foot well switch is located in the lower
The spotlight switch is located on the pivoting handle
switch module in the sleeper. It looks identical to the
of the spotlight. There may be a single spotlight as-
cab foot well switch. See Fig. 2.26. When the switch
sembly mounted above the drivers door, or one
is activated, two lights illuminate the sleeper floor.
above each door.

Turn Signals Instrument Panel Lights


The instrument panel lights illuminate when the
The turn signal lever is mounted on the steering col- headlights are turned on. When the headlights are
umn. Push the lever down to activate the left-turn on, the panel lamp switch controls the intensity of the
signal lights; pull the lever up to activate the right- instrument panel lamps. Slide the switch up to
turn signal lights. To manually cancel the signal, brighten them and down to dim them. When the
move the lever to the neutral position. When a turn headlights are turned on, the panel lights setting will
signal is activated, a green indicator light flashes on default to the intensity that was last set.
the instrument cluster.
Rear-Wall Dome Light
Utility Lights
A rear-wall dome light is available on all sleeper
Utility lights can be swivel-mounted on top of the cabs. It is located on the rear wall where the wall
cab, mounted on the intake/exhaust support, or flush- meets the roof. To turn on the rear-wall fluorescent
mounted in the back of the cab or sleeper. Press the

2.26
Instruments and Controls Identification

light, press the dome light switch on either the lower wheel away from you. Release the foot pedal to lock
or upper bunk control panels. the steering column in place.

Sleeper Dome Light Suspension/Trailer Connection


A sleeper dome light is located on the roof, between Controls
the bunk and the cab on sleeper vehicles. The rear
cab dome light will activate with the dome lights Air Suspension Dump Control Switch
when a door is opened, then stay on for a short time
after both doors are closed. Use the dash-mounted NOTICE
switch or the switch in the sleeper panel to activate
the rear cab dome light. See Fig. 2.26. Do not operate the vehicle over uneven ground
such as ramps, speed bumps, curbs, etc. with
Sleeper Reading Lights the air springs deflated. Doing this may lead to
Clear reading lights are mounted above the lower air bag separation from the piston, preventing the
bunk in the rear corners of the sleeper. There are suspension air springs from re-inflating.
two switches in the sleeper control panel for the The air suspension height control switch may be
reading lights. To turn a reading light on, press the used to aid in connecting or disconnecting from a
upper half of the switch. Press the lower half of the trailer. When the switch is set to LOWER, the air
switch to turn it off. suspension dump valve deflates the air springs to
The reading lights can also be activated by pressing lower the rear of the vehicle. In the AUTO position,
the lens. the automatic ride-control valves operate for normal
driving.
PTO Switch
NOTICE
To activate the PTO function, press the upper half of
the switch. Press the lower half of the switch to de- Never exhaust air from the suspension while
activate the PTO function. driving. When the air is exhausted, the suspen-
sion will not absorb road shocks, and compo-
Steering Column Tilt/Telescope nents may be damaged.
Control A red LED in the switch is illuminated when the sus-
pension is deflated.
WARNING
Fifth Wheel Slide Control Switch
Make sure that the steering column is locked be-
fore driving the vehicle. Never tilt the column NOTICE
while driving the vehicle. Doing so could cause
loss of vehicle control, personal injury, and prop- Do not activate the fifth wheel slide control valve
erty damage. while the vehicle is in motion. To do so could
Adjust the seat to the desired ride position, then tilt cause damage to the fifth wheel member, the
or telescope the steering column as needed. kingpin, the cab or trailer, and ultimately to the
drivetrain.
To tilt the steering column, press down on the foot
pedal located on the steering column. Tilt the steer- The fifth wheel air slide valve allows repositioning of
ing column up or down to the desired position. Re- the sliding fifth wheel from inside the cab. Move the
lease the foot pedal to lock the steering column in air slide control valve switch to the LOCK position to
place. lock the fifth wheel to the baseplate. Move the switch
to the UNLOCK position to unlock the fifth wheel
To telescope the steering column, press down on the slide mechanism, allowing changes to the total length
foot pedal located on the steering column. Pull the of the tractor-trailer and changes to axle loads to
steering wheel closer to you or push the steering comply with state or provincial laws.

2.27
Instruments and Controls Identification

For detailed operating instructions for fifth wheel delay mode (fast or slow), push the bottom paddle
slide, refer to Chapter 10. A red indicator light illumi- up to shorten the delay period, or push the paddle
nates whenever the fifth wheel slide is unlocked. down to lengthen it.

Trailer Auxiliary Switch Roll Stability Advisor and


Some trailers with pneumatic brakes are equipped
with power for the trailer lights. The connection is
Control System
passed from the vehicle to the trailer via the primary The roll stability system may include only the roll sta-
receptacle, controlled by a dash switch. bility advisor (RSA) only, or it may also include the
roll stability control (RSC).
Press the top of the switch to activate the trailer aux-
iliary function. Press the bottom of the switch to turn A decal (Fig. 2.28) on the auxiliary dash panel, and
trailer auxiliary function off. an amber-colored dash indicator light (Fig. 2.29), in-
dicate that the vehicle is equipped with roll stability
Windshield Wiper/Washer Controls system components.

NOTICE
Do not attempt to manually move the windshield
SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
wiper arms. Wiper motor damage will occur if the lamp indicates traction
arms are forcibly moved. OR roll control event.
The wipers are operated by a dual paddle switch lo- Follow instructions in
cated on the auxiliary instrument panel. See drivers manual.
Fig. 2.27. To turn the wipers on or off, press the top 2401204000

paddle in. When the top paddle is pushed up, the 07/11/2003 f080125
wipers will operate at high speed; when it is pushed
down, they will wipe at low speed. Fig. 2.28, Roll Stability Decal

06/26/2003 f602128
05/01/2012 f611185
Fig. 2.29, Roll Stability Indicator Lamp
Fig. 2.27, Windshield Wiper Switch

The bottom paddle, when pushed in, turns the


Roll Stability Advisor
washers on. When pressed for less than -second, IMPORTANT: This is not an advance warning
the wipers will perform a single, low speed dry wipe system. The roll stability advisor displays a mes-
(mist function). When pressed for more than sage only after the driving maneuver is com-
-second, the wash cycle begins and continues for pleted.
three cycles or until the paddle is released. When the
bottom paddle is pushed up, the wipers operate in The roll stability system uses a lateral-acceleration
fast delay. When the bottom paddle is pushed down, sensor that monitors rollover risk. Shortly after a
the wipers operate in slow delay. With the wipers in curve, lane change, or other driving maneuver that

2.28
Instruments and Controls Identification

results in a rollover-risk detection, a dash warning MSG Message Message to Display Display Buzzer
light illuminates, an audible tone sounds, and a driver No. Time: Time:
advisory message is displayed in the driver message Seconds Seconds
1 System Fault 4 1
center. The purpose is to advise the driver that the WARNING
previous maneuver produced a rollover risk. RAC SYSTEM FAIL

The roll stability advisor displays different text mes- 2 RSC 4 None
ACTIVE SLOWING
sages depending on the severity of the risk of each ROLLOVER RISK

occurrence of risky driving. From the highest risk 3 RSA Level 3 VERY HIGH RISK OF 19.6 10
level to the lowest risk level, the system will sound ROLLOVER DETECTED
an audible alert, and display a message, as shown in
REDUCE SPEED
Fig. 2.30. AT LEAST 7 MPH

NOTE: The system will calculate and recom- or in metric


mend a speed reduction value. It may be differ- REDUCE SPEED
ent than the values shown here. AT LEAST 11 KPH

Bring the vehicle to an authorized service facility if a 4 RSA Level 2 HIGH RISK OF 14 5
system failure message is displayed. ROLLOVER DETECTED

REDUCE SPEED
Roll Stability Control AT LEAST 7 MPH

or in metric
WARNING REDUCE SPEED
AT LEAST 11 KPH
The Roll Stability Control system is intended only
5 RSA Level 1 8.4 2
as an aid for a conscientious and alert driver. ROLLOVER RISK
DETECTED
Carefully read the information in this manual to
understand this system and its limitations. The REDUCE SPEED
Roll Stability Control system is not a substitute AT LEAST 7 MPH

for safe driving procedures. Failure to drive or in metric


safely, and use the system properly, could result REDUCE SPEED
in personal injury and/or death and property AT LEAST 11 KPH
damage.
6 HBED Level 3 HARD BRAKING WITH 14 0.5
The roll stability control system automatically reduces ABS ACTIVATED
engine power, applies the engine brake, and/or ap-
LOOK AHEAD
plies the tractor and trailer brakes when the accelera- BRAKE SOONER
tion sensor detects that the vehicle is at risk of rolling
7 HBED Level 2 14 0.5
over. The control can intervene even before an advi- HARD BRAKING
DETECTED
sory message is displayed.
LOOK AHEAD
The dash indicator light illuminates whenever the roll BRAKE SOONER
stability control system intervenes.
8 HBED Level 1 LOSS OF TRACTION 14 0.5

Hard-Braking Advisor ABS ACTIVATED

ROAD SURFACE
The hard-braking advisor uses the information from MAY BE POOR
the ABS wheel speed sensors to determine when
braking is severe enough to produce lockup at one 07/25/2008 f040769
or more wheels on the tractor, and/or very rapid ve-
Fig. 2.30, Roll Stability and Hard-Braking Warnings
hicle deceleration. Shortly after a hard-braking event
occurs, an advisory message is displayed in the face conditions. This system is not a replacement for
driver message center, indicating that the braking a drivers good judgment. Sometimes it is necessary
behavior was too aggressive for the current road sur- to brake hard.

2.29
Instruments and Controls Identification

From the highest risk level to the lowest risk level, If the count reaches more than 9 occurrences an up-
the system will sound an audible alert, and display a arrow symbol will appear, to indicate to the driver
message, as shown in Fig. 2.30. that the count has exceeded 9 counts. See
Fig. 2.32.
Trip/Leg Totals
The driver message center records the number of
messages received, and displays the number of TRIP ADVISORIES
messages as counts. Roll stability advisor (RSA) and 23 ROLL 518 BRK
hard-braking event data (HBED) counts can be
viewed in the trip advisory screen, and the leg advi-
sory screen. A
07/25/2008 f040771
Counts can be reset using the + key on the steering A. RSA Lev. 1 has more than 9 counts.
wheel. Clearing RSA and HBED leg counts will also
reset the leg miles and leg hours. Clearing RSA and Fig. 2.32, Trip Advisor Message Screen (more than 9
HBED trip counts will also reset trip miles, trip hours, counts)
leg miles, leg hours, and leg advisory counts. In ad-
dition, resetting leg miles will clear leg counts. Clear-
ing trip miles will reset miles, hours, and counts in
both the leg and trip screens.
The TRIP and LEG advisor screens count both the
roll stability advisories (ROLL) and hard-braking
events (BRK). For example, if during a TRIP, the
driver message center recorded the events in
Table 2.5, the message center would display as
shown in Fig. 2.31.

TRIP ADVISORIES
237 ROLL 518 BRK

A B C D E F
07/25/2008 f040770
A. RSA lev. 3 Count (2) D. HBED lev. 3 Count (5)
B. RSA lev. 2 Count (3) E. HBED lev. 2 Count (1)
C. RSA lev. 1 Count (7) F. HBED lev. 1 Count (8)
Fig. 2.31, Trip Advisor Message Screen

RSA/HBED Count
Message Received Message Counts
RSA Level 3 2
RSA Level 2 3
RSA Level 1 7
HBED Level 3 5
HBED Level 2 1
HBED Level 1 8
Table 2.5, RSA/HBED Count

2.30
3
Vehicle Access
Ignition and Lock Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1
Cab Door Locks and Handles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1
Grab Handles and Access Steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1
Door Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3
Sleeper Compartment Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3
Circuit Breaker/Relay Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3
Cab-to-Sleeper Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3
Sleeper Bunk Latches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3
Sleeper Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3
Baggage Compartment Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.4
Back-of-Cab Grab Handles, Steps, and Deck Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.4
Battery Box Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5
Hood Tilting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5
Cab Amenities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6
Windshield Washer Reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.7
Vehicle Access

Ignition and Lock Key


One key operates the ignition switch and all of the
door locks.
IMPORTANT: Each key is numbered. Record
the number so, if needed, a duplicate key can
be made.
1

Cab Door Locks and Handles 3


To unlock the drivers door from outside the cab, in-
sert the key in the lockset and turn it one-quarter turn
clockwise (Fig. 3.1). Turn the key counterclockwise
to the original position to remove it. Pull out on the
paddle handle to open the door (Fig. 3.1).
2

10/27/95 f600910

1. Lock Button 3. Door Handle


2. Integral Grab Bar
9/07/95 f600906 Fig. 3.2, Door Interior
1. Lockset 2. Paddle Handle
Fig. 3.1, Exterior Door Handle
Grab Handles and Access
Steps
To unlock the passengers door from outside the cab,
insert the key in the lockset and turn it one-quarter
turn counterclockwise. Turn the key to the original WARNING
position to remove it.
Wet or dirty shoe soles greatly increase the
NOTE: The cab door locks can be operated chance of slipping or falling. If your soles are wet
when the doors are open. or dirty, be especially careful when climbing
onto, or down from, the back-of-cab area.
To lock a door from outside the cab, insert the key in
the lockset and turn it opposite the unlocking direc- Always maintain three-point contact with the
tion, then close the door if it is open. Or, push down back-of-cab access supports while entering and
the inside lock button (Fig. 3.2), then close the door. exiting the back-of-cab area. Three-point contact
means both feet and one hand, or both hands
To lock either door from inside the cab, push down and one foot, on the grab handles, steps, and
the lock button (Fig. 3.2), then close the door if it is deck plates. Other areas are not meant to sup-
open. Pull the integral grab bar (Fig. 3.2) when clos- port back-of-cab access, and grabbing or step-
ing the door. ping in the wrong place could lead to a fall, and
To open the door from the inside, pull the door personal injury.
handle toward you (Fig. 3.2). This will unlatch the
door whether or not it is locked. To unlock the door
without unlatching it, pull the lock button up.

3.1
Vehicle Access

Be careful not to get hands or feet tangled in Exiting the Drivers Side (Fig. 3.3)
hoses or other back-of-cab equipment. Careless-
ness could cause a person to trip and fall, with Exit the cab from the drivers side as follows:
possible injury.
IMPORTANT: Do not attempt to exit the cab
Entering the Drivers Side (Fig. 3.3) while carrying any items in your hands.
1. Grasp the steering wheel with both hands, place
your left foot on the top step, and stand on the
threshold, facing into the cab.
2. Grasp the grab handle at the aft edge of the
1 door opening with your right hand.
3. Move your right foot to the bottom step.
4. Move your left hand to the grab handle.
5. Step to the ground with your left foot first.
2
Entering the Passengers Side (Fig. 3.4)
3

4 1

2
02/12/96 f600911

1. Steering Wheel 3. Top Step


2. Grab Handle 4. Bottom Step
3
Fig. 3.3, Drivers Side Steps and Grab Handle

When entering the cab from the drivers side, use the
4
grab handle and access steps as follows:
1. Open the drivers door, and place anything that
you are carrying in the cab.
2. Grasp the grab handle with both hands. Reach
up as far as is comfortable. 03/27/96 f601124

3. Place your right foot on the bottom step, and pull 1. Upper Grab Handle 3. Top Step
yourself up. 2. Lower Grab Handle 4. Bottom Step

4. Place your left foot on the top step. Fig. 3.4, Passengers Side Steps and Grab Handles

5. Grasp the steering wheel with your left hand, and When entering the cab from the passengers side,
step up. use the grab handles and access steps as follows:
6. Step into the cab with your right foot first, and 1. Open the passengers door, and place anything
grasp the steering wheel with your right hand. that you are carrying in the cab.

3.2
Vehicle Access

2. Grasp the grab handle at the aft edge of the


door opening with your left hand.
Circuit Breaker/Relay Panel
3. The circuit breaker/relay panel is located in front of
Grasp the handle on the door (Fig. 3.4) with your
the passengers seat under the top cover of the in-
right hand.
strument panel. To access the compartment, first re-
4. Place your right foot on the bottom step and step move the vertical panel located immediately below
up to the upper step with your left foot. the right hand adjustable louvers. Gently pry up the
lower edge by using your fingertips or a flat-bladed
5. With your left hand, grasp the upper grab handle screwdriver in the slots provided. Rotate the exposed
on the windshield post. fastener one-quarter turn and lift off the cover. Re-
6. Place your right foot on the top step and step up. moval of the smaller exposed duct might also be re-
quired.
7. Move your right hand to the upper grab handle
on the windshield post.
Cab-to-Sleeper Access
8. Step into the cab with your left foot first.

Exiting the Passengers Side (Fig. 3.4) WARNING


Exit the cab from the passengers side as follows: Place rigid or heavy objects in storage areas on
the floor or under the bunk. Sudden stops or
IMPORTANT: Do not attempt to exit the cab swerves could cause personal injury if items fall
while carrying any items in your hands. from overhead storage shelves.
1. Grasp the grab handle on the windshield post To open the sleeper access on vehicles with vinyl
with both hands, and place your right foot on the sleeper curtains, unzip the sleeper curtains. If de-
top step while standing up from the seat facing sired, unsnap the curtains all the way around the
inward. sides and top and remove the curtains.
2. Place your left foot on the bottom step. To open the sleeper access on vehicles with velour
3. Move your left hand to the grab handle at the aft sleeper curtains, unfasten the snaps at one side,
edge of the door opening. then push the curtain to the opposite side.

4. Move your right hand to the grab handle on the


door.
Sleeper Bunk Latches
5. Step to the ground with your right foot first. To move the lower or upper sleeper bunk (if
equipped), disengage the latch at the front of the
lower bunk, or the latches on both sides of the upper
Door Windows bunk. Lock the bunks into operating position, down
The windows in both doors operate electrically (if so for the lower bunk and up or down for the upper
equipped). Use the appropriate switch to raise or bunk, by engaging both the primary and secondary
lower a door window. latches.

Sleeper Compartment Vents Sleeper Door


To open any sleeper compartment vent, push the The sleeper door (Fig. 3.5, Ref. 1) is not intended for
vent handle outward and forward with your fingertips. entry or exit. The door is intended only as a conve-
To close the vent, turn your hand so that your fingers nient means to stow or remove personal belongings
are pulling on the handle from the front edge, then in and from the sleeper area. To open the door, push
pull in and back on the handle. Use care to avoid down on the lever handle located inside the sleeper
pinching your fingers. compartment to the right of the door. The door can
be opened from the outside by pulling the release
cable strap inside the baggage door opening. To
close the door, push it closed until it latches.

3.3
Vehicle Access

IMPORTANT: The sleeper doors are two-stage touch any part of the exhaust system, or severe
latching. When closing the doors, ensure that burns could occur.
they are completely latched to prevent wind When trailer air and electrical connections cannot be
noise and water intrusion. reached conveniently from the ground, Federal Motor
Carrier Safety Regulations require commercial carri-
ers to provide back-of-cab access supports.
Optional grab handles are mounted either on both
cab sidewalls, or on the left sidewall only. See
Fig. 3.6. Steps are mounted either on the fuel tank(s)
1 or on metal brackets. When a deck plate is neces-
sary, it is mounted across the top of the frame rails.
IMPORTANT: Climb onto, and down from, back-
2 of-cab access facing in toward the vehicle, as
you would on a ladder. Do not climb up or down
facing out away from the vehicle.

02/12/96 f601031

1. Sleeper Door
2. Baggage Compartment Door
Fig. 3.5, Passenger-Side Sleeper and Baggage
Compartment Doors 2

Baggage Compartment Doors


To unlock the baggage compartment door on the
passengers side, insert the ignition key in the lock-
set, and turn it one-quarter turn clockwise. See
Fig. 3.5. Turn the key to the original position to re-
move it. Pull up and outward on the baggage door
handle to open the door. To close the door, push it
closed until it latches. To lock the door, insert the ig- 3
nition key in the lockset and turn it one-quarter turn
counterclockwise.
Use the same procedure to open the baggage com-
partment door on the drivers side, but turn the key
counterclockwise to unlock the door and clockwise to
lock it.
1
Back-of-Cab Grab Handles,
Steps, and Deck Plate
1

WARNING
09/24/2007 f602335
External surfaces of the exhaust system remain
hot after the engine has been shut down. When 1. Steps 2. Grab Handle 3. Deck Plate
accessing the back of the cab or sleeper, do not Fig. 3.6, Back-of-Cab Access

3.4
Vehicle Access

WARNING Battery Box Cover


To remove the cover from the frame rail-mounted
Wet or dirty shoe soles greatly increase the battery box, release the latches that attach the left
chance of slipping or falling. If your soles are wet chassis fairing panel (if equipped) in front of the bat-
or dirty, be especially careful when climbing tery box. Remove the air fairing panel. See Group
onto, or leaving, the back-of-cab area. 60 of the Columbia Workshop Manual for instruc-
Always maintain three-point contact with the tions. If no air fairing panel is installed, remove the
back-of-cab access supports while entering and step plate. Pull on the end of each hold-down latch
exiting the back-of-cab area. Three-point contact until the end clears the cover-mounted catch. Pivot
means both feet and one hand, or both hands the latches out of the way, then lift off the cover.
and one foot, on the grab handles, steps, and When installing the cover, be sure it is positioned
deck plates. Other areas are not meant to sup- properly before fastening the latches.
port back-of-cab access, and grabbing or step- To remove the cover from the battery box mounted
ping in the wrong place could lead to a fall, and between the frame rails, remove the deck plate and
personal injury. lift the handle on the top of the battery box cover. If
Be careful not to get hands or feet tangled in equipped, remove the spring pin.
hoses or other back-of-cab equipment. Careless-
ness could cause a person to trip and fall, with Hood Tilting
possible injury.
The hood can be tilted to a full-open position. A grab
Entering Back-of-Cab handle at the front of the hood provides a hand-hold
for hood tilting. A torsion bar helps you to tilt the
When climbing onto the deck plate, do the following: hood open, and to return it to the operating position.
1. Grasp the sidewall grab handle with both hands. A damper controls the closing rate of the hood and
Reach up as far as is comfortable. hood straps prevent the hood from overtravel. In the
operating position, the hood is secured to the lower
2. Place one foot on the bottom step and pull your- cab side panels by a hold-down latch on each side of
self up. the hood.
3. Place your other foot on the top step.
To Tilt the Hood
4. Move your lower hand to a higher position on the
grab handle. 1. Apply the parking brakes.
5. Step onto the deck plate. 2. Release both hood hold-down latches by pulling
the ends outward.
Climbing Down from Back-of-Cab
To climb down from the back-of-cab area:
CAUTION
1. Grasp the sidewall grab handle with both hands. Do not let the hood free-fall to the full-open posi-
tion. To do so could cause damage to the hood
2. Step one foot at a time onto the top step. or hood straps.
3. Move your upper hand to a lower position on the 3. Using the bumper step and grab handle, slowly
grab handle. tilt the hood until the straps support it. See
4. Move one foot to the bottom step. Fig. 3.7.

5. Move your upper hand to a lower position on the To Return the Hood
grab handle.
1. Grasp the grab handle, and lift the hood to the
6. Step to the ground with your upper foot first. 45-degree position.

3.5
Vehicle Access

Dash Storage Bin


The dash storage bin is located under the cup hold-
ers on the center panel. The bin has a hinged cover
and can be used to store sunglasses.

Map Holder
An elastic-topped pouch is located above each door.
These are intended for holding maps and other
items.

Glove Box
Some vehicles have two glove boxes and two small
overhead bins, all located in the overhead console
assembly. See Fig. 3.8. Above the sun visors on
both the drivers and the passengers sides are the
11/15/1999 f880478
glove boxes with latched doors or netted openings.
In the middle section of the console assembly are
Fig. 3.7, Hood Tilting two small bins. The drivers-side bin is often removed
and replaced with a CB radio. The grille underneath
2. As the hood goes over center, the hood damper this portion of the console allows the radios speaker
controls the rate of descent to the operating posi- to be heard.
tion.
3. Make sure the hood is flush with the cowl, then
secure the hood by engaging both hood hold-
down latches.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that both hold-down
latches are fully engaged before operating the
vehicle.

Cab Amenities
Waste Bin 1 2 3 4
10/15/96 f601244
To remove the waste bin, slide the waste bin out as
far as it will go. Reach in behind the bin and release 1. Drivers Glove Box
the bin from the stops on the bin sides. Remove the 2. Drivers Overhead Storage Bin
3. Passengers Overhead Storage Bin
bin. To install the bin, insert the bin onto the slides, 4. Passengers Glove Box
and then slide the bin into place.
Fig. 3.8, Glove Boxes and Overhead Storage
Cup Holders
The Columbia vehicle features two cup holders
Overhead Lights
above the ash tray and waste bin on the center Above both the drivers and the passengers seats
panel. are three oval-shaped lights mounted to the bottom
of the overhead console: a red light and two white
Ash Tray and Cigar Lighter lights. The red light is mounted nearest to the wind-
shield. Each light is activated by pushing on the lens
The drivers ash tray and cigar lighter assembly is on cover. Also, the center light, a white light, activates
the center panel. The tray is removable. when the doors to the vehicle are opened.

3.6
Vehicle Access

Footwell Lights
There are optional red lights mounted underneath the
dash on the drivers and the passengers sides of the
vehicle. These lights are activated by a rocker switch
on the lower dash panel next to the climate control
switches.

Windshield Washer Reservoir


The windshield washer reservoir is located on the
left-hand side of the frontwall between the surge tank
and the hood. See Fig. 3.9.

01/15/97 f820190
1. Surge Tank 3. Drain
2. Washer Reservoir

Fig. 3.9, Windshield Washer Reservoir

3.7
4
Heater and Air Conditioner
Constant Discharge Temperature Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1
Cab Climate Control Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1
Sleeper Climate Control Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3
Parked HVAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4
Air Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.5
Heater and Air Conditioner

Constant Discharge NOTE: When the fan switch on the cab climate
control panel is off and the sleeper air condi-
Temperature Control tioner is on, the cab fan will operate at low
The cab heater and air conditioner system is a Con- speed even though the cab fan switch is in the
stant Discharge Temperature Control (CDTC) sys- off position. This is necessary to protect the
tem. The CDTC maintains a constant temperature of evaporator in the cab heater and air conditioner
airflow in the cab regardless of outside air tempera- system from freezing.
ture, selected fan speed, engine coolant temperature, There is a two-second delay between the time the
or engine coolant flow. Once the temperature control engine is started and the blower is operational. It can
switch is turned to the desired temperature, no other take an additional four seconds for the blower to
adjustments are necessary. The CDTC system is dis- reach high speed. The blower motor performs a self-
abled when the temperature control switch is in the test immediately after the engine is started, which
maximum cool or maximum warm position. causes the delay.

Cab Climate Control Panel Air Selection Switch


The climate control panel allows you to control the The air selection switch allows you to control the flow
heating and air conditioning functions of the heater of air through the face outlets, the floor outlets, the
and air conditioner. See Fig. 4.1. defrost (windshield) outlets, or a combination of
these outlets to give you nine air selection modes.
Fan Switch See Fig. 4.2.
The fan switch controls the fan speed and forces 1. Face Mode: Directs all airflow through the face
fresh air or recirculated air through the selected air or instrument panel outlets.
outlets. The fan switch has eight fan speeds and an 2. Selection between Face Mode and Bi-Level
off position. Mode: Directs 75 percent of the airflow through
To increase airflow, turn the switch clockwise or to a the face outlets and 25 percent through the floor
higher number. To decrease the airflow, turn the outlets.
switch counterclockwise or to a lower number. Set-
3. Bi-Level Mode: Directs the airflow equally to the
ting the fan switch to the off position disables the air
face outlets and floor outlets.
conditioner and places the air source in the fresh air
mode.

2
1 3

BUNK O 4
OVRD

2 4 6

1 3 5

06/21/2001 f610450

1. Bunk Override Switch 3. Recirculation Button 5. Air Conditioning Button


2. Fan Switch 4. Air Selection Switch 6. Temperature Control Switch
Fig. 4.1, Cab Climate Control Panel

4.1
Heater and Air Conditioner

9. Defrost Mode: Directs all airflow through the


5 defrost outlets. The air conditioner automatically
4 6
turns on in this mode. The recirculation button
3 7 will not work in this mode.

Temperature Control Switch


2 8
The temperature control switch is used to select the
desired temperature. On the manual and CDTC cli-
mate control panel, turn the switch clockwise or to
1 9
the red area for warm air. Turn the switch counter-
clockwise or to the blue area for cool air.

Air Conditioning
The air conditioner cools and dehumidifies the air
06/21/2001 f610502 inside the cab. Press the air conditioning button to
1. Face Mode turn the air conditioner on and off. See Fig. 4.3.
2. Selection Between Face Mode and Bi-Level Mode
3. Bi-Level Mode
4. Selection Between Bi-Level Mode and Floor Mode
5. Floor Mode
6. Selection Between Floor Mode and Floor/Defog
Mode 1
7. Defog Mode
8. Selection Between Defog Mode and Defrost Mode
9. Defrost Mode

Fig. 4.2, Air Selection Switch Modes

4. Selection between Bi-Level Mode and Floor 06/21/2001 f610505


Mode: Directs 25 percent of the airflow through
1. Amber Indicator
the face outlets and 75 percent through the floor
outlets. Fig. 4.3, Air Conditioning Button
5. Floor Mode: Directs all airflow through the floor When the air conditioner is operating, the amber indi-
outlets. cator on the air conditioning button will be on
6. Selection between Floor Mode and Floor/ whether the request for air conditioning comes from
Defog Mode: Directs 75 percent of the airflow the cab climate control panel or the sleeper climate
through the floor outlets and 25 percent through control panel. When the instrument panel lights are
the defrost outlets. on, the snowflake indicator on the air conditioning
button will be on.
7. Defog Mode: Directs the airflow equally to the
floor outlets and the defrost outlets. The air con- The air conditioner will be automatically disabled
ditioner automatically turns on in this mode. The when:
recirculation button will not work in this mode. The outside air temperature is low enough to
8. Selection between Defog Mode and Defrost make air conditioning ineffective;
Mode: Directs 75 percent of the airflow through The engine is running at low rpm;
the defrost outlets and 25 percent through the
floor outlets. The air conditioner automatically Specific conditions exist that result in the
turns on in this mode. The recirculation button heater and air conditioner system going into
will not work in this mode. protection mode.

4.2
Heater and Air Conditioner

Recirculation mode is on. If the fan speed or temperature setting


on the sleeper climate control panel is adjusted when
The recirculation mode limits the amount of outside the bunk override mode is on, the bunk override
air entering the cab. Press the recirculation button to mode will be canceled.
prevent dusty or smoky air from entering the cab.
When the heating and air conditioning system is in
See Fig. 4.4. The recirculation mode can also de-
the bunk override mode, the cab climate control
crease the time required to cool or heat the cab inte-
panel can be adjusted without affecting the sleeper
rior during extreme outside temperature conditions.
settings. To reset the sleeper settings, set the fan
When the recirculation mode is on, the amber indica-
speed and temperature settings on the cab climate
tor on the recirculation button will be on.
control panel to the desired sleeper settings and
press the upper half of the bunk override switch
again. The cab climate control panel can again be
adjusted without affecting the sleeper settings.
Press the lower half of the bunk override switch to
1 cancel the override mode. After the override mode is
canceled, the sleeper heater and air conditioner sys-
tem will operate from the sleeper fan speed and tem-
perature settings and the amber indicator will be off.

Sleeper Climate Control Panel


06/21/2001 f610504
1. Amber Indicator The sleeper heater and air conditioner system fea-
tures Constant Discharge Temperature Control
Fig. 4.4, Recirculation Button (CDTC). The sleeper climate control panel is shown
in Fig. 4.5. The CDTC maintains a constant tempera-
The recirculation button will not work when the air ture of airflow in the sleeper regardless of outside air
selection switch is in one of the following modes: temperature, selected fan speed, engine coolant tem-
defog mode perature, or engine coolant flow. Once the tempera-
ture control switch is turned to the desired tempera-
the selection between defog mode and defrost ture, no other adjustments are necessary.
mode
defrost mode Fan Switch
NOTE: To prevent the buildup of fumes or odors The fan switch controls the sleeper heater and air
and to prevent oxygen depletion inside the cab, conditioner system fan speed. The sleeper climate
control panel has eight fan speeds and an off posi-
the system switches from full recirculation mode
tion. To increase airflow, turn the switch clockwise or
to partial recirculation mode after 20 minutes. In to a higher number. To decrease the airflow, turn the
extremely dusty or smoky conditions, the partial switch counterclockwise or to a lower number.
recirculation mode can be overridden by press-
ing the recirculation button twice to obtain full NOTE: When the cab air conditioner is on, the
recirculation mode. This resets the 20-minute sleeper fan will operate at low speed even
timer. though the sleeper fan switch is in the off posi-
tion. This is necessary to protect the evaporator
Bunk Override Switch, Optional in the sleeper heater and air conditioner system
from freezing.
The bunk override (BUNK OVRD) switch allows the
driver to remotely control the fan speed and tempera- Temperature Control Switch
ture settings in the sleeper. See Fig. 4.1. Press the
upper half of the bunk override switch to override the The temperature control switch is used to select the
sleeper settings with the cab settings. The amber desired temperature in the sleeper. Turn the switch
indicator on the switch is on when the bunk override clockwise or to the red area for warm air. Turn the

4.3
Heater and Air Conditioner

Overview
The Bergstrom NITE (No Idle Thermal Environment)
parked, or no-idle, air conditioning system is a com-
1 2
2 pact, electrically powered, 3000-BTU system. It is
1 3
designed to provide a means of air conditioning to
the sleeper area without having the engine running. It
O 4
is completely self-contained, and runs on 12-volt
deep-cycle batteries. The system is designed to
maintain cool air in the sleeper interior. For optimal
operation, the curtain between the cab and the
sleeper must be closed when using the A/C system.
The parked A/C unit will not cool down a hot sleeper
that has been sitting in the sun without the vehicle
A/C running. If the interior temperature is higher than
desired, start the engine and run the vehicle A/C sys-
tem until the desired sleeper temperature is
06/21/2001 f610503 achieved. This will help cool the sleeper to a tem-
1. Fan Switch perature that the parked A/C system can maintain.
2. Temperature Control Switch Once the sleeper temperature is lowered, the system
will maintain a comfortable setting.
Fig. 4.5, Sleeper Climate Control Panel
The A/C unit is located under the lower bunk in the
switch counterclockwise or to the blue area for cool sleeper compartment. The unit gets its intake air
air. from the under-bunk area through a grate in the top
panel. An air intake grille is located on the front panel
The air conditioner automatically turns on when nec-
of the lower bunk. The outlet ducting runs from the
essary to maintain the selected temperature in the
left side of the unit to an outlet near the bunk occu-
sleeper. If the sleeper air conditioner automatically
pants face on the back wall of the sleeper. It is im-
turns on when the cab air conditioner is on, the cab
portant to keep the air intake grille, and the area
air conditioner fan speed and temperature settings
under the bunk, free of objects that might block air
will override the sleeper air conditioner settings.
flow or put objectionable odors into the cooling air.
The CDTC system is disabled when the temperature Air for the condenser is taken in from under the cab
control switch is in the maximum cool or maximum and exhausted through another opening in the cab
warm positions. floor.
The bunk override switch allows the driver to re- The system receives power from four deep-cycle bat-
motely control the temperature and fan speed set- teries located between the frame rails. These batter-
tings in the sleeper. The bunk override mode can be ies are completely isolated from the starting batteries
canceled by changing the sleeper fan speed or tem- to keep the starting batteries from being drawn down
perature setting. After the override mode is canceled, during operation.
the sleeper heater and air conditioner system will
The heater unit is located under the lower bunk in
operate from the sleeper fan speed and temperature
the sleeper compartment next to the A/C unit. The
settings and the amber indicator on the switch will be
unit gets its intake air through a duct attached to a
off.
grille located on the right side of the front panel of
the lower bunk. The outlet ducting runs from the
Parked HVAC back of the unit to a grille on the left side of the front
panel of the lower bunk.
The parked HVAC system consists of a compact
electrical 3000-BTU air conditioning system, and a Operation
diesel-fired heater unit.
IMPORTANT: Before operating the Parked
HVAC system, make sure that the intake and

4.4
Heater and Air Conditioner

outlet vents for the A/C and heater units are


clear. Blocked vents will hamper the operation
of the unit.
The control panel for the parked A/C and heater is 1
located on the back wall of the sleeper near the left
side. It has a temperature control dial, and a four-
position mode selector switch. Turn the temperature
control dial to the left for cooling, and to the right for 2
heat. See Fig. 4.6. See Table 4.1 for a description of
the function of the mode switch. 3
The system must be turned off whenever it is not in
use, or the batteries may not charge properly. After
4
using the system, turn the mode switch to the OFF
position, even if the unit is not running.
5 AUTO
Parked A/C and Heater Mode Switch Operation
Mode Function
6
Off Turns the unit off.
Allows the unit to automatically heat or
cool the sleeper, depending on the 08/29/2007 f831760
temperature setting and the sleeper 1. Temperature Control 4. Heat Only
AUTO
temperature. Adjusts the compressor, Dial 5. AUTO
heater, and fans to keep temperature 2. Mode Switch 6. Off
constant. 3. A/C Only
Allows only the heat portion of the system
Heat Only to run. Adjusts the heater only to keep the Fig. 4.6, Parked A/C and Heater Control Panel
temperature constant.
Allows only the A/C portion of the system
A/C Only to run. Adjusts compressor and fans only
to keep the temperature constant.
Table 4.1, Parked A/C and Heater Mode Switch
Operation

Air Outlets
The face outlets on the instrument panel have lou-
vers that can be moved right and left, and up and
down. Move the louvers to the desired location or to
close the outlet. The defrost (windshield) outlets and
the outlets that are directed at the doors are not
adjustable.
The sleeper has one or two air outlets on the right
side of the cab, depending on the height of the cab.
The sleeper air outlet pivots from side to side and
has louvers that can be moved up and down or
closed.

4.5
5
Seats and Seat Belts
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1
Seat Belts and Tether Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4
Sleeper Compartment Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7
Supplemental Restraint System, Optional . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.8
Air Bag, Optional . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.8
SPACE System, Optional . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.9
Seats and Seat Belts

Seats Seat Adjustment


General Information The following is a description of adjustments that can
be made to various Freightliner-installed seats. Not
Unless otherwise noted, all seat adjustments should all seats have all of the adjustments listed below.
be made while seated and before the engine is See Fig. 5.1.
started. 1. Back Cushion Tilt: This adjustment enables the
Due to the maximum adjustability of mid- and high- back cushion to pivot forward or backward.
back air suspension seats, it is possible to combine
2. Lumbar Support: Lumbar support changes the
the seat back recline adjustment and the seat slide
shape of the seat back to give more or less sup-
adjustment so that the seat back contacts the back-
port to the occupants lumbar (lower back) area.
wall. It is the responsibility of the driver to adjust the
This adjustment is either mechanical or air con-
seat to prevent damage to the seat and the cab inte-
trolled, depending on make and model of the
rior.
seat.
WARNING 3. Isolator: This feature (also referred to as back-
slap isolator or Chugger-Snubber) reduces the
Keep hands, tools, and other objects away from amount of road shock by isolating the occupant
the scissor points under the seats. Failure to do from the motion of the vehicle, and allowing the
so could cause personal injury. upper seat to move in a simple pendulum mo-
tion. A lockout feature is used whenever the iso-
lator is not desired.

1
3 4
2
8

6 7
5

10/26/2000 f910149a
1. Back Cushion Tilt 5. Bottom Cushion Angle (fore and aft cushion height)
2. Lumbar Support 6. Fore and Aft Seat Adjustment (seat track adjustment)
3. Isolator Feature 7. Seat Tilt
4. Height Adjustment 8. Upper Back Cushion
Fig. 5.1, Seat Adjustments

5.1
Seats and Seat Belts

4. Height Adjustment: The entire seat moves up or


down when adjusting the height. The adjustment
is either manually or air controlled, depending on
the make of the seat.
5. Bottom Cushion Angle or Fore and Aft Bottom
Cushion Height: This feature enables the occu-
pant to raise or lower the front or back of the
bottom cushion. This adjustment is easier to per-
form when all weight is removed from the seat. 2
6. Fore and Aft Seat or Seat Track Adjustment: The
entire seat moves forward or backward when this 3
adjustment is made.
4
7. Seat Tilt: When this adjustment is made, the seat
assembly (back and bottom cushions) tilts for-
ward or backward. 5
6
8. Upper Back Cushion Adjustment: When this ad-
justment is made, the upper back cushion
1 7
changes angle to provide upper back support. 03/12/2001 f910456
9. Weight Adjustment: On those seats with weight 1. Isolator and Fore/Aft Seat Adjustment Lever
adjustment, the feature is fully automatic. When 2. Bottom Cushion Angle Guide
you sit on the seat, a leveling valve places you in 3. Armrest Adjustment Knob
the center of the ride zone. Additional adjust- 4. Back Cushion Tilt Position Indicator
ments are possible by using the height adjust- 5. Back Cushion Tilt Lever
ment feature. 6. Height Adjustment and Lumbar Support Lever
7. Fore/Aft Seat Position Indicator
EzyRider Seat Fig. 5.2, EzyRider Seat Adjustment Controls (Vehicles
Built Before November 28, 2005)
For seat adjustment controls on vehicles built before
November 28, 2005, see Fig. 5.2. For seat adjust- Fore and Aft Seat Adjustment
ment controls on vehicles built on or after November
28, 2005, see Fig. 5.3. Pull the fore and aft seat adjustment lever out to the
second stop and slide the seat forward or backward
Back Cushion Tilt to the desired position.
To tilt the back cushion, raise the back cushion tilt Height Adjustment
lever and lean forward or backward. Release the
lever to lock the cushion in place. To raise or lower the seat, use the height adjustment
switch or lever on the side of the seat.
Lumbar Support
Bottom Cushion Angle
To adjust the amount of support for your lower back,
use the lumbar support switch or lever on the side of To adjust the bottom cushion angle, pull the bottom
the seat. cushion up and forward or down and back. The bot-
tom cushion angle is controlled by the guides on
Isolator each side of the seat.
To engage the isolator, push in on the isolator lever. Seat Position Indicators
To lock out the isolator, pull the isolator lever out to
the first stop. Seats installed in vehicles built before November 28,
2005 are equipped with seat position indicators. A
back cushion tilt position indicator and a fore/aft seat

5.2
Seats and Seat Belts

3 1
7

4
6 2
5 3
4
6 5
10/10/96 f910131
01/06/2006 1 f910565 1. Back Cushion Tilt Lever
1. Isolator and Fore/Aft Seat Adjustment Lever 2. Lumbar Support Switch (LSO models)
2. Armrest Adjustment Knob 3. Damper Adjustment Switch
3. Bottom Cushion Angle Guide 4. Weight and Height Adjustment Switch
4. Back Cushion Tilt Lever 5. Bottom Cushion Tilt Knob
5. Lumbar Support Switch 6. Fore and Aft Adjustment and Isolator Lever
6. Height Adjustment Switch 7. Lumbar Support Knob (non-LSO models)

Fig. 5.3, EzyRider Seat Adjustment Controls (Vehicles Fig. 5.4, Freightliner/Bostrom Seat Adjustment Controls
Built on or After November 28, 2005)
Weight and Height Adjustment
position indicator allow the driver to see where the
seat is adjusted within the adjustment ranges. To raise the seat, press the upper portion of the
weight and height adjustment switch. To lower the
Armrest Angle (optional armrests) seat, press the lower portion of the switch.

To adjust the vertical angle of the armrest, turn the Isolator


adjustment knob on the underside of the armrest.
To engage the isolator, put the isolator lever in the
Freightliner/Bostrom Seat center position. Lock out the isolator by moving the
lever to the right.
See Fig. 5.4 for seat adjustment controls.
Fore and Aft Seat Adjustment
Back Cushion Tilt Hold the fore and aft adjustment lever to the left and
To tilt the back cushion, lean forward slightly to re- slide the seat forward or backward to the desired po-
move pressure from the cushion and hold the back sition.
cushion tilt lever rearward. Lean backward slowly to
the desired position and release the lever to lock the Bottom Cushion Tilt Adjustment
cushion in place. Rotate the bottom cushion tilt knob to increase or
decrease bottom cushion tilt.

5.3
Seats and Seat Belts

Lumbar Support Height Adjustment


To increase lumbar support on LSO models, press To raise or lower the height of the seat, use the
the plus sign on the lumbar support switch. To de- height adjustment switch on the side of the seat.
crease lumbar support on LSO models, press the
minus sign on the switch. To increase lumbar support Fore and Aft Seat Adjustment
on non-LSO models, rotate the lumbar support knob
forward. To decrease lumbar support on non-LSO To adjust the fore and aft position of the entire seat,
models, rotate the knob rearward. move the fore and aft seat adjustment lever to the
left and slide the seat forward or backward to the
Damper Adjustment desired position. Move the lever back to its original
position to lock the seat in place.
Press the damper adjustment switch to adjust the
damper. Rear Cushion Adjustment
To adjust the height of the rear of the seat cushion,
National 2000 Series Seat remove your weight from the seat and turn the rear
See Fig. 5.5 for seat adjustment controls. cushion adjustment knob to one of three positions.

Isolator
Also called a Chugger Snubber, the isolator reduces
the amount of road shock by isolating the occupant
from the motion of the vehicle and allowing the seat
to move in a simple pendulum motion. To use the
isolator feature, turn the isolator handle to the hori-
7 zontal position. Turn the isolator handle down when
the isolator feature is not desired.

6 Lumbar Support
To adjust the lumbar support, use the lumbar support
switch on the side of the seat to give more or less
1 support to your lower back.
5
Bottom Cushion Front Height
4 2 To adjust the height of the front of the bottom cush-
3
ion, lift the bottom cushion front height adjustment
handle, and pull forward or push back to the desired
11/14/2000 f910445 setting.
1. Back Cushion Tilt Knob
2.
3.
Lumbar Support Switch
Height Adjustment Switch
Seat Belts and Tether Belts
4. Fore and Aft Seat Adjustment Lever General Information
5. Bottom Cushion Front Height Adjustment Handle
6. Isolator Handle Seat belt assemblies are designed to secure persons
7. Rear Cushion Adjustment Knob in the vehicle to help reduce the chance of injury or
the amount of injury resulting from accidents or sud-
Fig. 5.5, National 2000 Series Seat Adjustment Controls
den stops. For this reason, Daimler Trucks North
Back Cushion Tilt America LLC urges that the driver and all passen-
gers, regardless of age or physical condition, use
To tilt the back cushion, turn the back cushion tilt seat belts when riding in the vehicle.
knob until the desired position is reached.

5.4
Seats and Seat Belts

Inspect the seat belts and tether belts (if so


WARNING equipped).
Always use the vehicles seat belt system when 1. Check the web for fraying, cuts, extreme dirt and
operating the vehicle. Failure to do so can result dust, or for severe fading from exposure to sun-
in severe personal injury or death. light, especially near the buckle latch plate and in
the D-loop guide area.
Seat belt assemblies in Daimler Trucks North
America (DTNA) vehicles meet Federal Motor Ve- 2. Check operation of the buckle, latch, Komfort
hicle Safety Standard 209, "Type 1" and "Type 2" re- Latch or Sliding Komfort Latch (if equipped), web
quirements. retractor, and upper seat belt mount on the door
pillar. Check all visible components for wear or
When transporting a child, always use a child re- damage.
straint system or the vehicle seat belts as appropri-
ate. To determine whether a child restraint system is 3. Check the seat belt and tether belt connection
required, review and comply with applicable state points and tighten any that are loose.
and local laws. Any child restraint used must comply
with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213, Seat Belt Operation
"Child Restraint Systems." When providing a child
restraint system, always carefully read and follow all Three-Point Seat Belt With Komfort Latch
instructions pertaining to installation and usage for NOTE: For vehicles not equipped with the Kom-
the child. Make certain the child remains in the re- fort Latch, see the seat belt operation under the
straint system at all times when the vehicle is in mo-
heading "Three-Point Seat Belt."
tion.
In addition to seat belt assemblies, tether belts are WARNING
installed on suspension-type seats. Tether belts help
secure the seat to the floor and are intended to re- Wear three-point seat belts only as described
strain the seat and seat belt in case of an accident or below. Three-point seat belts are designed to be
sudden stop. worn by one person at a time. In case of an acci-
IMPORTANT: Seat belts have a finite life which dent or sudden stop, personal injury or death
may be much shorter than the life of the vehicle. could result from misuse.
Regular inspections and replacement as needed Fasten the seat belts before driving. Fastening a
are the only assurance of adequate seat belt three-point seat belt while driving creates a haz-
security over the life of the vehicle. ard.
1. Slowly pull the link end of the three-point seat
Seat Belt Inspection belt out of the retractor and pull it across your
lap (from outboard to inboard) far enough to en-
WARNING gage the buckle. If the retractor locks too soon,
allow the belt to retract slightly, then slowly pull it
Inspect and maintain seat belts. When any part of out again.
a seat belt system needs replacement, the entire
2. Fasten the three-point seat belt by pushing the
seat belt must be replaced, both retractor and
link into the buckle until it latches (Fig. 5.6). Give
buckle side. Any time a vehicle is involved in an
the belt a tug at the buckle. If the buckle un-
accident, and the seat belt system was in use,
latches, repeat this step. If the problem contin-
the entire vehicle seat belt system must be re-
ues, replace the three-point seat belt.
placed before operating the vehicle. Do not at-
tempt to modify the seat belt system; doing so 3. Position the shoulder strap diagonally across
could change the effectiveness of the system. your chest with the adjustable D-loop bracket (if
Failure to replace worn or damaged seat belts, or equipped). The shoulder strap must be centered
making any modifications to the system, may re- on your shoulder and chest, away from your face
sult in personal injury or death. and neck. See Fig. 5.7. If desired, engage the
Komfort Latch as follows.

5.5
Seats and Seat Belts

01/06/95 f910048a
A. 1 Inch (2.5 cm) Maximum
01/18/95 f910004a
Fig. 5.8, Adjusting Shoulder Harness Clearance
Fig. 5.6, Fastening the Three-Point Belt

A B C
08/09/2010 f910634

A. CorrectBelt is centered on your shoulder and


chest, away from your face and neck.
B. WrongBelt must not rub against face or neck. 11/02/95 f910144
C. WrongBelt must not hang off shoulder.
Fig. 5.9, Locking Komfort Latch
Fig. 5.7, Proper Shoulder Strap Fit
NOTE: The Komfort Latch does not have to be
Pull on the shoulder strap to lessen the pressure released in an emergency situation. The Kom-
of the strap on your shoulder and chest. Allow no
fort Latch will release by itself under rough road
more than 1 inch (2.5 cm) of slack between your
chest and the shoulder harness. More slack can or other abnormal conditions. Make sure the
significantly reduce the seat belts effectiveness three-point seat belt is completely retracted
in an accident or a sudden stop. While holding when it is not in use.
the belt slack, press the Komfort Latch lever up,
clamping the seat belt webbing (Fig. 5.8 and Three-Point Seat Belt
Fig. 5.9). NOTE: For vehicles equipped with the Komfort
4. To unbuckle the three-point seat belt, push the Latch, see the seat belt operation under the
button on the buckle as shown in Fig. 5.10. If the heading "Three-Point Seat Belt With Komfort
Komfort Latch was used, release it by giving the Latch."
shoulder belt a quick tug. If you lean forward
against the shoulder belt, the Komfort Latch will
automatically release, and will need to be reset.

5.6
Seats and Seat Belts

on your shoulder and chest, away from your face


and neck. See Fig. 5.7.
6. To unbuckle the three-point seat belt, press the
release button on the buckle; see Fig. 5.10.
NOTE: Make sure the three-point seat belt is
completely retracted when it is not in use.

Sleeper Compartment
Restraints
General Information
On vehicles equipped with a sleeper compartment,
bunk restraints should be used whenever the sleeper
compartment is occupied and the vehicle is moving.
01/18/95 f910049a Restraints are designed to lessen the chance of in-
jury or the amount of injury resulting from accidents
Fig. 5.10, Releasing the Three-Point Seat Belt or sudden stops. For this reason, Daimler Trucks
North America LLC urges the use of bunk restraints
WARNING when the sleeper compartment is occupied in a mov-
ing vehicle.
Wear three-point seat belts only as described
below. Three-point seat belts are designed to be WARNING
worn by one person at a time. In case of an acci-
dent or sudden stop, personal injury or death Do not use the sleeper compartment while the
could result from misuse. vehicle is in motion unless a bunk restraint is
installed and used. Not using the bunk restraint
Fasten the seat belts before driving. Fastening a
increases the chance of injury, or the degree of
three-point seat belt while driving creates a haz-
injury, from accidents or sudden stops to all oc-
ard.
cupants of the vehicle.
1. Slowly pull the link end of the three-point seat
belt out of the retractor and pull it across your Bunk Restraint Adjustment
lap (from outboard to inboard) far enough to en-
gage the buckle. If the retractor locks too soon, 1. Make sure the belt is attached to the bunk sup-
allow the belt to retract slightly, then slowly pull it port and sleeper wall.
out again. 2. To lengthen the belt, tip the link end downward
2. Fasten the three-point seat belt by pushing the and pull the link until it connects with the buckle.
latch into the buckle. Listen for an audible click. 3. After the belt is connected, shorten it by pulling
See Fig. 5.6. on the loose end until the belt is snug, but com-
3. Tug on the seat belt to make sure it is securely fortable. Be sure the belts are not twisted. See
fastened. If the buckle unlatches, repeat this Fig. 5.11.
step. If the problem continues, replace the three-
point seat belt. Bunk Restraint Operation
4. Snug the seat belt to your waist. 1. Starting at the foot of the bunk, pull up the link
end of the belt far enough to engage the buckle.
5. Position the shoulder strap diagonally across See Fig. 5.12.
your chest with the adjustable D-loop bracket (if
equipped). The shoulder strap must be centered 2. Fasten the belt by pushing the link end into the
buckle until they latch. Make sure that the belt is

5.7
Seats and Seat Belts

Supplemental Restraint
2
System, Optional
The supplemental restraint system can consist of an
A air bag and SPACE system, or an air bag only sys-
1
tem. Your vehicle may or may not have a supple-
3 mental restraint system.

Air Bag, Optional


01/06/95 f910068a
The air bag, when used with seat belts, provides ad-
A. Pull on the loose end to shorten the belt.
ditional protection to the driver in severe frontal colli-
1. Buckle 3. Link
sions. The operational readiness of the air bag sys-
2. Belt Release Button
tem is indicated by the supplemental restraint system
Fig. 5.11, Bunk Restraint Adjustment (SRS) indicator on the dash. The SRS indicator
comes on when the engine is started and then goes
off. The indicator will remain on if there is a problem
with the air bag system. The vehicle should be ser-
2 3 viced if the SRS indicator does not come on when
the engine is started or if the SRS indicator remains
on.

WARNING
Air bags are designed to inflate only in severe
frontal collisions. The driver and the passenger
should always wear seat belts. For maximum pro-
4 tection in a collision or rollover, always be in a
5 normal seated position with your back against
the seat back and your head upright. Fasten your
seat belt and ensure that it is properly positioned
1 on your body as described under the "Seat Belt
02/14/96 f910150 Operation" heading. Since the air bag inflates
1. Mattress 4. Belt Anchor with considerable speed and force, a proper seat
2. Sleeper Wall 5. Buckle position will keep you a safe distance from the
3. Restraint inflating air bag.
Fig. 5.12, Bunk Restraint Do not place objects on the steering wheel or be-
tween you and the steering wheel. Keep your
not twisted. Check the engagement by trying to hands on the sides and lower portion of the
pull the link out of the buckle. If they come apart, steering wheel. Any objects may cause harm dur-
repeat this step. If the problem continues, re- ing an accident.
place the belt. Repeat steps 1 and 2 for the
other two belts located in the middle and upper Failure to follow these instructions may result in
portion of the bunk to lock the restraint in place. death or personal injury.

3. To release the bunk restraint, push the release Air Bag Safety Guidelines
button on the buckle at the head of the bunk and
pull the link from the buckle. The air bag system contains components that use
combustible chemicals. Because these chemicals are
Repeat this step for the other two buckles to combustible, care must be taken when replacing or
completely release the bunk restraint. handling system components.

5.8
Seats and Seat Belts

connector from the system will disable the


WARNING safety shunt and could cause unintentional
deployment.
Consider undeployed air bags to be dangerous
and capable of deploying at any time. Do not at- Allow deployed air bag systems to cool
tempt to service the air bag system unless after deployment.
trained to do so. Damaged air bag systems Wear rubber gloves and safety glasses
should be examined by qualified personnel be- when handling a deployed air bag.
fore any attempt is made to remove or to deploy
the air bag. All intentional deployments and test- Wash your hands and exposed skin surface
ing of the system should be performed by trained areas immediately after handling a de-
personnel. Unintentional or improper air bag de- ployed system.
ployment could cause severe bodily injury or Store, transport, dispose of, and recycle
death. deployed air bag system components in
Do not attempt to disassemble the air bag inflator accordance with all applicable federal,
unit or breach the integrity of the sealed metallic state, and local regulations.
inflator case. Doing so could cause severe bodily The air bag module may contain perchlor-
injury or death. ate material: special handling may apply,
Do not allow system chemicals to contact other see www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/
liquids, combustibles, and flammable materials. perchlorate.
Doing so could cause chemical burns or per- Keep all heavy objects in the cab secured.
sonal injury.
The surface of the deployed air bag may contain SPACE System, Optional
small amounts of sodium hydroxide (which is a
by-product of the gas generant combustion) and The Seat Pretensioner Activation for Crash survival
metallic sodium. Sodium hydroxide may be irri- Enhancement (SPACE) system, when used with seat
tating to the skin and eyes. Always wear rubber belts, provides additional protection to the driver
gloves and safety glasses when handling a de- and/or passenger in severe frontal collisions.
ployed air bag. Immediately wash your hands and
The SPACE system provides a significant increase in
exposed skin areas with a mild soap and water.
seat stability during a severe, frontal collision. When
Flush your eyes immediately if exposed to so-
the SPACE module senses a severe, life-threatening
dium hydroxide.
frontal impact, the module triggers two gas-cylinders
Review and comply with the following list of mounted at the base of the seat. See Fig. 5.13. The
warnings. Failure to do so could result in severe gas cylinders activate the power cinches that then
injury or death. tighten the lap and shoulder belts against the occu-
pant of the seat and lower the seat suspension, mov-
Keep all liquids, acids, halogens, heavy
ing the occupant down and away from the steering
metals, and heavy salts away from the air wheel and ceiling. See Fig. 5.14. The air bag is acti-
bag system. vated simultaneously. This sequence of actions oc-
Do not cut, drill, braze, solder, weld, strike, curs in about a tenth of a second.
or probe any part of the air bag system.
Do not expose the air bag module to elec- WARNING
tricity. Never probe a circuit.
The SPACE system will activate during a severe,
Do not attempt to adapt, reuse, or install an frontal collision even if the seat belts are not fas-
air bag system in any vehicle other than the tened, but the SPACE system only provides pro-
specific vehicle for which it is designed. tection to the occupant when the seat belts are
Do not cut wires or tamper with the connec- fastened. Always use the seat belts when operat-
tor between the vehicle wiring harness and ing the vehicle. Failure to do so can result in se-
the air bag module. Cutting or removing the vere personal injury or death.

5.9
Seats and Seat Belts

1
3 2

1
2

8
3
A
2
4
1
5
5 6
B
4
7
09/03/97 f910172
1. Pretensioning Cable Tether
2. SPACE Module
3. Suspension Seat 07/29/97 f910235
4. Gas Cylinder A. Seat Tether Without the SPACE System
5. Sensor Bracket B. Seat Belt Assembly B-Pillar Components
1. Height Adjuster 5. Buckle
Fig. 5.13, SPACE System Components 2. Shoulder Loop 6. Buckle Cable
3. Seat Belt 7. SPACE Module
4. Latch 8. Seat Tether
WARNING
Fig. 5.14, SPACE System Seat Belt Assembly
Damaged seat belts or seat belts that were worn
in an accident must be replaced and their an- Safety Guidelines for the SPACE
choring points must be checked. Do not attempt
to modify the SPACE system. Doing so could System
change the effectiveness of the system. The The SPACE system contains components that use
SPACE system must be replaced after being acti- combustible chemicals. Because these chemicals are
vated. Failure to do so may result in personal in- combustible, care must be taken when replacing or
jury or death. handling system components.
Infants and children must not be placed in seats
equipped with the SPACE system. The SPACE WARNING
system is designed for adults only. Failure to fol-
low these instructions may result in personal in- Do not attempt to service the air bag/SPACE sys-
jury or death. tem. Damaged or deployed air bag/SPACE sys-
tems should be examined only by qualified per-
The operational readiness of the SPACE system is
sonnel before any attempt is made to remove,
indicated by the supplemental restraint system (SRS)
replace, or handle the air bag/SPACE system
indicator on the dash. The SRS indicator comes on
components. All intentional deployments and
when the engine is started and then goes off. The
testing of the system should be performed by
indicator will remain on if there is a problem with the
trained personnel. Unintentional or improper de-
air bag or SPACE system. The vehicle should be
ployment of the air bag/SPACE system could
serviced if the SRS indicator does not come on when
cause severe bodily injury or death.
the engine is started or if the SRS indicator remains
on.

5.10
Seats and Seat Belts

Do not attempt to service or to disassemble the


SPACE module. The SPACE module cannot be
serviced. Doing so could result in severe bodily
injury or death.
Although the air bag/SPACE system components
will not likely explode, self-deploy, or produce
shrapnel, take care when it is necessary to re-
place or perform work around the air bag/SPACE
system components. Review and comply with the
following list of warnings. Failure to do so could
result in severe injury or death.
Do not cut, drill, braze, solder, weld, strike,
or probe any part of the air bag/SPACE sys-
tem.
Keep all liquids, acids, halogens, heavy
metals, and heavy salts away from the air
bag/SPACE system.
Do not expose the air bag/SPACE system
components to electricity.
Do not attempt to adapt, reuse, or install an
air bag/SPACE system in any vehicle other
than the specific vehicle for which it is de-
signed.
Keep hands and tools away from the scis-
sor points under the seats.
Do not cut wires or tamper with the connec-
tors between the vehicle wiring harness
and the air bag/SPACE system. Cutting or
removing the electrical connectors could
cause unintentional deployment.
Do not expose the air bag/SPACE system to
electricity. Never probe a circuit.
Store, transport, dispose, and recycle de-
ployed air bag/SPACE system components
in accordance with all applicable federal,
state, and local regulations.
Replace damaged seat belts or seat belts
that were worn in an accident, and check all
anchoring points. Only qualified personnel
familiar with air bag/SPACE systems should
replace the seat belts used in a vehicle with
an air bag/SPACE system.
The air bag/SPACE system requires a spe-
cial seat belt. Care must be taken to be
sure the correct seat belt is used.
Keep all heavy objects in the cab secured.

5.11
6
Steering and Brake Systems
Steering System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1
Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1
Steering and Brake Systems

Steering System the vehicle until the cause of the problem has been
corrected.
General Information
When there is no load on the vehicle, and the front
WARNING
tires are pointed straight ahead, the steering wheel
Driving the vehicle without the power-assist fea-
spokes should be centered, 10 degrees, as shown
ture of the steering system requires much greater
in Fig. 6.1. See Group 46 of the Columbia Work-
effort, especially in sharp turns or at low speeds,
shop Manual for steering adjustment procedures.
which could result in an accident and possible
injury.
Drivers should carefully use the power available with
a power steering system. If the front tires become
lodged in a deep chuckhole or rut, drive the vehicle
out, instead of using the steering system to lift the
tires from the hole. Also, avoid turning the tires when
10 10 they are against a curb, as this places a heavy load
on steering components and could damage them.
1 2
Brake System
10 10
General Information
A dual air brake system consists of two independent
air brake systems that use a single set of brake con-
10/15/98 f461694 trols. Each system has its own reservoirs, plumbing,
1. 9 oClock 2. 3 oClock
and brake chambers. The primary system operates
the service brakes on the rear axle; the secondary
Fig. 6.1, Proper Steering Wheel Position (with tires system operates the service brakes on the front axle.
pointed straight ahead) Service brake signals from both systems are sent to
the trailer.
CAUTION
WARNING
Never steam clean or high-pressure wash the
steering gear. Internal damage to gear seals, and Do not operate the vehicle with the front brakes
ultimately the steering gear, can result. backed off or disconnected. Backing off or dis-
connecting the front brakes will not improve ve-
Power Steering System hicle handling and may lead to loss of vehicle
control, resulting in property damage or personal
The power steering system consists of an integral injury.
steering gear (which includes a manual steering
mechanism, a hydraulic control valve, and a hydrau- IMPORTANT: On TRACTORS, loss of air pres-
lic power cylinder), hydraulic hoses, power steering sure in the primary system causes the rear ser-
pump, reservoir, and other components. Some vice brakes to become inoperative; front brakes
models are also equipped with a separate hydraulic will continue to be operated by secondary sys-
power cylinder on the right side of the front axle. The tem air pressure. On TRUCKS, loss of air pres-
power steering pump, driven by the engine, provides sure in the primary system causes the rear
the power assist for the steering system. If the en- spring brakes to get modulated, controlled by a
gine is not running, there is no power assist. If the secondary air signal. In addition, on TRACTORS
power-assist feature does not work due to hydraulic and TRUCKS, trailer brakes will be operated by
fluid loss, steering pump damage, or some other
the secondary system.
cause, bring the vehicle to a safe stop. Do not drive

6.1
Steering and Brake Systems

Before driving your vehicle, allow time for the air After correcting the brake system problem, uncage
compressor to build up a minimum of 100 psi (689 the spring parking brakes before resuming normal
kPa) pressure in both the primary and secondary vehicle operation.
systems. Monitor the air pressure system by observ-
ing the dual system air pressure gauge and the low- Brake System Operation
air-pressure warning light and buzzer. The warning
light and buzzer shut off when air pressure in both IMPORTANT: Before driving the vehicle, secure all
systems reaches 64 to 76 psi (441 to 524 kPa). loose items in the cab so that they will not fly forward
during a full brake application. Make sure all passen-
The warning light and buzzer come on if air pressure gers are wearing seat belts.
drops below 64 to 76 psi (441 to 524 kPa) in either
system. If this happens, check the dual system air During normal brake stops, depress the foot brake
pressure gauge to determine which system has low control pedal until braking action slows down the ve-
air pressure. Although the vehicles speed can be hicle. Increase or decrease the pressure on the
reduced using the foot brake control pedal, either the pedal so that the vehicle comes to a smooth, safe
front or rear service brakes will not be operating, stop. Apply the spring parking brakes if the vehicle is
causing a longer stopping distance. Bring the vehicle to be parked.
to a safe stop, and have the air system repaired be- IMPORTANT: An air brake proportioning system
fore continuing. is used in tractor air brake systems when the
IMPORTANT: In the event of a total loss of ser- vehicle is not equipped with ABS. When operat-
vice brakes with full system air pressure, use ing in bobtail mode, the rear brake chambers
the parking brake control valve (yellow knob) to (whose axle load has been greatly reduced) re-
bring the vehicle to a complete stop in the saf- ceive reduced or proportional air pressure, while
est location possible. the front axle brake chambers receive full (nor-
On tractor-trailer vehicles, if both the primary and
mal) air pressure. This results in a different
secondary systems become inoperative, the trailer brake pedal "feel," as the pedal seems to re-
service brakes or spring parking brakes will automati- quire more travel and/or effort to slow or stop
cally apply when air pressure drops below 35 to 45 the vehicle. However, the air brake proportioning
psi (242 to 310 kPa). The tractor spring parking system actually improves vehicle control when
brakes will automatically apply when air pressure the tractor is in the bobtail mode of operation.
drops below 20 to 30 psi (138 to 207 kPa). On When the tractor is towing a trailer, the rear
straight trucks, spring parking brakes will apply when brake chambers will receive full (normal) appli-
air pressure drops below 20 to 30 psi (138 to 207 cation air pressure.
kPa). Do not wait for the brakes to apply automati-
cally. When the warning light and buzzer first come NOTE: If equipped with main and auxiliary
on, immediately bring the vehicle to a safe stop. Be- transmissions, do not shift both transmissions
fore continuing operation of the vehicle, correct the into neutral while the vehicle is rolling. Shifting
cause of the air loss. both transmissions back into gear would be diffi-
Before the vehicle can be moved, the spring parking cult while the vehicle is rolling.
brakes must be released by applying an external air The trailer brake hand control valve (Fig. 6.2) actu-
source at the gladhands, or by manually caging the ates the trailer service brakes independently from the
parking brake springs. vehicle chassis service brakes. The valve can be
partially or fully applied, but in any partially-on posi-
WARNING tion it will be overridden by a full application of the
foot brake control pedal. Moving the valve handle
Do not release the spring parking brakes and clockwise actuates the trailer brakes, while moving it
then drive the vehicle. There would be no means counterclockwise releases the trailer brakes. The
of stopping the vehicle, which could result in se- valve handle is spring-loaded and returns to its origi-
rious personal injury or vehicle damage. Before nal, no-air application position when released.
releasing the spring parking brakes, make the
connection to a towing vehicle or chock the tires.

6.2
Steering and Brake Systems

1
2 1
2

3 03/10/99 f610291

9/26/95 f461056 1. Trailer Air Supply Valve Knob


2. Parking Brake Valve Knob
1. Turn Signal Lever
2. Trailer Brake Hand Control Valve Fig. 6.3, Brake Valve Knobs
3. Hazard Warning Light Tab
vice brakes are wet. To do so could damage the
Fig. 6.2, Steering Column-Mounted Controls (left-hand
brakes if hot, or cause them to freeze during cold
drive shown)
weather.
If the brakes are wet, drive the vehicle in low
WARNING gear and lightly apply the brakes to heat and dry
them. Allow hot brakes to cool before using the
Do not use the trailer service brakes for parking;
spring parking brakes. Always chock the tires.
they are not designed for this purpose. If air
bleeds out of the trailer air tank during parking, If the trailer is not equipped with spring parking
the vehicle could roll, causing serious personal brakes, pulling out the yellow knob applies the tractor
injury or property damage. spring parking brakes and the trailer service brakes.
When the tractor and trailer parking brakes (or trailer
The red octagonal-shaped knob (Fig. 6.3) in the con-
service brakes) are both applied, the trailer brakes
trol panel actuates the trailer air supply valve. After
are released by pushing in the red knob, leaving the
the vehicles air hoses are connected to a trailer, and
tractor parking brakes applied. Air pressure in the
the pressure in both air systems is at least 65 psi
primary or secondary reservoir must be at least 65
(448 kPa), the red knob must be pushed in. It should
psi (447 kPa) before the tractor spring parking
stay in, to charge the trailer air supply system and to
brakes, or the trailer service or spring parking
release the trailer spring parking brakes. It must be
brakes, can be released.
pulled out before disconnecting a trailer. It must also
be pulled out when operating a vehicle without a On trailers not equipped with spring parking brakes,
trailer. If pressure in both air systems drops to 35 to chock the trailer tires before disconnecting the truck
45 psi (242 to 310 kPa), the red knob automatically or tractor when parking just the trailer.
pops out, exhausting the trailer air supply, and apply- When parking a truck or tractor with a trailer (combi-
ing the trailer service or spring parking brakes. nation vehicle), and the trailer is not equipped with
The yellow diamond-shaped knob (Fig. 6.3) in the spring parking brakes, apply the truck or tractor
control panel actuates the parking brake valve. Pull- spring parking brakes.
ing out the knob applies both the tractor and trailer
spring parking brakes and automatically causes the WARNING
trailer air supply valve knob to pop out.
If a trailer or combination vehicle is not equipped
CAUTION with spring parking brakes, do not park it by pull-
ing out only the trailer air supply valve knob.
Do not use the spring parking brakes if the ser- This would apply only the trailer service brakes.
vice brakes are hot, such as after descending a If air were to bleed from the trailer brake system,
steep grade. Also, do not use the spring parking the trailer brakes would release, possibly causing
brakes during freezing temperatures if the ser- an unattended runaway vehicle.

6.3
Steering and Brake Systems

After the ignition switch is turned on, the tractor


CAUTION warning light (TRACTOR ABS) and, if equipped with
Automatic Traction Control, the wheel spin (WHEEL
Never apply the service and spring parking SPIN) indicator light come on for about three sec-
brakes simultaneously. To do so transmits exces- onds. After three seconds, the warning lights go out
sive input force to the brake components, which only if all of the tractors ABS components are work-
could damage or cause eventual failure of brake ing.
actuating components.
Vehicles with electronic engines and ABS may have
Meritor WABCO Antilock Braking automatic traction control (ATC). On these vehicles,
the ATC system automatically limits wheel spin dur-
System (ABS) ing reduced-traction situations.
The Meritor WABCO Antilock Braking System (ABS) If the vehicle has ATC, there will be a momentary
is an electronic wheel speed monitoring and control contact rocker switch on the dash labeled NORM/
system that works with the standard air brake sys- SPIN and ATC.
tem. ABS passively monitors vehicle wheel speed at
When the ATC system is in the NORMAL mode, it
all times, and controls wheel speed during emer-
will apply gentle braking to the spinning wheel, to
gency stops. If equipped with Automatic Traction
feed power to the wheel(s) with better traction. If
Control, wheel spin is controlled during reduced-
both wheels are spinning, the system will signal the
traction situations. In normal braking applications, the
electronic engine to reduce power.
standard air brake system is in effect.
Pressing NORM/SPIN will temporarily allow more
IMPORTANT: For proper ABS system operation, drive wheel spin to help burn through a thin layer of
do not change tire sizes. The sizes of the tires ice, or to help throw off accumulated mud or snow.
installed during production are programmed into SPIN mode is indicated by a flashing WHEEL SPIN
the electronic control unit. Installing different- light. Pressing NORM/SPIN again will cycle the sys-
sized tires could result in a reduced braking tem back to normal operation.
force, leading to longer stopping distances. The Meritor WABCO ABS system combines one
ABS includes signal-generating tone wheels and sen- front-axle control channel with one rear axle to form
sors located in the wheel hubs of each sensed one control circuit. For example, the sensor and sole-
wheel. The sensors transmit vehicle wheel speed noid control valve on the left-front axle form a control
information to an electronic control unit (located on circuit with the sensor and solenoid control valve on
the frame rail). The control units main circuit inter- the right rear axle. If, during vehicle operation, the
prets the speed sensor signals and calculates wheel safety circuit senses a failure in any part of the ABS
speed, wheel retardation, and a vehicle reference system (a sensor, solenoid control valve, wiring con-
speed. If the calculations indicate wheel lockup, the nection, short circuit, etc.), the tractor warning light
main circuit signals the appropriate solenoid control (TRACTOR ABS) comes on and the control circuit
valve to reduce braking pressure. During emergency where the failure occurred is switched to normal
braking, the solenoid control valve alternately re- braking action. The remaining control circuit will re-
duces, increases, or maintains air pressure supply in tain the ABS effect. Even if the ABS system is com-
the brake chamber to prevent front and rear wheel pletely inoperative, normal braking ability is main-
lockup. tained. An exception would be if a solenoid control
valve (or combination solenoid control valve) is dam-
If equipped with Automatic Traction Control, an addi- aged and inoperative. As these components are an
tional solenoid valve is installed. During reduced- integral part of the air brake system, normal braking
traction situations, the valve increases or reduces air may be impaired or inoperative.
pressure supply in the brake chamber to provide bet-
ter traction whenever wheel spin occurs. IMPORTANT: If any of the ABS warning lights
The electronic control unit also has a safety circuit do not work as described above, or come on
that constantly monitors the wheel sensors, traction while driving, repair the ABS system immedi-
control valve (if equipped), solenoid control valves, ately to ensure full antilock braking capability.
and the electrical circuitry.

6.4
Steering and Brake Systems

During emergency or reduced-traction stops, fully as driver brake demand, wheel speed, and vehicle
depress the brake pedal until the vehicle comes to a load is gathered by a network of electronic sensing
safe stop; do not pumpthe brake pedal. With the devices (including load sensors, and signal generat-
brake pedal fully depressed, the ABS system will ing tone wheels and sensors located in the wheel
control all wheels to provide steering control and a hubs of each sensing axle).
reduced braking distance. An electronic control unit, the central module, over-
Although the ABS system improves vehicle control sees the translation of electronic signals into pneu-
during emergency braking situations, the driver still matic actuation. During a braking application,
has the responsibility to change driving styles de- electronic-pneumatic modulators control the brake
pending on the existing traffic and road conditions. pressure of each wheel, as well as at the trailer cou-
For example, the ABS system cannot prevent an ac- pling head. As a result, the same amount of vehicle
cident if the driver is speeding or following too deceleration will occur for a given brake pedal travel,
closely. regardless of vehicle load. During emergency stops
(i.e. wheel lockup), the EBS also activates the An-
Trailer ABS Lamp Operation tilock Braking System (ABS).
Antilock Braking Systems (ABS) on tractors are de- The EBS includes a system check for all modulators,
signed to communicate with trailer ABS systems, if sensors, brake system electric circuits and data lines
they are compatible. Compatibility will result in the and is thereby able to detect malfunctions in the
illumination of the trailer ABS lamp during vehicle braking system. When a fault is detected, the central
start-up and fault detection. module will disable the affected part of the EBS.
Under this safe status (i.e. fail-safe) mode, the nonaf-
The dash-mounted lamp will operate as follows when fected parts will continue to function. For example, in
a compatible trailer is properly connected to a tractor: the case of a sensor malfunction, the system works
When the ignition key is turned to the ON posi- without the sensor information but at a reduced per-
tion, the trailer ABS lamp will illuminate mo- formance level.
mentarily, then turn off. If a serious malfunction causes a total loss of one or
If the lamp comes on momentarily during ve- more electronic braking circuits, a pure pneumatic
hicle operation, then shuts off, a fault was de- backup system is available.
tected and corrected. The following functions can be deactivated in the
If the lamp comes on and stays on during ve- event of a malfunction:
hicle operation, there is a fault with the trailer ABS can be deactivated at one individual
ABS. Repair the trailer ABS system immedi- wheel, at one axle, or for the whole vehicle.
ately to ensure full antilock braking capability.
ATC control can be deactivated. If it is shut
The Trailer ABS lamp will not illuminate unless a down, then both the ATC brake control and the
compatible trailer is connected to the tractor. ATC engine control will be shut down.
IMPORTANT: If a compatible trailer is con- If electrical control is lost, the affected axle is
nected, and the lamp is not illuminating momen- braked by means of the pneumatic redundancy
tarily when the ignition key is turned to the ON pressure. The driver must compensate by ex-
position, it is possible that the lamp is burnt out. erting more force on the brake pedal to stop
the vehicle.
Meritor WABCO Electronic Braking This system has built-in diagnostics to ensure that all
System (EBS) components are operating properly. Under normal
conditions, the system performs a three second self-
The Meritor WABCO Electronic Braking System check when the ignition is turned on. The two warn-
(EBS) is designed to continuously monitor and coor- ing lamps (EBS, ABS) and the information lamp
dinate all aspects of service braking. (ATC) should illuminate for three seconds and then
The EBS pairs an electronic control system with a go out if all EBS components are working properly. If
pneumatic application system. Key braking data such all three lamps do not switch on or if all three lamps

6.5
Steering and Brake Systems

do not switch off after three seconds, the system


should be checked.
NOTE: If there is no bulb check and no dis-
played fault, most likely the brake pedal is par-
tially depressed, either by the driver or by some-
thing holding the pedal down. This safety
feature alerts the driver that the brake pedal is
not fully in the released position.

Automatic Slack Adjusters


Automatic slack adjusters are required on all vehicles
equipped with air brakes manufactured after October
20, 1994. Automatic slack adjusters should never be
manually adjusted except during routine maintenance
of the foundation brakes (e.g., replacing shoes), dur-
ing slack adjuster installation or in an emergency
situation.
When the brake pushrod stroke exceeds the legal
brake adjustment limit on a vehicle, there is likely a
mechanical problem with the foundation brake com-
ponents or the adjuster is improperly installed.
Visit a repair facility as soon as possible when
brakes equipped with automatic slack adjusters are
determined to be out of adjustment.

WARNING
Manually adjusting an automatic slack adjuster to
bring the pushrod stroke within legal limits is
likely masking a mechanical problem. Adjustment
is not repairing. In fact, continual adjustment of
automatic slack adjusters may result in prema-
ture wear of the adjuster itself. Further, the im-
proper adjustment of some automatic slack ad-
justers may cause internal damage to the
adjuster, thereby preventing it from properly
functioning.

6.6
7
Engines and Clutches
EPA07 Aftertreatment System (ATS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.1
DD15 Heavy-Duty Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.3
Engine StartingCAT, Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.6
Starting After Extended Shutdown or Oil ChangeCAT, Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.9
Engine Break-InCAT, Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.10
Engine OperationCAT, Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.10
Cold-Weather OperationCAT, Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.13
High-Altitude OperationCAT, Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.15
Engine ShutdownCAT, Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.15
Engine Braking SystemsCAT, Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.16
Exhaust Brake SystemCAT, Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.19
Clutches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.20
Engines and Clutches

EPA07 Aftertreatment System vehicle is driven normally under load; the driver is
not even aware that it is happening. The harder an
(ATS) EPA07 engine works, the better it disposes of soot,
as the exhaust heat alone is enough to burn the soot
On-road diesel engines built after December 31, to ash. Over the course of a workday, however, pas-
2006, are required to meet EPA07 guidelines for re- sive regeneration cannot always keep the ATD filter
duced exhaust emissions of particulate matter and clean, so the filter must undergo active regenera-
nitrogen oxides (NOx). NOx is limited to just over 1 tion. In active regeneration, extra fuel is injected into
gram per brake horsepower hour (g/bhp-hr), and par- the exhaust stream to superheat the soot trapped in
ticulate matter cannot exceed 0.01 g/bhp-hr. the DPF and turn it to ash. Active regeneration hap-
EPA07-compliant engines require ultralow-sulfur die- pens only when the vehicle is moving above a cer-
sel (ULSD) fuel, and they should never be run on tain speed, determined by the engine manufacturer.
fuel with sulfur content higher than 15 ppm. In addi- Consult manufacturers documentation for details.
tion, they require low-ash engine oil. The following Both active and passive regeneration happen auto-
guidelines must be followed, or the warranty may be matically, without driver input.
compromised.
NOTE: Caterpillar engines do not use a DOC;
Use ultralow-sulfur diesel (ULSD) with 15 ppm
CAT engines burn diesel fuel at the regeneration
sulfur content or less, based on ASTM D2622
test procedure. head to superheat the exhaust and burn the
trapped soot to ash. Engine software monitors
Do not use fuel blended with used engine lube and controls this process.
oil.
Only when operating conditions do not allow for ATD
Engine lube oil must have a sulfated ash level filter cleaning by at-speed active or passive regen-
less than 1.0 wt %, meeting the API CJ-4 index eration, the vehicle may require a parked regenera-
specifications. tion. The vehicle must be standing still, and the
IMPORTANT: Using non-specification fuels or driver must initiate the parked regen. Completing a
oils can lead to shortened diesel particulate filter parked regen takes 20 minutes to an hour, depend-
ing on ambient conditions.
(DPF) cleaning or exchange intervals. For ex-
ample, using CI-4+ oil with 1.3% sulfated ash
(30% more ash content) may result in the need DANGER
for DPF cleaning or exchange 20 to 30% sooner
During parked regeneration, exhaust tempera-
than would normally be required. tures are very high, and could cause a fire, heat
The "exhaust system" in EPA07-compliant vehicles is damage to objects or materials, or personal in-
called the aftertreatment system (ATS). The ATS var- jury to persons near the exhaust outlet.
ies according to engine manufacturer and vehicle Before initiating a parked regeneration, make cer-
configuration, but instead of a muffler, an aftertreat- tain the exhaust outlets are directed away from
ment system has a device that outwardly resembles structures, trees, vegetation, flammable materi-
a muffler, called the aftertreatment device (ATD). als, and anything else that may be damaged or
IMPORTANT: See the manufacturers engine injured by prolonged exposure to high heat.
operation manual for complete details and op- The warning lamps in the driver message center alert
eration of the aftertreatment system. the driver of a regen in progress, high exhaust tem-
Inside the ATD on Mercedes-Benz, Detroit Diesel, peratures, the need to perform a parked regen either
and Cummins engines, the exhaust first passes over soon or immediately, and of an engine fault that af-
the diesel oxidation catalyst (DOC), then it passes fects the emissions.
through the DPF, which traps soot particles. If ex- A slow (10-second) flashing of the high exhaust sys-
haust temperature is high enough, the trapped soot tem temperature (HEST) lamp indicates that a
is reduced to ash, in a process called passive regen- parked regeneration is in progress, and the engines
eration (regen). Passive regeneration occurs as the

7.1
Engines and Clutches

high idle speed is being controlled by the engine Fig. 7.2. A DPF lamp blinking at the same time as a
software, not the driver. steadily illuminated yellow Check Engine lamp, indi-
cates that a parked regen must be performed imme-
A steadily illuminated high temperature (HEST) lamp diately, or an engine derate will occur. If the red Stop
alerts the operator of high exhaust temperature dur- Engine lamp illuminates with the blinking DPF lamp
ing the regeneration process, if vehicle speed is and the Check Engine lamp, a parked regen must
below 5 mph (8 km/h). See Fig. 7.1. The HEST lamp occur or an engine shutdown will occur. Park the ve-
does not signify the need for any kind of vehicle or hicle and perform a parked regen. See Fig. 7.3.
engine service; it only alerts the vehicle operator of
high exhaust temperatures. Make sure the engine
exhaust pipe outlet is not directed at any person, or
at any surface or material that will melt, burn, or
explode.

09/25/2006 f610815a

Fig. 7.2, Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) Status Lamp

09/25/2006 f610816a

Fig. 7.1, High Exhaust System Temperature (HEST) CHECK STOP


Lamp

WARNING 1 2 3
03/20/2008 f611000
Active regeneration can occur automatically any- 1. Stop Engine Override Switch
time the vehicle is moving. The exhaust gas tem- 2. Amber Check Engine Warning Lamp
perature could reach 1500F (816C), which is hot 3. Red Stop Engine Lamp
enough to cause a fire, heat damage to objects
or materials, or personal injury to persons near Fig. 7.3, Engine Lamps
the exhaust outlet. See Regen-Inhibit Switch later A solid yellow malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) indi-
in this chapter for instructions on preventing au- cates an engine fault that affects the emissions. See
tomatic regen if necessary. Fig. 7.4.
The exhaust temperature can remain high even When diesel particulate filter servicing is needed, it
after the vehicle has stopped. When stopping the must be performed by an authorized technician, and
vehicle shortly after an automatic regen, ensure a record must be maintained for warranty purposes.
the exhaust outlets are directed away from struc- The record must include:
tures, trees, vegetation, flammable materials, and
anything else that may be damaged or injured by date of cleaning or replacement;
exposure to high heat.
vehicle mileage;
A steadily illuminated yellow diesel particulate filter
particulate filter part number and serial number.
(DPF) lamp indicates that a regen may be required
soon. Bring the vehicle to highway speeds to allow The regen switch (Fig. 7.5), located on the dash, is
for an active regen, or a parked regen should be used to initiate a parked regen of the aftertreatment
scheduled for the earliest convenient time. See device.

7.2
Engines and Clutches

09/25/2006 f610814a
07/30/2009 f610944

Fig. 7.4, Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)


Fig. 7.6, Regen-Inhibit Switch

Engine Protection
An engine protection system monitors all engine sen-
sors and electronic components, and recognizes sys-
tem malfunctions. If a critical fault is detected, an
amber Check Engine warning lamp and a red Stop
Engine lamp illuminate. See Fig. 7.3.

RGEN
The standard parameters that are monitored for en-
gine protection are: low coolant level, high coolant
temperature, low oil pressure, and high oil tempera-
ture.
03/09/2012 f610848

Fig. 7.5, Regen Switch


Amber Check Engine Warning Lamp
When the amber Check Engine warning lamp comes
NOTE: The regen switch can start a parked on for any reason, the vehicle can still be operated,
regen only when at least one of two conditions and the driver can proceed to the required destina-
exists: either the DPF light is illuminated, or the tion. See Fig. 7.3. This condition should be reported
engine software calls for it. If neither of those to an authorized service center as soon as possible.
conditions exist, the regen switch cannot cause
a regeneration to happen. Red Stop Engine Lamp
The regen-inhibit switch provides additional control When the red Stop Engine lamp comes on, the com-
over the aftertreatment regeneration process. The puter has detected a major malfunction in the engine
inhibit switch will stop a regeneration cycle in that requires immediate attention. See Fig. 7.3. It is
progress, and prevent the start of a regeneration the operators responsibility to shut down the
cycle until the switch is no longer active. See engine to avoid serious damage.This system fea-
Fig. 7.6. tures a 30-second, stepped-down power-shutdown
sequence, or an immediate emergency-running
mode, in the event that a major engine malfunction
DD15 Heavy-Duty Engine occurs. The conditions that will cause the red Stop
See Chapter 2 of this manual for information on the Engine lamp to come on are:
DDEC VI operator controls. See the Detroit Diesel high coolant temperature
DD15 Engine Operators Guide for complete details
of engine operation. loss of coolant
high oil temperature

7.3
Engines and Clutches

low oil pressure The DD15 engine provides horsepower through 2100
rpm, but fuel economy is not as efficient above 1800
auxiliary shutdown
rpm. If you decide to drive at lower rpm for improved
fuel economy, dont let different engine noises throw
Stop Engine Override Switch you off guard. The DD15 engine sounds quiet at
In the event that the vehicle is operating in a critical 1400 rpm, almost as if it had quit pulling. If you had
location when a shutdown is initiated, a Stop Engine a boost gauge to look at while driving, you would no-
Override (SEO) switch can be used to override the tice the turbocharger maintaining steady intake mani-
shutdown sequence. See Fig. 7.3. This override re- fold pressure, even as rpm falls. Depending on the
sets the shutdown timer, restoring power to the level air intake arrangement, you may also hear a "chuff-
when the red stop engine lamp was illuminated. The ing" sound as the engine starts to pull hard at lower
switch must be recycled after five seconds to obtain rpm. This is normal, and caused by the velocity
a subsequent override. changes of the air flow within the air intake plumbing.
Electronic engines can actually deliver more fuel at
lower engine speeds than at rated speed.
CAUTION
The DD15 engine has been designed for a very quiet
Using the override button so the engine operates operation, but the air flow may be noticeable to the
for an extended period may result in engine dam- tuned attentive ear. The turbocharger operates at
age. The operator has the responsibility to take higher boost pressure, forcing exhaust to flow
action to avoid engine damage. through the exhaust gas recirculation plumbing. In
some situations the driver may believe they have ex-
DDEC VI Driving Tips perienced a charge air cooler system leak. Even
while connecting trailer lights and air hoses, the
Accelerating the Vehicle driver may hear a different tone (exhaust and under
The accelerator pedal was designed to communicate hood with the engine idling). If equipped with a turbo
"percentage" of accelerator pedal travel to the engine boost gauge, the driver may occasionally note the
MCM. A throttle characteristic you may need time to intake manifold pressure exceeds 35 psi (241 kPa).
get used to, is the DDEC limiting speed governor.
This allows the driver to command total engine re- Idling
sponse between idle and rated speed, such as accel- The common belief that idling a diesel engine causes
erating at half throttlean advantage when driving no engine damage is wrong. Idling produces sulfuric
under slippery conditions. To obtain 100 percent fuel- acid, that is absorbed by the lubricating oil, and eats
ing at any speed, the accelerator pedal must be de- into bearings, rings, valve stems, and engine sur-
pressed to the fully pressed position. faces. If you must idle the engine for cab heat or
cooling, the high idle function of the cruise control
Shifting switches should be used. An idle speed of 900 rpm
Depending on your transmission model, the gear split should be enough to provide cab heat in above
may vary from 400 to 500 rpm. The electronic gover- freezing ambient temperatures.
nor provides almost no overrun capability; if the
transmission is downshifted too early, you will experi- Cold-Weather Operation
ence a temporary loss of pulling power until the en- Precautions must be taken during cold weather to
gine speed falls below rated speed. In general, when protect your engine. Special cold-weather handling is
using a 9-speed transmission, you should always required for fuel, engine oil, coolant, and batteries.
downshift between 1000 and 1100 rpm. This is true The engine does not require starting aids down to
even on steep grades with heavy loads. When using 50F (10C). A grid heater is included for tempera-
an 18-, 15-, or 13-speed transmission, you will need tures between 50F (10C) and 4F (20C). Tem-
to downshift at an rpm that allows "less than rated" peratures below 4F (20C), will require a grid
rpm, before throttle application in the next gear heater, block heater, and oil pan heater.
down. You may want to limit engine speed to 1900
rpm in all gears.

7.4
Engines and Clutches

use of the vehicle brakes will cause them to heat


CAUTION up, reducing their stopping ability. This condi-
tion, referred to as brake fade, may result in
NEVER use ether as a starting aid on a DD HD loss of braking, which could lead to loss of con-
engine. Doing so will result in injector damage. trol of the vehicle, resulting in personal injury or
A winterfront may be used to improve cab heating. At property damage.
least 25 percent of the grill opening should remain Use the following guidelines when descending a
open in sectioned stripes that run perpendicular to long, steep grade.
the charge air cooler tube flow direction. This as-
sures even cooling across each tube, and reduces Before beginning the descent, determine if
header-to-tube stress and possible failure. Winter- your engine brake system is operating prop-
fronts should only be used when the ambient tem- erly, by lifting your foot briefly off the accelera-
perature remains below 10F (12C). tor pedal. You should feel the system activate.
Ensure the progressive braking switch is in the
Driving on Flat, Dry Pavement appropriate power position. Check your pro-
Use the following guidelines when driving on flat, dry gressive braking switch often for proper posi-
pavement. tion, since road conditions can change quickly.
Never skip a step when operating the progres-
If driving on flat, dry, open stretches, with a sive braking switch. Always go from OFF to
light load, place the progressive braking switch LOW and then to a higher position when on
in the LOW position. slippery roads.
If you find you are still using the service Do not exceed the safe control speed of your
brakes, move the switch to a higher position vehicle. Example: You could descend a 6 per-
until you do not need to use the service brakes cent grade, under control at 10 mph (16 km/h)
to slow the vehicle. without an engine brake, but at 25 mph (40
If you are carrying a heavier load and road km/h) it requires an engine brake. You could
traction is good, move the progressive braking not descend that same hill at 50 mph (80
switch to the HIGH position. km/h) and still expect to remain under control.
Know how much slowing power your engine
Check your progressive braking switch often brake can provide before descending hills, and
for proper position, since road conditions can do not exceed a safe control speed.
change quickly. Never skip a step when oper-
ating the progressive braking switch. Always go Driving on Wet or Slippery Pavement
from OFF to LOW, and then to a higher posi-
tion.
WARNING
Descending a Long, Steep Grade To avoid injury from loss of vehicle control, do
An explanation of "control speed" may be helpful in not activate the engine brake system under the
understanding how to use the engine brake system following conditions:
while descending a grade. Control speed is the con- on wet or slippery pavement
stant speed at which the forces pushing the vehicle
forward on a grade, are equal to the forces holding it when driving without a trailer (bobtailing) or
back, without using the vehicle service brakes. In pulling an empty trailer
other words, this is the speed the vehicle will main-
if the tractor drive wheels begin to lock, or
tain without using the service brakes or throttle.
there is fishtail motion after the engine
brake is activated
CAUTION
Do not over apply the vehicle service brakes
when descending a long, steep grade. Excessive

7.5
Engines and Clutches

NOTE: On single trailers or combinations, a light If a vehicle does not start on the first attempt,
air application of the trailer brakes may be desir- make sure that the engine has completely
able to help keep the trailer stretched out. Fol- stopped rotating before reapplying the starter
low the manufacturers recommended operating switch. Failure to do so can cause the pinion to
procedure when using the trailer brakes. release and re-engage, which could cause ring
gear and starter pinion damage.
On wet or slippery pavement, start with the master
Moving a vehicle with the starter and/or using the
switch in the OFF position and use the gear you
starter to bump the engine for maintenance pro-
would normally use under these conditions. If the
cedures is strictly prohibited. Use of these meth-
vehicle is maintaining traction, place the selective
ods to bump the engine over or move the vehicle
braking switch in the LOW position and turn ON the
can cause the pinion to release and re-engage,
engine brake system. If the drive wheels are main-
which could cause ring gear and starter pinion
taining traction and you desire greater slowing power,
damage.
move the braking switch to the next higher position.
However, if the tractor drive-wheels begin to lock, or
there is a fishtail motion, turn the engine brake sys-
Prestart
tem OFF immediately and do not activate it until road NOTE: These prestart steps apply to all the fol-
conditions improve. lowing engines.
Check your progressive engine braking switch often 1. Before engine start-up, perform the engine pre-
for proper position, since road conditions can change trip inspection and daily maintenance checks in
quickly. Never skip a step when operating the pro- Chapter 11.
gressive braking system. Always go from OFF to
LOW and then to a higher position. See Chapter 2 2. Apply the parking brake.
for the proper operation of the engine brake. 3. For manual transmissions, place the transmis-
sion in neutral and step on the clutch pedal. Do
Engine StartingCAT, not push the accelerator pedal.
Cummins, DDE S60, M-B NOTE: On vehicles equipped with a neutral start
switch, the transmission must be in neutral be-
Normal Starting fore the engine can be started. For air start sys-
NOTE: Before starting the engine, read Chap- tems, check the air supply before starting the
engine. There must be 100 psi (689 kPa) of air
ter 2 for detailed information on how to read the pressure available.
instruments and operate the controls. Read the
operating instructions in the engine manufactur- Starting Precautions
ers operating manual before starting the en-
gine.
CAUTION
IMPORTANT: Ring gear and starter pinion dam-
age caused by improper starting procedures is Do not crank the engine for more than 30 sec-
not warrantable. onds at a time. Wait two minutes after each try to
allow the starter to cool. Failure to do so could
cause starter damage.
CAUTION
NOTE: Some starters are equipped with op-
When starting a vehicle equipped with a manual tional overcrank protection. If overcranking oc-
transmission and clutch lockout switch, the curs, a thermostat breaks the electrical circuit to
clutch pedal must be fully depressed during the the starter motor until the motor has cooled.
entire start sequence. Failure to do so can cause
the pinion to release and re-engage, which could
cause ring gear and starter pinion damage.

7.6
Engines and Clutches

2.1 If the engine does not start after 30 sec-


CAUTION onds of cranking, turn the ignition switch
off.
Protect the turbocharger during the start-up by
not opening the throttle or accelerating the en- NOTE: Some starters are equipped with op-
gine above 1000 rpm until normal engine idle oil tional overcrank protection. If overcranking
pressure registers on the gauge. occurs, a thermostat breaks the electrical
circuit to the starter motor until the motor
WARNING has cooled.
2.2 Wait two minutes to allow the starter
Never pour fuel or other flammable liquid into the
motor to cool. Turn the ignition switch
air inlet opening in the air intake in an attempt to
back to the on position and try again to
start the vehicle. This could result in a flash fire
start the engine.
causing serious personal injury or property dam-
age. 2.3 As soon as the engine starts, release the
ignition switch, allowing the engine to run
Caterpillar at a slow idle.
NOTE: Before doing these steps, do the steps
in "Prestart." CAUTION
1. Turn the ignition switch to the on position. See If the oil pressure is less than 5 psi (35 kPa), shut
Fig. 7.7. All the electronic gauges on the ICU down the engine immediately to prevent serious
(instrumentation control unit) complete a full damage. If the vehicle is equipped with an auto-
sweep of their dials, the warning and indicator matic shutdown system, the engine will shut
lights light up, and the buzzer sounds for 3 down after 30 seconds.
seconds.
3. Caterpillar C10/C12/C15/C16 engines may
be operated at low load and speed once the en-
gine oil pressure has reached 10 to 20 psi (69 to
138 kPa). Caterpillar 3406E engines may be op-
erated at low load and speed once the engine oil
pressure has reached 18 psi (124 kPa).
4. When the engine has reached the normal operat-
ing temperature of 189F (87C), the engine may
be operated at full load.

Detroit Diesel S60


OFF
ON
NOTE: Before doing these steps, do the steps
in "Prestart."
ACC START
1. Turn the ignition switch to the on position. See
Fig. 7.7. All the electronic gauges on the ICU
03/22/2001 f602079
(instrumentation control unit) complete a full
Fig. 7.7, Ignition Switch Positions sweep of their dials, the warning and indicator
lights light up, and the buzzer sounds for three
NOTE: The engine electronics supply the cor- seconds.
rect amount of fuel for starting the engine. Pedal 2. When all the indicators go out, turn the ignition
pressure is unnecessary. switch to the start position. Without touching the
2. Turn the ignition switch to the start position. Do throttle pedal, start the engine. If the engine
not press down on the throttle pedal. Release wont start within 15 seconds, release the ignition
the switch the moment the engine starts. switch and allow the starter motor to cool.

7.7
Engines and Clutches

IMPORTANT: If the engine wont start, check the sweep of their dials, the warning and indicator
main engine power fuses. The fuses are located lights light up, and the buzzer sounds for three
along the main engine electrical harness on the seconds.
left frame rail, near the batteries. If the fuses are IMPORTANT: On vehicles equipped with an in-
blown, replace the fuses. Be sure to find the take air preheater, the INTAKE HEATER indica-
cause of the blown fuses as soon as possible. tor stays on for a minimum of two seconds, re-
NOTE: Some starters are equipped with op- gardless of coolant temperature. Wait until the
tional overcrank protection. If overcranking oc- INTAKE HEATER indicator goes out before at-
curs, a thermostat breaks the electrical circuit to tempting to start the engine.
the starter motor until the motor has cooled. 2. Turn the ignition switch to the start position.
Without touching the throttle pedal, start the en-
WARNING gine.
NOTE: Some starters are equipped with op-
Never pour fuel or other flammable liquid into the
air inlet opening in the air intake in an attempt to tional overcrank protection. If overcranking oc-
start the vehicle. This could result in a flash fire curs, a thermostat breaks the electrical circuit to
causing serious personal injury or property dam- the starter motor until the motor has cooled.
age. 3. It is not necessary to idle the engine before en-
3. Check the oil pressure gauge immediately after gaging or starting the operation, but load should
starting the engine. be applied gradually during the warm-up period
until the oil temperature reaches 140F (60C).
4. If no pressure registers within 10 to 15 seconds
or the ENGINE PROTECT indicator comes on, 4. Check the oil pressure gauge for any drop in lu-
shut down the engine and check the lubricating bricating oil pressure or mechanical malfunction
oil system. in the lubricating oil system. Minimum oil pres-
sure at idle is 7 psi (50 kPa).
CAUTION
CAUTION
Protect the turbocharger during the start-up by
not opening the throttle or accelerating the en- Do not rev the engine if the oil pressure gauge
gine above 1000 rpm until minimum engine idle indicates no oil pressure. Shut down the engine
oil pressure of 12 psi (83 kPa) registers on the if no oil pressure appears within approximately
gauge. ten seconds. Check to determine the cause of the
problem. Operating the engine with no oil pres-
5. Idle the engine for about five minutes at 1000 sure will damage the engine.
rpm before operating the engine under load.

Mercedes-Benz
Cold-Weather Starting
Modern electronic engines do not normally require
NOTE: Before doing these steps, do the steps special starting aids. At low temperatures, oil pan
in "Prestart." heaters or water jacket heaters are sometimes used
to assist in starting.
CAUTION
Caterpillar
Never attempt to start any Mercedes-Benz elec-
tronic engine using ether or any other starting WARNING
fluid. Serious engine damage could result.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the on position. See If using a cold-weather-start system, be sure to
Fig. 7.7. All the electronic gauges on the ICU follow the manufacturers instructions regarding
(instrumentation control unit) complete a full

7.8
Engines and Clutches

its use, handling, and storage. Many starting flu- Mercedes-Benz


ids are in capsules or pressure cans, and im-
proper usage can be dangerous.
CAUTION
Do not attempt to use any type of vapor-
compound start system near heat or open flame. Never attempt to start any Mercedes-Benz elec-
Engine damage due to an explosion or fire in the tronic engine using ether or any other starting
intake manifold could result. fluid. Serious engine damage could result.
Do not breathe the ether fumes; doing so could The intake air preheater is activated by turning the
result in personal injury. ignition switch to the on position. See Fig. 7.7. If the
engine is at normal temperature, the INTAKE
Turn the ignition switch to the on position. See HEATER indicator goes out after two seconds.
Fig. 7.7.
If the temperature is low enough to require the
If the engine doesnt start after 30 seconds of crank- heater, the INTAKE HEATER indicator stays on while
ing, turn the key to the off position and wait two min- the intake air preheater warms up. After the indicator
utes; then repeat the starting procedure. goes out, start the engine. If the engine doesnt start
If the coolant temperature is less than 64F (18C), after about 30 seconds of cranking, turn the key to
the engine will start up in the cold-start strategy. This the off position and wait two minutes; then repeat the
reduces the amount of fuel available to the injectors, starting procedure.
advances the timing, and controls white smoke emis- NOTE: If the engine doesnt start on the second
sions. The engine remains in the cold-start strategy
until the coolant temperature rises above 64F
try, wait at least five minutes before using the
(18C), or until it has been running for 12 minutes. intake air preheater again.
IMPORTANT: Do not move the vehicle when it Starting After Extended
is in the cold-start strategy. Power will be notice-
ably reduced. Shutdown or Oil ChangeCAT,
After a cold engine start of less than 64F (18C), Cummins, DDE S60, M-B
Caterpillar electronic engines automatically idle at
An engine in storage for an extended period of time
800 rpm (for C10 and C12 engines), or 600 rpm
(over winter, for example) may accumulate water in
(for 3406E, C15, and C16 engines). These elec-
the oil pan. Oil diluted by water cannot provide ad-
tronic engine systems will adjust the idle speed to
equate bearing protection at start-up. For this reason,
700 to 750 rpm when the engine is warm enough to
change the engine oil and filters after extended
drive the vehicle.
storage.
Detroit Diesel S60 Do the following steps after an oil change or after the
engine has been shut down for more than three
The engine may require the use of a cold-weather
days:
starting aid if the outside temperature falls below
40F (4C). 1. Make sure the transmission is filled with the cor-
rect type of fluid, as recommended by the trans-
Turn the ignition switch to the on position and start
mission manufacturer.
the engine.
2. Make sure the fuel tank is full. If air has entered
If the engine doesnt start after 30 seconds of crank-
the fuel system, prime the fuel system, using the
ing, turn the key to the off position and wait two min-
engine manufacturers instructions.
utes; then repeat the starting procedure.
3. If the engine is equipped with a fuel/water sepa-
Run the engine slightly above idle until oil pressure
rator, drain off any accumulated water.
shows on the gauge. If oil pressure doesnt show on
the gauge within 30 seconds of starting, turn the key 4. Check the drive belts to make sure they are in
to the off position and wait one minute; then repeat good condition and properly adjusted. Replace
the starting procedure. any drive belts that are cracked, worn, or glazed.

7.9
Engines and Clutches

5. Check the turbocharger for signs of oil or ex-


haust leaks. Correct any problems before starting
Engine OperationCAT,
the engine. Cummins, DDE S60, M-B
6. Check the engine mounting bolts for tightness. Safety and Environmental
Retighten them if necessary.
Considerations
7. Make sure the battery cable connections are
clean and tight. Check that the batteries are WARNING
charged.
8. Start the engine. See "Engine Starting". Do not operate the engine in an area where flam-
mable vapors such as gasoline or diesel fumes
are present. Shut off the engine when in an area
Engine Break-InCAT, where flammable liquids or gases are being
Cummins, DDE S60, M-B handled. Failure to observe these precautions
could result in serious injury or death.
Caterpillar Operating vehicles with diesel engines in areas
Every Caterpillar engine must pass a full-load opera- where there are concentrated flammable vapors
tion test on a dynamometer before shipment, elimi- (such as diesel, gasoline, natural gas, or propane
nating the need for a break-in period. Only an initial fumes) can create a hazardous situation. These va-
operational check is necessary. pors can be drawn into the engine through the air
intake, and cause engine overspeed. Be especially
Cummins cautious of low-lying or closed-in areas, and always
check for signs posted where flammable vapors may
Cummins engines are run on a dynamometer before be present.
being shipped from the factory. They do not require a
break-in period. All diesel engines for these vehicles have been built
to comply with the requirements of the Federal (U.S.)
Detroit Diesel S60 Clean Air Act. Once an engine is placed in service,
the responsibility for meeting both state and local
Detroit Diesel S60 engines can be put to work upon regulations is with the owner/operator.
delivery without having to follow a formal break-in It is extremely important to use the correct fuel for
schedule. The engine has been "run-in" on a factory EPA07-compliant engines. The following require-
dynamometer during performance and quality assur- ments must be met, otherwise damage can occur to
ance tests prior to shipment. the aftertreatment device, and the warranty may be
compromised.
Mercedes-Benz
Use ultralow-sulfur diesel (ULSD) with 15 ppm
Each Mercedes-Benz engine must pass a full-load sulfur content or less, based on ASTM D2622
operating test on a dynamometer before shipment, test procedure.
thereby eliminating the need for a break-in. Before
running the engine for the first time, follow the in- Do not use fuel blended with used engine lube
structions in Chapter 2 of the MBE4000 Engine Op- oil.
erators Manual. Engine lube oil must have a sulfated ash level
less than 1.0 wt %, meeting the API CJ-4 index
specifications.
Adequate maintenance of the engine and the diesel
particulate filter are the responsibility of the owner/
operator, and are essential to keep the emission lev-
els low. Good operating practices, regular mainte-
nance, and correct adjustments are factors that will
help to stay within the regulations.

7.10
Engines and Clutches

General Information
See the manufacturers engine operation manual 1
for specific reccomendations for your engine.
2
1. Operate the engine at low load when the engine
3
is first started. After normal oil pressure is
reached and the temperature gauge needle be- 0 10 20 30 40 50 60
gins to move, the engine may be operated at full (16) (32) (48) (64) (80) (97)
load. 4
11/02/95 f250319
Electronic engines automatically idle at a slightly
higher speed for the correct warm up time after a 1. Governed RPM
cold engine start. These electronic engine sys- 2. Engine RPM
tems will reduce the idle speed to normal rpm 3. Idle RPM
when the engine has warmed sufficiently to oper- 4. Miles (kilometers) per Hour
ate the vehicle. Fig. 7.8, Progressive Shift Pattern
2. Select a gear that allows a smooth, easy start
operated in a lower gear with reserve power
without increasing engine speed above low idle
available for changes in terrain, wind, etc.
or slipping the clutch. Engage the clutch
smoothly. Jerky starts waste fuel and put stress
on the drivetrain.
Driving on Hills
1. When approaching a hill, open the throttle
3. It is seldom necessary to accelerate the engine
smoothly to start the upgrade at full power, then
to governed speed in the lower gears to get the
shift down as desired, to maintain the optimum
vehicle moving, except in a high-power-demand
vehicle speed.
situation such as starting on a grade. To con-
serve fuel, start off in low gear, and develop only NOTE: A momentary hesitation in throttle re-
the engine speed needed to get rolling. Then, sponse will occur when a vehicle with a turbo-
increase engine speed gradually as upward gear charged engine is started on a grade. Do not
shifting progresses. This technique will get the disengage the clutch. The rpm will recover, and
vehicle up to the desired cruising speed while the vehicle will accelerate up the grade.
minimizing noise emission and maximizing fuel
2. On uphill grades, begin downshifting when the
economy. A progressive shift pattern is illustrated
engine rpm falls to 1200 rpm. Fuel economy will
in Fig. 7.8.
be best if you let the engine lug back to around
Electronic engines can be programmed to limit this speed before you downshift. Downshift until
engine rpm while the vehicle is operated in the a gear is reached in which the engine will pull
lower and higher gears. This feature assists the the load. Let the engine lug down if you can
driver in following "progressive shifting" make it to the top of a hill without downshifting.
techniques.
3. If going up a hill causes a steady decline in en-
4. For highway cruising, and for best fuel economy, gine rpm, downshift as required until the engine
run the engine at 80 to 90 percent of rated rpm can maintain a stable uphill speed. Make full use
to maintain highway speed. Proper gear selec- of each gear before going to a lower gear. By
tion should permit cruising in the economy range remaining in a gear until arriving at the speed of
with no appreciable sacrifice in desired highway the next lower gear, the vehicle will top the grade
speed. in the best possible time on less fuel and fewer
It is okay to operate below rated rpm at full shifts.
throttle if you are satisfied with the way the ve- 4. The driver can greatly improve driving skill by
hicle performs. However, there are times when learning the vehicles shift points for all gears. By
hilly terrain, high winds, or other conditions make knowing rather than guessing where the shift
it impractical to operate without reserve power. points are, it is possible to avoid overspeeding
Such conditions are better met if the vehicle is

7.11
Engines and Clutches

the engine when downshifting too soon or miss- rpm. However, during engine braking only, a
ing the full use of a gear by downshifting too higher rpm can be used to increase retarding
late. The shift points of any vehicle can be deter- power, if necessary. When using the engine
mined by a simple road-test method. Run the brake it is recommended to use engine speeds
vehicle, and determine the maximum road speed up to 2300 rpm. The engine provides maximum
possible in every gear at the engine governed
braking effect when running at 2500 rpm, but it
full-load speed setting.
must not be allowed to exceed this speed.
The top road speed possible in a gear would be
the shift point for that gear. The results should be 9. Continue to downshift as further reduction in ve-
recorded in the proper order of shifting and dis- hicle speed is required. If the vehicle is above
played inside the cab. the allowable maximum speed of a lower gear,
use the service brakes to slow the vehicle to an
5. For improved operating efficiency (fuel economy acceptable speed where the transmission may
and engine life), operate in the higher gear at be downshifted safely. Again, the importance of
reduced rpm, rather than in the next lower gear knowing the shift points is demonstrated.
at the maximum rpm.
6. Cruise at partial throttle whenever road condi- Idling
tions and speed requirements permit. This driv-
ing technique permits operating within the most CAUTION
economical power range of the engine.
Do not idle the engine for excessively long peri-
7. The diesel engine is effective as a brake on ods. Long periods of idling are not good for an
downhill grades, but care must be used not to engine because the combustion chamber tem-
overspeed the engine going downhill. The gover- peratures drop so low the fuel may not burn
nor has no control over engine speed when the completely. This will cause carbon to clog the
engine is being turned by the loaded vehicle. A injector spray holes and piston rings, and may
simple rule to follow for engine braking is to se- result in stuck valves.
lect the same gear (or one gear lower) that
would be needed to go up the grade. The common belief that idling a diesel engine causes
no engine damage is wrong. Idling produces sulfuric
Never turn off the ignition switch while going
acid, which breaks down the oil and eats into bear-
downhill.
ings, rings, valve stems, and engine surfaces. If you
IMPORTANT: Do not let Caterpillar C10, C12, must idle the engine for cab heat or cooling, the high
C15, C16, and 3406E electronic engines ex- idle function of the cruise control switches should be
ceed 2300 rpm (2100 rpm if equipped with an used. An idle speed of 900 rpm should be enough to
exhaust brake). provide cab heat in above 32F (0C) ambients.

CAUTION WARNING
Do not allow the engine to exceed its governed Do not leave the vehicle unattended with the en-
speed, or serious engine damage could result. gine running. If you leave the vehicle and the en-
gine is running, the vehicle can move suddenly,
8. To slow the vehicle on downgrades and curves which could result in personal injury or property
(using the engine), shift to a lower gear, and damage.
allow the vehicle to decelerate in that gear. The
engine provides maximum braking effect when If the engine is programmed with the idle shutdown
running at the top end of the operating range, timer, ninety seconds before the preset shutdown
but it must not be allowed to exceed its full-load time, the CHECK ENGINE light will begin to flash at
rated rpm. a rapid rate. If the position of the clutch pedal or ser-
vice brake changes during this final ninety seconds
IMPORTANT: For Mercedes-Benz engines, the (CHECK ENGINE lamp flashing) the idle shutdown
maximum speed in regular operation is 2000 timer will be disabled until it is reset.

7.12
Engines and Clutches

Cold-Weather OperationCAT, 1. Check for cracks in the battery cases, for corro-
sion of the terminals, and for tightness of the
Cummins, DDE S60, M-B cable clamps at the terminals.
Satisfactory performance of a diesel engine operating 2. Charge the batteries to full capacity. Replace any
in low ambient temperatures requires modification of battery that is unable to hold full charge or is
the engine, surrounding equipment, operating prac- physically damaged.
tices, and maintenance procedures. The lower the 3. Check the alternator output.
temperatures, the greater the amount of modification
required; and yet with the modifications applied, the 4. Check the condition and tension of the drive
engines must still be capable of operation in warmer belts.
climates without extensive changes.
The following information is provided to engine own-
Caterpillar
ers, operators, and maintenance personnel on how If the engine is in good mechanical condition and the
the modifications can be applied to get satisfactory precautions necessary for cold-weather operation are
performance from their diesel engines. taken, ordinary cold weather will not cause difficulty
There are three basic objectives: in starting or loss of efficiency.

Reasonable starting characteristics followed by If the engine does not start, prime the fuel system.
practical and dependable warm-up of the en- When the use of unblended No. 2 diesel fuel in win-
gine and equipment. ter cannot be avoided, install a thermostatically con-
trolled fuel heater. Fuel heaters can prevent wax
A unit or installation that is as independent as
from clogging the fuel filters and formation of ice
possible from external influences.
crystals from water in the fuel.
Modifications that maintain satisfactory operat-
ing temperatures with a minimum increase in
IMPORTANT: If a fuel heater is used, make sure
maintenance of the equipment and accesso- it has thermostatic controls to prevent excessive
ries. heating of the fuel in warm weather. Excessive
heating of fuel can cause a loss of engine
If satisfactory engine temperature is not maintained, power.
higher maintenance cost will result due to increased
engine wear. Special provisions to overcome low For cold weather operation, use the following guide-
temperatures are definitely necessary, whereas a lines:
change to a warmer climate normally requires only a 1. When starting the engine in temperatures below
minimum of revision. Most of the accessories should 32F (0C), use engine lubricants of lower vis-
be designed in such a way that they can be discon- cosity. Refer to the Caterpillar Operation and
nected so there is little effect on the engine when Maintenance Manual for specifications.
they are not in use.
2. When the temperature is below freezing, use suf-
IMPORTANT: If a winterfront is used on a ve- ficient antifreeze solution in the cooling system to
hicle with an electronic engine equipped with a prevent freezing.
charge air cooler, make sure that there are slit
3. During cold weather, give more attention to the
openings distributed across the face of the win-
condition of the batteries. Test them frequently to
terfront to allow airflow through the entire ensure sufficient power for starting. See Group
charge-air-cooler core. Do not use a winterfront 15 of the Century Class Trucks Workshop
with closed areas that block uniform air flow Manual for detailed information.
across any sections of the charge-air-cooler
crossflow tubes. This will adversely affect the 4. If so equipped, turn off the battery disconnect
operation and durability of the charge air cooler. switch after the engine is shut down, to prevent
battery discharge.
On all engines, the following steps are necessary
For starting below 0F (18C), an optional cold-
when operating in cold weather:
weather starting assist is recommended. For

7.13
Engines and Clutches

temperatures below 10F (23C), consult your Arctic specifications refer to the design of material
Caterpillar dealer for recommendations. and specifications of components necessary for sat-
isfactory engine operation in extremely low tempera-
5. When customer parameters include cold-mode tures to 65F (54C). Contact the nearest Freight-
operation and the coolant temperature is below liner dealer or Cummins engine dealer, to obtain the
82F (28C), the system puts the engine into special items required.
cold mode. It adjusts the low idle to 600 rpm for
the 3406E, C15, and C16 engines, and 800
rpm for the C10 and C12 engines. It also ad- CAUTION
vances the timing, to reduce white smoke emis-
sions and improve warm-up time. The system will "Antileak" antifreezes are not recommended for
keep the engine in cold mode until the coolant use in Cummins engines. Although these anti-
temperature rises above 82F (28C). After cold freezes are chemically compatible with DCA
mode has been completed, operate the vehicle water treatment, the "antileak" agents may clog
at low load and low rpm until the engine coolant the coolant filters.
reaches normal operating temperature of 189F IMPORTANT: Fuel heaters used on vehicles
(87C). with Cummins CELECT Plus engine systems
6. Fuel cloud point is the temperature at which wax could cause high fuel temperatures that affect
crystals become visible, which is generally above engine performance and operation of the elec-
the pour point of the fuel. To keep the fuel filter tronic engine controls. If a fuel heater is used,
elements from plugging with wax crystals, the make sure it has thermostatic controls. If the
cloud point should be no higher than the lowest fuel heater has a timer, set the timer to activate
ambient temperature at which the engine must only for a limited period of time before the en-
start.
gine starts. Make sure the fuel heater is used
Cummins only for starting the engine.
For more information, see the Cummins Operation
The two most commonly used terms associated with and Maintenance Manual.
preparation of equipment for low-temperature opera-
tion are "winterization" and "arctic specifications." DDE S60
Winterization of the engine and/or components, so
that starting and operating are possible in the lowest Preparations made in advance of winter and mainte-
temperature to be encountered, requires: nance performed during the cold months will help to
ensure efficient engine starting and operation.
Proper lubrication with low-temperature lubri-
cating oils. Engine oil thickens as it gets colder, slowing
cranking speed. When cold, multi-grade oil of-
Protection from the low-temperature air. The fers less resistance to the cranking effort of the
metal temperature does not change, but the engine and permits sufficient rpm to be devel-
rate of heat dissipation is affected. oped to start the engine. See "How to Select
Fuel of the proper grade for the lowest tem- Lubricating Oil" in the Detroit Diesel Engine
perature. Operators Guide for specific recommenda-
tions.
Heat to raise the engine block and component
When an engine equipped with a DDEC sys-
temperatures to at least 25F (32C) for
starting in lower temperatures. tem is started at temperatures below 25F
(4C), the idle speed automatically increases
Electrical equipment capable of operating in to 900 rpm. The injection timing is also ad-
the lowest expected temperature. All switches, vanced to decrease white smoke. As the en-
connections, and batteries in the electrical sys- gine oil warms up, the idle speed gradually de-
tem should be inspected and kept in good con- creases. When the oil temperature reaches
dition to prevent losses through poor contacts. 122F (50C), both the idle speed and the in-
jection timing return to normal.

7.14
Engines and Clutches

A winterfront may be used to improve cab


heating while idling. At least 25% of the grille WARNING
opening should remain open in sectioned
stripes that run perpendicular to the charge air The addition of kerosene lowers the flash point
cooler tube flow direction. This assures even of diesel fuel. To prevent fire and risk of injuries
cooling across each tube and reduces header- due to burning, do not smoke or use open flames
to-tube stress, and possible failure. Winter- around fuel mixed with kerosene. Comply with all
fronts should only be used when the ambient appropriate safety regulations.
temperature remains below 10F (12C). 4. When winter-grade diesel fuel is not adequate, it
During cold weather, the batteries should be is possible to mix kerosene with the diesel fuel. If
tested more frequently to ensure ample power it is an EPA07 engine, ultralow-sulphur kerosene
for starting. All electrical connections should be must be used. Add the kerosene only when refill-
tight and in good condition to prevent losses ing the tank, and before adding the diesel fuel.
through loose or corroded connections. NOTE: Engine power may drop according to the
Ethylene-glycol-base antifreeze is recom- proportion of kerosene. For this reason, never
mended. An inhibitor system is included in this add more than 50 percent kerosene to the fuel.
type of antifreeze, and the corrosion protection
is sufficient as long as the recommended con-
centration range of 30 to 67 percent (antifreeze
High-Altitude OperationCAT,
to water by volume) is employed. Cummins, DDE S60, M-B
If the engine is to be operated in arctic tem- Engines lose horsepower when operated at high alti-
peratures, consult the nearest Freightliner tude because the air is too thin to burn as much fuel
dealer or an authorized Detroit Diesel engine as at sea level. This loss is about three percent for
dealer for information regarding availability of each 1000 feet (300 m) altitude above sea level for a
special cold-weather equipment. naturally aspirated engine. Most turbocharged en-
gines are rated for higher altitudes than naturally as-
Mercedes-Benz pirated engines.
Special precautions must be taken during cold An engine will have smoky exhaust at high altitudes
weather. For service products to use in cold weather, unless a lower gear is used. The engine will not de-
see Chapter 5 of the MBE4000 Engine Operators mand full fuel from the fuel system unless the engine
Manual. is altitude-compensated by the use of a turbocharger.
Shift gears as needed to avoid excessive exhaust
IMPORTANT: At outside temperatures below smoke.
4F (20C), a coolant preheater is recom-
mended. There is no restriction with respect to altitude opera-
tion for Mercedes-Benz MBE4000 engines. These
1. Periodically check the coolant mixing ratio (con- engines will perform properly between sea level and
centration of antifreeze in the coolant). Add more 13,000 ft (4000 m) above sea level.
if necessary. The coolant mixing ratio should
never rise above 60 percent antifreeze.
Engine ShutdownCAT,
2. Use low-viscosity lubricating oils for adequate
lubrication.
Cummins, DDE S60, M-B
3. At temperatures below 32F (0C), do not use Caterpillar
summer-grade (2-D) diesel fuel. To avoid fuel
problems due to paraffin separation, use winter- CAUTION
grade (1-D or winterized 2-D) diesel fuel only.
Stopping the engine immediately after it has been
working under load can result in overheating and

7.15
Engines and Clutches

accelerated wear of the engine components. Ex- 2. Allow the engine to run at idle for four to five
cessive temperatures in the turbocharger center- minutes. This allows the engine to cool and the
housing will cause oil coking problems. Follow turbocharger to slow down.
the procedure, outlined below, to allow the en-
gine to cool. CAUTION
1. With the vehicle stopped, apply the parking
brakes. Reduce the engine speed to low idle. After high-speed operation, shutting down the
engine without idling may cause damage to the
2. Place the transmission shift lever in neutral. turbocharger, as it will continue to turn without
NOTE: If the engine has been operating at low an oil supply to the bearings.
loads, run it at low idle for 30 seconds before 3. Turn off the ignition switch and shut down the
stopping. If the engine has been operating at engine.
highway speed or at high loads, run it at low
idle for three minutes to reduce and stabilize Mercedes-Benz
internal engine temperatures before stopping. 1. With the vehicle stopped, apply the parking
3. Turn off the ignition switch and shut down the brakes and put the transmission in neutral.
engine. 2. Allow the engine to idle for one to 2 minutes be-
4. After engine shutdown, fill the fuel tank. fore shutting it down.
5. Check the crankcase oil level. Maintain the oil 3. Shut down the engine by turning off the ignition.
level between the add and full marks on the dip-
stick. Engine Braking SystemsCAT,
6. If equipped with an idle shutdown timer, it can be Cummins, DDE S60, M-B
set to shut the engine down after a preset
amount of time. Ninety seconds before the pre- Several types of engine braking systems are option-
set shutdown time, the CHECK ENGINE light will ally available. Each of these systems uses the en-
begin to flash at a rapid rate. If the clutch pedal gine to retard the vehicle on downgrades and re-
or service brake indicate a position change dur- duces the heat load on the service brakes. The
ing this final ninety seconds (diagnostic lamp engine brakes are meant to be auxiliary vehicle brak-
flashing), the idle shutdown timer will be disabled ing systems in addition to the regular service brakes.
until reset.
7. If freezing temperatures are expected, allow the
Jacobs Engine Brake
engine jacket water expansion tank to cool, then A Jacobs engine brake is a hydraulic-electric engine
check the coolant for proper antifreeze protec- attachment that converts a diesel engine into an air
tion. The cooling system must be protected compressor. This is done by changing engine ex-
against freezing to the lowest expected outside haust valve operation. An engine brake is not a sub-
temperature. Add permanent-type antifreeze, if stitute for a service braking system, except in emer-
required. gencies, because it does not provide the precise
8. Repair any leaks, perform minor adjustments, control available from the service brakes.
tighten loose bolts, etc. Observe the vehicle mile- The Jake Brake is controlled by a single, dash-
age or the service meter reading, if so equipped. mounted paddle switch with three positions: OFF,
Perform periodic maintenance as instructed in LO, and HI.
the Maintenance Interval Schedule in the Cater-
pillar Operation and Maintenance Manual.

Detroit Diesel S60


1. With the vehicle stopped, apply the parking
brakes, and place the transmission in neutral.

7.16
Engines and Clutches

Jacobs Engine Brake Operation The control speed varies, depending on vehicle
weight and the downhill grade.
WARNING Below a set engine speed (set at the factory to 700
rpm), the engine control unit (ECU) will not engage
Do not use the engine brake if road surfaces are the engine brake. The engine brake will not work
slippery. Using the engine brake on wet, icy, or below the set engine speed.
snow-covered roads could result in loss of ve-
hicle control, possibly causing personal injury For faster descent, select a higher gear than that
and property damage. used for control speed. Service brakes must then be
used intermittently to prevent engine overspeed and
If the engine brake is engaged when the trans- to maintain desired vehicle speed.
mission is in neutral, the braking power of the
engine brake can stall the engine and result in IMPORTANT: When descending a grade, re-
loss of vehicle control, possibly causing personal member that frequent use of service brakes
injury and property damage. causes them to become hot, which results in a
reduction of their stopping ability. Grade descent
To engage the engine brake, the dash switch must
speed should be such that the service brakes
be in the LO or HI position and both the clutch and
throttle pedals must be fully released. To disengage are used infrequently and that they remain cool,
the engine brake, depress the throttle or clutch thus retaining their effectiveness.
pedal, or move the dash switch to OFF. Use the LO A driver may descend slower than control speed by
position when driving on flat, open stretches of road. selecting a lower gear, one that will not overspeed
If you need to use the service brakes to slow down, the engine. The engine brake retarding force will
switch to a higher position until there is no need for then be sufficient to cause vehicle deceleration. Oc-
the service brakes. casional deactivation of the engine brake may be
necessary to maintain the designated road speed
WARNING under these conditions.

The engine brake must be disengaged when WARNING


shifting gears. The clutch must be used if the
dash switch is in the LO or HI position. If the en- Using the engine brake as a primary braking sys-
gine brake is engaged when the transmission is tem when the service brakes are operable is dan-
in neutral, the braking power of the engine brake gerous. This can cause long, unpredictable stop-
can stall the engine, which could result in loss of ping distances, possibly resulting in personal
vehicle control, possibly causing personal injury injury or property damage.
and property damage.
Whenever vehicle braking is required, the engine
Since the engine brake is most effective at rated en- brake may be used with the service brakes. There is
gine speed, gear selection is very important. Gearing no time limit for operation of the engine brake.
down the vehicle within the limits of the rated engine
speed makes the engine brake more effective. Rec- 1. After the engine is warmed up and the vehicle is
ommended engine braking speed is above 1800 rpm in motion, move the paddle switch to the desired
and below the rated speed. position, LO or HI. Depending on the engine
model, LO will provide 1/3 or 1/2 of the full brak-
IMPORTANT: Maximum retarder performance is ing capacity of the engine. HI will provide maxi-
obtained when you use the lowest possible gear mum engine braking.
without exceeding the recommended engine
2. The engine brake activates when the dash
braking speed. switch is in LO or HI position and the drivers
"Control speed" is the speed at which the engine feet are removed from both the clutch and
brake performs 100 percent of the required downhill throttle pedals. If it fails to activate, take the ve-
braking, resulting in a constant speed of descent. hicle to an authorized Freightliner dealer for ser-
vice.

7.17
Engines and Clutches

3. To obtain maximum retarding, maintain the top perature of the oil at full engine power or full
governed speed of the engine through appropri- BrakeSaver capacity, but not both at the same
ate selection of gears when the engine brake is time.
in use.
Turbo Brake (MBE4000 only)
CAUTION For high braking output, the Mercedes-Benz
MBE4000 engine can be equipped with an optional
If the engine brake fails to shut off when either turbo brake.
the throttle or clutch pedal is depressed, place
the dash switch in the OFF position and do not The turbo brake can be operated either manually or
use the engine brake until the throttle or clutch automatically, through the cruise control function. If
switch system is repaired. If the engine brake the turbo brake is operated manually, there is a four-
fails to shut off when the dash switch is turned position switch on the dashboard: OFF/ LOW/ MED/
off, the engine should be shut down and the en- HIGH.
gine brake repaired before continuing operation. The turbo brake provides 600 brake horsepower at
Failure to do so could result in damage to the 2500 engine rpm. In the braking condition, the
engine. MBE4000 turbo brake engine operates as a turbo-
4. When either the clutch or throttle pedal is de- charged compressor, resulting in high braking output.
pressed, the engine brake is deactivated. It is recommended to operate the turbo brake up to
the 2300 rpm level. This provides approximately 550
BrakeSaver brake horsepower which should cover most situa-
tions. If additional braking power is required, engine
The BrakeSaver (optional on 3406E engines) permits speed can be increased to 2500 rpm maximum, re-
the operator to control the speed reduction of the sulting in 600 brake horsepower.
vehicle on grades, curves, or anytime speed reduc-
tion is necessary but long applications of the service CAUTION
brakes are not desired.
During downhill operation, the crankshaft is turned by Do not allow the engine to exceed 2500 rpm. Se-
the rear wheels (through the drivetrain). To reduce rious engine damage could result.
the speed of the vehicle, an application of braking Because the charge air pressure is maintained at a
force can be made to the crankshaft. The Brake- high level during braking, full throttle response is
Saver does this by converting rotation energy into available immediately, if the operator desires it, with-
heat, which is removed by the engine cooling sys- out any turbo lag.
tem. The BrakeSaver is controlled by the driver, as
necessary, by operating a lever on the instrument
panel. Braking force increases as the lever is moved CAUTION
toward the ON position. An air pressure gauge pro-
vides a relative indication of the braking force. An oil The turbo brake should only be operated when
temperature gauge indicates the heat in the Brake- the engine coolant temperature exceeds 140F
Saver during its operation. If the temperature gauge (60C). It cannot be engaged below this level. Be
indicates HOT, the BrakeSaver control lever must be aware that no engine retarding system is avail-
moved to the OFF position. The oil temperature will able during engine warm-up.
decrease rapidly with the BrakeSaver off. When the The MBE4000 turbo brake is combined with
temperature reaches normal, the BrakeSaver can be Mercedes-Benz constant throttle technology, but an
used. exhaust flap is not used. The turbo brake emits very
low levels of noise, making it an environmentally
CAUTION friendly system. It is maintenance-free, highly reli-
able, and adds virtually no weight to the engine.
Do not engage the BrakeSaver and control the
wheel speed with the accelerator. The design of
the cooling system is for the control of the tem-

7.18
Engines and Clutches

Constant-Throttle Engine Brake pedals, allows the driver to make maximum use of
the exhaust brake in off-highway and mountain driv-
(MBE4000 only) ing as well as in traffic or high-speed highway driv-
The standard engine braking system is the constant- ing.
throttle system combined with an exhaust flap. To The exhaust brake is a butterfly valve mounted in the
increase braking performance, each cylinder is exhaust pipe. When the drivers foot is not on the
equipped with a small valve built into the cylinder accelerator pedal and the exhaust brake switch is in
head. This valve is always open during engine brake the on position, an air cylinder shuts the butterfly
activation, and it allows compressed air to exhaust valve, which restricts the flow of exhaust gases and
when the piston is at top dead center. This removes retards the engine. This retarding action is carried
pressure from the piston as it moves to the bottom through the engine and drivetrain, slowing the vehicle
dead center position. and reducing the need for frequent service brake ap-
The standard constant-throttle engine brake is plications.
equipped with an exhaust flap. During engine brake Exhaust brakes are not intended for use as the pri-
operation, the six constant throttle valves are open in mary braking system during vehicle operation.
parallel and the exhaust flap is closed. For normal
engine brake use, operate the engine up to 2300 Starting the Engine
rpm. If increased retarding power is required, the
maximum 2500 engine rpm can be used. Before starting the engine, make sure that the ex-
haust brake switch is in the off position. Do not turn
the exhaust brake on until the engine has reached
CAUTION normal operating temperatures.
Do not allow the engine to exceed 2500 rpm. Se- Driving Downhill
rious engine damage could result.
While approaching a steep grade, make sure that the
A two-position switch on the dash controls the engine
exhaust brake switch is in the on position. The ex-
braking system. Like the exhaust flap, the constant
haust brake comes on as soon as you remove your
throttles are deactivated when the accelerator or
foot from the accelerator pedal. While going down
clutch pedal is depressed. The ABS system, when
the grade, use a low enough gear to safely descend
active, also deactivates constant-throttle braking.
with a minimum application of the service brakes. As
a general guideline, use the same gear as you would
Exhaust Brake SystemCAT, to ascend the hill.
Cummins, DDE S60, M-B
CAUTION
General Information
Do not allow the engine to exceed its governed
An exhaust brake is an optional auxiliary braking sys- speed, or serious engine damage could result.
tem that assists but does not replace the service
brake system. The exhaust brake can be used alone Apply the service brakes to reduce the engine rpm or
or together with the constant-throttle valves for steep make a slower descent by using a lower gear.
or long grades. It cannot be used at the same time
as a Jake brake. WARNING
When only the exhaust brake is installed, a two-
position switch on the dash controls the engine brak- Do not use the exhaust brake when driving on
ing system. The exhaust brake is only active when slippery or low-traction road surfaces. Failure to
the engine speed is between 900 and 2500 rpm. De- follow this precaution could result in a loss of
pressing the accelerator or clutch pedal deactivates vehicle control and possible personal injury or
the exhaust brake. The ABS system, when active, property damage.
also deactivates the exhaust brake.
The exhaust brake switch located on the control
panel, in combination with the accelerator and clutch

7.19
Engines and Clutches

Exhaust Brake Operating Characteristics Heat and wear are practically nonexistent when a
clutch is fully engaged. But during the moment of
When you remove your feet from both the accelera- engagement, when the clutch is picking up the load,
tor and clutch pedals and the exhaust brake switch is it generates considerable heat. An improperly ad-
in the on position, the exhaust brake is applied. The justed or slipping clutch will rapidly generate suffi-
following conditions should exist if the brake is oper- cient heat to destroy itself.
ating properly.
To ensure long service life of the clutch; start in the
A slight change in the sound of the engine may right gear, be alert to clutch malfunctions, and know
be noticed when the exhaust brake is applied. when to adjust the clutch.
Exhaust smoke should appear normal.
Clutch Operation
Engine temperature should remain in the nor-
mal operating range. Clutch Break-In
Road speed usually decreases when the ex- With a new or newly installed clutch, the clutch may
haust brake is applied during a descent. When slip for a short time while the friction surfaces break-
the vehicle is carrying a heavy load or the in. However, allowing the clutch to slip for more than
grade is extremely steep, you may need to two seconds can severely damage the clutch disc,
apply the service brakes occasionally. pressure plate, and the flywheel.
Do not expect a retarding effect similar to sud- During initial operation of a new vehicle or a vehicle
den hard application of the service brakes. The with a new clutch, check for clutch slippage during
exhaust brake retards the vehicle with a acceleration. If the clutch slips, decelerate until the
smooth braking effect. clutch does not slip. Allow the clutch to cool 15 to 30
seconds, and then gradually accelerate again. If the
During a descent, the tachometer usually clutch continues to slip, repeat the procedure. If nec-
shows a drop in rpm depending on the grade essary, repeat the procedure up to five times. If the
and the vehicle load. clutch slips after five attempts, stop the vehicle. Allow
Depending on the grade and vehicle load, you the clutch to cool for at least one hour. Notify your
may or may not feel the retarding force acting Freightliner dealer of the problem.
against your body when the brake is applied.
The retarding force of the brake may not al- CAUTION
ways be noticed, but it is actually preventing
the vehicle from going much faster. Do not allow sustained slippage of the clutch;
this could severely damage the clutch disc, pres-
Make sure the exhaust brake is turned off before
sure plate, or flywheel. Damage caused by clutch
shutting off the engine.
slippage due to improper break-in is not warrant-
able.
Clutches
Moving the Vehicle in the Proper Gear
General Information
An empty truck can be started in a higher transmis-
Clutches are designed to absorb and dissipate more sion gear than can a partially or fully loaded truck. A
heat than encountered in typical operation. The tem- good rule of thumb for the driver to follow is to select
peratures developed in typical operation will not the gear combination that allows the vehicle to start
break down the clutch friction surfaces. However, if a moving with an idling engine, or, if necessary, just
clutch is slipped excessively, or asked to do the job enough throttle to prevent stalling the engine. After
of a fluid coupling, high temperatures develop quickly the clutch is fully engaged, the engine can be accel-
and destroy the clutch. Temperatures generated be- erated to the correct rpm for the upshift into the next
tween the flywheel, driven discs, and pressure plates higher gear.
can be high enough to cause the metal to flow and
the friction facing material to char and burn.

7.20
Engines and Clutches

Gear Shifting Techniques Slightly depressing the clutch pedal while driving is
damaging to the clutch, because partial clutch en-
Shift into the next higher gear when the vehicle gagement causes slippage and heat. Resting your
speed allows the transmission input shaft speed to foot on the clutch pedal will also put a constant thrust
match the flywheel speed when engaging the clutch. load on the release bearing, thinning the bearing lu-
This technique results in the smallest speed differ- bricant and increasing the wear on the bearing.
ence between the clutch disc and the flywheel and
causes the least heat and wear on the clutch assem- Using the Clutch Brake
bly. When downshifting, the input shaft speed must
be increased by slightly revving the engine to match The clutch brake is applied by depressing the clutch
the flywheel speed for smooth clutch engagement. pedal past the fully released clutch position, almost
For transmission operating instructions, refer to to the floor plate. The last part of the clutch pedal
Chapter 8 in this manual. travel will compress the clutch brake plates together,
stopping the transmission input shaft. The purpose of
Vehicle Loading the clutch brake is to stop the transmission gears
from rotating in order to quickly engage a transmis-
Clutches are designed for specific vehicle applica- sion gear after idling in neutral.
tions and loads. These weight limitations should not
be exceeded.
CAUTION
CAUTION Never apply the clutch brake when the vehicle is
moving. If the clutch brake is applied when the
Exceeding vehicle load limits can not only result vehicle is moving, the clutch brake will try to
in damage to the clutch, but can also damage the stop or decelerate the vehicle, causing rapid
entire powertrain. wear of the clutch brake friction discs. Consider-
able heat will be generated, causing damage to
Using the Clutch the release bearings and the transmission front
The clutch pedal must be used only to start the ve- bearings.
hicle moving or while shifting. To start the vehicle
moving, depress the clutch pedal all the way to the Holding the Vehicle on an Incline
floor plate (see "Using the Clutch Brake") and shift Always use the vehicle service brakes to prevent the
from neutral to a low gear. Slowly raise your foot until vehicle from rolling backwards while stopped on a
the clutch starts to engage. In this position the clutch hill. Slipping the clutch on a hill to maintain the ve-
is starting to connect the transmission input shaft to hicle position will quickly damage the clutch assem-
the flywheel and is causing the most heat and wear. bly.
Slightly increase the engine speed and smoothly
allow the clutch pedal to return to its at-rest position. Coasting
Do not allow the clutch to remain in the partially en-
gaged position any longer than necessary to obtain a Coasting with the clutch pedal depressed and the
smooth start. transmission in a low gear can cause high driven
disc speed. The clutch speed can be much higher
To shift gears while the vehicle is moving, push the under these conditions than when the engine is driv-
clutch pedal most of the way (but not all of the way) ing the clutch. This condition creates a hazardous
to the floor plate. Shift the transmission into neutral situation due to the lack of vehicle control and due to
and fully release the clutch pedal. If upshifting, wait the high clutch disc speed. Engaging the clutch
long enough for the engine speed to decrease to the under these conditions can cause component dam-
road speed. If downshifting, increase the engine age because of the shock loads to the clutch and
speed to match the road speed. Again, push down drivetrain.
the clutch pedal part way and then move the shift
lever to the next gear position. Fully release the
clutch pedal after completing the shift.

7.21
Engines and Clutches

WARNING
Always shift into the gear that is correct for the
traveling speed of the vehicle and engage the
clutch. Coasting with the clutch disengaged can
prevent engagement of the correct transmission
gear which can cause loss of vehicle control,
possibly resulting in personal injury or property
damage.
High clutch disc speeds while coasting can also
cause the clutch facing to be thrown off the disc.
Flying debris from the clutch can cause injury to
persons in the cab.

Clutch Maintenance
Checking the Clutch Adjustment
Reporting erratic clutch operation as soon as pos-
sible gives maintenance personnel a chance to in-
spect, lubricate, and adjust the clutch components.
The driver can be aware of clutch wear by noticing 02/09/96 f250306
the gradual decrease in the distance the clutch pedal A. Free Pedal
moves before resistance is felt. A correctly adjusted
clutch must have about 3/4 inch (19 mm) of travel at Fig. 7.9, Clutch Free Pedal Travel
the top of its stroke before a stronger resistance can
be felt. See Fig. 7.9. If the free pedal travel is less Adjusting the Clutch
than this distance, have the clutch adjusted.
Clutches have an internal adjustment and external
The clutch pedal free travel should be checked and linkage adjustment. See Group 25 of the Columbia
commented on daily in the drivers report. Workshop Manual for clutch adjustment procedures
and specifications.
See Group 25 of the Columbia Workshop Manual-
for clutch adjustment procedures and specifications.
CAUTION
CAUTION Operating the vehicle with the clutch incorrectly
adjusted could result in clutch or clutch brake
Operating the vehicle with incorrect free pedal
failure.
could result in clutch damage.

Checking the Clutch Brake Operation Lubricating the Clutch Linkage and
Bearing
Clutch brake operation can be felt as an increased
resistance as the clutch pedal approaches the bot- On vehicles equipped with a greaseable release
tom of its stroke. If the gears grind when shifting into bearing, the release bearing and linkage should be
first or reverse gear from neutral with the clutch lubricated at frequent intervals. See Group 25 of the
pedal fully depressed, the clutch pedal is out of ad- Columbia Maintenance Manual for intervals and
justment or the clutch brake is worn and needs to be procedures.
replaced.

7.22
Engines and Clutches

CAUTION
Failure to lubricate the release bearing and link-
age as recommended could result in release
bearing and clutch damage.

7.23
8
Transmissions
Freightliner SmartShift Shift Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.1
Eaton Fuller AutoShift Automated Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.1
ZF-FreedomLine Automated Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.4
Eaton Fuller Range-Shift Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.6
Eaton Fuller Splitter and Range-Shift Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.8
Eaton Fuller Deep-Reduction Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.11
Eaton Fuller Super 10, Top 2, and Lightning Semi-Automated Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.14
Meritor Range-Shift Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.17
Meritor Splitter and Range-Shift Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.19
Meritor Engine Synchro Shift (ESS) Automated Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.20
Eaton UltraShift DM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.23
Transmissions

Freightliner SmartShift Shift 5 6 7


Control 4 8
3
General Information, SmartShift
The SmartShift transmission control is an electronic
transmission control device. It is installed with the
9
following transmissions: 1
2
Eaton Fuller AutoShift 10
11
Eaton Fuller UltraShift DM 12
01/24/2003 f270120
ZF-FreedomLine
To upshift manually, pull the lever up (towards you). To
It replaces the typical floor-mounted shift lever or downshift manually, push the lever down (away from
dash-mounted push button control. you).
1. SmartShift Control Lever
SmartShift accepts driver requests for transmission 2. Slide Switch (forward driving mode switch)
functions and transmits them through hard wiring to 3. MAN Position (of slide switch)
the transmission control unit (TCU). SmartShift is a 4. AUTO Position (of slide switch)
true shift-by-wire system. 5. Upshift Direction
6. Reverse Position (of selector switch)
SmartShift offers two main advantages over conven-
7. Selector Switch
tional transmission control devices. Without a floor- 8. Neutral Lock Button
mounted shift control, usable cab space is increased. 9. Neutral Position (of selector switch)
Access to the sleeper is improved by removing the 10. Drive Position (of selector switch)
shift lever from the floor. 11. Low Position (of selector switch)
12. Downshift Direction
The SmartShift control mounts to the right-hand side
of the steering column and is operated by the fingers Fig. 8.1, Four-Position SmartShift Control (with Eaton
of the drivers right hand, allowing both hands to re- Fuller transmissions)
main on the steering wheel.
tral (N) to another gear, such as drive (D), low (L), or
A two-position slide switch is mounted on the body of
reverse (R). When shifting to N, it is not necessary to
the control lever just before the paddle widens out.
press the neutral lock button.
The slide switch allows the driver to choose auto-
matic (AUTO) mode or manual (MAN) mode.
In AUTO mode, gears shift automatically, without
Eaton Fuller AutoShift
driver interaction. Manual gear shifts are accom- Automated Transmissions
plished by a momentary pull or push on the control in
the plane perpendicular to the steering wheel. Pull Refer to the Eaton website for additional information,
upward (toward you) on the control to upshift and www.roadranger.com.
push downward (away from you) to downshift. The
control is spring-loaded and returns to mid-position General Information, AutoShift
when released after an upshift or downshift. 10-Speed RT/RTO Models
For the Eaton Fuller automated transmissions, a Eaton Fuller 10-speed AutoShift transmissions have
four-position (R, N, D, L) selector switch (Fig. 8.1) is 10 forward speeds and two reverse speeds. The
located at the end of the lever. For the FreedomLine transmission consists of a 5-speed front section and
transmission, a three-position (R, N, D) selector a 2-speed rear section. The driver must use the
switch (Fig. 8.2) is located at the end of the lever. clutch to start and stop the vehicle.
Embedded in the selector switch is a small neutral
The driver does not need to break torque or increase
lock button to prevent accidental shifts into gear from
or decrease engine speed to synchronize the shift.
neutral. Any time you shift through N, press down on
The transmission signals the engine controller when
the neutral lock button to move the switch from neu-

8.1
Transmissions

5 6
7
4
3 8

9 1 A
1
2
10
2
11 SOLID
11/11/2002 f270080
3
To upshift manually, pull the lever up (towards you). To
downshift manually, push the lever down (away from SOLID
you).
4
1. SmartShift Control Lever FLASHING
2. Slide Switch
3. MAN Position (of slide switch)
4. AUTO Position (of slide switch) 5
5. Upshift Direction SOLID
6. Reverse Position (of selector switch) 02/17/98 B f270062
7. Selector Switch A. Gear Display Module B. Module Detail
8. Neutral Lock Button 1. Current Gear
9. Neutral Position (of selector switch) 2. 9th Gear Engaged
10. Drive Position (of selector switch) 3. In 9th Gear, Preselected Toward 10th
11. Downshift Direction 4. Out Of Gear, Waiting For Engine/Transmission RPM
Fig. 8.2, Three-Position SmartShift Control (with To Synchronize
FreedomLine transmission) 5. 10th Gear Engaged
Fig. 8.3, Gear Display Module
to break torque and the engine controller automati-
cally increases or decreases engine speed. When ECU. The transmission ECU controls all trans-
engine speed is correct, the transmission engages mission shift functions and the system ECU
the next gear and signals the engine controller to manages all vehicle interfaces for transmission
resume operation. shift functions.
The AutoShift system consists of the following com- An electronic range valve, controlled by the
ponents: transmission ECU, is used to perform range
The SmartShift control paddle on the steering shifts.
column. See Fig. 8.1.
Operation, AutoShift with SmartShift
The gear display module (Fig. 8.3) mounted on
the dashboard indicates the current gear posi- Automatic and Manual Modes
tion or transmission status. The display also
A two-position slide switch (forward driving mode
flashes the next gear to be engaged while the
switch) is located near the end of the control
transmission is in neutral during a gear
(Fig. 8.1). The switch positions are labelled MAN
change.
(manual shift mode) and AUTO (automatic drive
The shifter mechanism performs shifts at the mode).
front portion of the transmission. It preselects
NOTE: In automatic drive mode, upshifts and
the shift to neutral and completes the gear
change after driver input. downshifts require no driver interaction. Move
the selector switch to the drive (D) position, dis-
The Electronic Control Unit (ECU) includes two engage the clutch to engage the gear selected,
controllers: a transmission ECU and a system

8.2
Transmissions

engage the clutch and drive the vehicle. In increases the starting gear by one gear, but no
manual shift mode, upshifts and downshifts re- higher than fourth gear.
quire either a pull upward or push downward on 3. The number of the gear selected will flash on the
the control. message display screen until the driver engages
the clutch. This gear will be stored in memory as
Driver Message Center the default starting gear until either a different
Gear information is presented to the driver via a LCD starting gear is selected by the driver or the en-
display on the dash. In automatic drive mode, the gine is shut down.
number of the forward gear currently engaged ap- NOTE: The transmission may also be pro-
pears continually on the message display screen grammed so that it is not possible to select a
when in drive (D). In manual shift mode, the current starting gear other than the preprogrammed de-
gear is displayed until a new gear is requested.
When neutral (N) is engaged, "N" will appear on the
fault starting gear.
message display screen. When reverse (R) is en-
gaged, either "RL" or "RH" will appear on the mes-
Upshifting
sage display screen. NOTE: With the transmission in drive (D) in the
IMPORTANT: The information shown on the automatic mode, upshifts require no driver inter-
message display screen indicates the state of action.
the transmission only, not the state of the 1. With the transmission in drive in the manual
SmartShift control. mode, request an upshift by pulling upward on
the control. If the requested gear is available, the
Neutral Position transmission will upshift.
Select neutral by sliding the selector switch to the NOTE: A single, momentary pull upward on the
"N" position. control selects the next higher gear when it is
NOTE: Neutral is always available during opera- available. Two consecutive, momentary upward
tion. When in neutral, upshift and downshift re- pulls will cause a skip shift when the next two
quests are ignored. If the mode selector switch higher gears are available and conditions are
is moved from neutral (N) to drive (D) while the right.
vehicle is moving, the transmission will shift into 2. To skip shift, move the control two times in less
a gear causing the engine to go to a high torque than 1/2 second. The number of the gear en-
level, under the engines rated torque. gaged will appear on the message display
screen.
Selecting a Starting Gear
NOTE: The Eaton Fuller AutoShift 18-speed
1. In automatic mode, select drive (D) by sliding the transmission is able to perform triple upshifts
selector switch downward to the next position when the next three higher gears are available
below the neutral position. and conditions are right. To triple-shift this trans-
2. Disengage the clutch to engage the gear se- mission, move the control three times in less
lected. Engage the clutch and drive the vehicle. than 1/2 second.

Changing the Default Starting Gear If a requested gear is not available, an audible
warning will sound and the gear display module
To select a starting gear other than the default start- will indicate that the gear is not available. An
ing gear, follow the instructions below. unavailable requested upshift is not stored in
1. Make sure the vehicle is stopped and in drive. memory. The upshift must be requested again.
2. In either automatic or manual mode, pull upward
on the control (to increase), or push downward
(to decrease). Each pull upward on the control

8.3
Transmissions

Downshifting 5. Press down on the clutch again and release the


parking brake.
NOTE: With the transmission in drive (D) in the
automatic mode, downshifts require no driver 6. Select the desired starting gear.
interaction. 7. Release the clutch.
1. With the transmission in drive in the manual
mode, request a downshift by pushing downward
Reverse
on the control. If the requested gear is available, 1. To engage reverse (R), slide the selector switch
the transmission will downshift. upward to the next position above the neutral
position and disengage the clutch.
NOTE: A single, momentary push downward on
the control selects the next lower gear when it is NOTE: AutoShift 10- and 18-speed transmis-
available. Two consecutive, momentary down- sions have a dual-range reverse. Reverse low
ward pushes will cause a skip shift, when the (RL) is the default reverse gear.
next two lower gears are available and condi- 2. Select reverse high (RH) by pulling upward on
tions are right. the control.
2. To skip shift, move the control two times in less NOTE: Reverse may be engaged below a pro-
than 1/2 second. The number of the gear en-
gaged will appear on the message display
grammable forward speed in order to rock the
screen. vehicle. If reverse is selected above the pro-
grammed forward speed, an audible warning will
NOTE: The Eaton Fuller AutoShift 18-speed sound and a message indicating that the gear is
transmission is able to perform triple downshifts not available will appear on the message dis-
when the next three lower gears are available play screen.
and conditions are right. To triple shift this trans-
mission, move the control three times in less Low Gear Operation
than 1/2 second. Use low (L) when descending steep hills and using
If a requested gear is not available, an audible compression braking. Engine speed will be increased
warning will sound and the gear display module by 200 rpm and shift points will be offset by 200 rpm.
will indicate that the requested gear is not avail- The efficiency of the exhaust brake will be maxi-
able. Unlike upshifting, an unavailable requested mized.
downshift is stored in memory and the shift will Using the Clutch
be made when the gear is available. The time
limit for this memory is a programmable param- Use the clutch to start and stop the vehicle.
eter.
ZF-FreedomLine Automated
Start-Up
Transmissions
1. With the parking brake applied, press the clutch
all the way down to the floor. Refer to the Meritor website for additional informa-
tion, www.arvinmeritor.com.
2. Start the engine.
3. Check to make sure the transmission is in neu- General Information, FreedomLine
tral. FreedomLine is a fully-automated manual transmis-
4. With the transmission in neutral, release the sion that features only an accelerator and brake
clutch. pedal in the cab. Clutch actuation is fully automated.
On Freightliner vehicles, it will be operated by a cus-
NOTE: This allows the speed sensor on the tom version of the SmartShift controller. On Columbia
input shaft to get a reading. vehicles, dash messages will appear on the round
Meritor message center display.

8.4
Transmissions

This transmission requires an additional 10-liter air pedal. On the driver message center display, the first
reservoir. After any transmission service, it will be character is a special character to indicate automatic
necessary to charge this tank with air before the ve- mode.
hicle can be operated.
In manual drive mode, upshifts and downshifts are
made by the driver:
Operation, FreedomLine
To shift up, pull the lever up (towards you).
1. With the parking brake engaged and/or the brake
pedal pressed down, select neutral (N) by press- To shift down, push the lever down (away from
ing in the safety release and moving the selector you).
switch to the center position. See Fig. 8.2. On the driver message center display, the first char-
2. With the transmission in neutral, start the engine. acter is blank to indicate manual mode.
Allow the air pressure to build to 100 psi (689
NOTE: Automatic shifting is possible only in for-
kPa) to ensure clutch engagement before moving
the vehicle. ward gear. When the selector switch is in re-
verse (R), all shifts are done manually, regard-
3. With air pressure built up, select drive (D) by by less of the position of the slide switch.
pressing in the safety release and moving the
selector switch downward to the position below Gear Positions
neutral. Release the parking brake and/or pedal.
Neutral
NOTE: When D is selected, the transmission Neutral (N) is in the center of the three-position se-
controller starts up in the default starting gear. lector switch located at the end of the SmartShift
4. Press down on the accelerator pedal to allow the control lever. To select neutral, press in the safety
vehicle to move forward. The vehicle will not release and move the selector switch to the center
move until the pedal is depressed. position.
Neutral is always available during operation. When in
WARNING neutral, requests to upshift or downshift are ignored.
If the selector switch is moved from neutral to drive
A vehicle equipped with the FreedomLine fully- while the vehicle is moving, the transmission will shift
automated transmission can roll backwards when into a gear within the engines operating torque
stopped on a hill or grade, or when the vehicle is range.
starting from a stop on a hill or grade. This can
result in serious personal injury or property dam- Reverse
age. To select reverse (R), press in the safety release and
5. To stop on a hill or grade, press and hold the move the selector switch upward to the position
brake pedal to keep the vehicle from moving. above neutral.
6. To start from a full stop on hill or grade, quickly NOTE: When the selector switch is in reverse
move your foot from the brake pedal and press (R), all shifts are done manually, regardless of
firmly on the accelerator pedal. the position of the slide switch.
Automatic and Manual Modes The vehicle must come to a complete stop before
selecting reverse. If reverse is selected with the ve-
The SmartShift selector has a slide switch located on hicle moving, an audible warning will sound. Once
the body of the control lever just before the paddle the vehicle has come to a complete stop, reverse low
widens out. The slide switch controls the forward can be engaged.
driving mode, automatic or manual.
There are two reverse gears. Reverse low (RL) is the
In automatic drive mode, upshifts and downshifts are default reverse gear. To select reverse high (RH),
made by the transmission without driver intervention. pull the control lever up (towards you). You can shift
Press in the safety release, move the selector switch between RL and RH "on the fly," without stopping
to drive (D), and press down on the accelerator first.

8.5
Transmissions

Upshifting Driver Message Center


NOTE: A request to upshift or downshift can On the Columbia, the gear is displayed on the round
only be accepted in the manual mode. Meritor message center display. See Fig. 8.4.
With the transmission in drive, to request an upshift,
pull the control lever up (towards you). If the gear is
available, the transmission will upshift.
An unavailable request to upshift is not stored in
memory. The upshift must be requested again. Skip
07
shifting in manual mode is not available with the ZF
Meritor version of SmartShift.
03/28/2002 f603017
Downshifting Fig. 8.4, Round Meritor Display
NOTE: A request to upshift or downshift can
only be accepted in the manual mode. The first character of the display is either blank, to
indicate the transmission is in manual mode, or an
With the transmission in drive, to request a down- up-and-down arrow to indicate the transmission is in
shift, push the control lever down (away from you). If automatic mode.
the gear is available, the transmission will downshift.
NOTE: Pre-production vehicles will have a small
An unavailable request to downshift is not stored in numeric "10" in place of the up-and-down arrow
memory. The downshift must be requested again. when in automatic mode.
Skip shifting in manual mode is not available with the
FreedomLine version of SmartShift. The next two characters indicate the current gear.
For forward drive gears, this appears as a two-digit
IMPORTANT: A downshift request can never number ( Examples: "03, "11"). For reverse, two let-
result in a shift into neutral, even if the vehicle is ters appear, either "RL" for low reverse (the default),
in the drive position in the lowest possible gear. or "RH" for high reverse. For neutral, a single letter
"N" appears.
Selecting A Nondefault Starting Gear
NOTE: For the clutch to engage, pressure in the Eaton Fuller Range-Shift
primary air system must be at least 100 psi (689 Transmissions
kPa).
Refer to the Eaton website for additional information,
1. Select drive (D) by pressing in the safety release www.roadranger.com.
and moving the selector switch downward to the
position below neutral. General Information, Eaton Fuller
2. Select manual mode (MAN) by moving the two- Range-Shift
position slide switch towards the steering column
until it is in the manual position. To operate a range-shift transmission, move the shift
lever through all the low gear positions and then acti-
3. To increase the starting gear, pull the lever up vate a range switch to provide an additional set of
(towards you). To decrease the starting gear, ratios in the high range. Using the same shift lever
push the lever down (away from you). positions as in low range, move the shift lever
4. Select automatic mode (AUTO), if desired, by through each position as before. On some models,
moving the two-position slide switch away from the initial low gear is often used only in low range.
the steering column until it is in the automatic po- IMPORTANT: Not all lever positions are used in each
sition. range and the shift patterns vary between transmis-
sions. Be sure to read the shift pattern decal on the

8.6
Transmissions

dash for the operating instructions for the specific


HI 7 9
transmission installed in your vehicle. R
LO 2 4
9-Speed RT/RTX Models
Eaton Fuller 9-speed transmissions have a 5-speed A
front section and a 2-speed rear range section. The N
low gear in the front sections of the RT and RTX
transmissions is used only as a starting ratio. The
B
remaining gear positions of the above transmissions 6 8 10
are used once in the low range and once in the high 1 3 5
range. 12/15/1999 f261053
See Fig. 8.5 for the 9-speed range-shift shift A. High Range B. Low Range
patterns.
Fig. 8.6, Eaton Fuller 10-Speed Transmission Shift
Patterns
HI
5 7
LO 1 3 When operating on-highway, with no load, or
under ideal conditions, use 1st gear when start-
A ing to move the vehicle (except when equipped
N with a 9-speed RTO transmission, then always
start in low gear).
6 8 B For all conditions, use the highest gear that is
LO still low enough to start the vehicle moving with
2 4
11/23/99 f261047
engine idling, and without slipping the clutch ex-
cessively.
A. High Range B. Low Range
2. Use the clutch brake to stop gear rotation when
Fig. 8.5, Eaton Fuller 9-Speed Transmission Shift shifting into low (or 1st) or reverse when the ve-
Patterns hicle is stationary. The clutch brake is actuated
by depressing the clutch pedal all the way to the
10-Speed FR/FRO and RT/RTO/RTX floor.
Models
For normal upshifts and downshifts, only a partial
Eaton Fuller 10-speed transmissions have 10 selec- disengagement of the clutch is necessary to
tive, evenly-spaced forward ratios. Each transmission break engine torque.
has a 5-speed front section and a 2-speed rear
3. Do not make range shifts with the vehicle moving
range section. The 10 forward speeds are obtained
by twice using a 5-speed shift pattern: the first time in reverse gear.
in low range, the second time in high range. See 4. Never attempt to move the range preselection
Fig. 8.6 for the shift patterns. lever with the gear shift lever in neutral while the
vehicle is moving. Preselection with the range
NOTE: The 4th/9th and the 5th/10th shift posi-
preselection lever must be made prior to moving
tions in the RT (direct ratio) and RTX (overdrive the shift lever out of gear into neutral.
ratio) transmissions are directly opposite in the
RTO (overdrive ratio) transmissions 5. Do not shift from high range to low range at high
vehicle speeds.
Operation, Eaton Fuller Range-Shift 6. Double-clutch between all upshifts and down-
1. When operating off-highway, or under adverse shifts.
conditions, always use low gear (if so equipped) 7. After your shifting ability improves, you may want
when starting to move the vehicle. to skip some of the ratios. This may be done

8.7
Transmissions

only when operating conditions permit, depend- Downshifting


ing on the load, grade, and road speed.
1. With the transmission in high range, shift pro-
Upshifting gressively downward to the bottom gear in high
range, double-clutching between shifts.
1. Position the gear shift lever in neutral. Start the
engine, and bring the air system pressure up to 2. When in the bottom gear of the high range shift
100 to 120 psi (689 to 827 kPa). pattern, and ready for the next downshift, push
the range preselection lever down into low range.
2. Position the range preselection lever down, into Double-clutch through neutral, and shift into the
low range. top gear of the low range shift pattern. As the
3. Press the clutch pedal to the floor; shift into low shift lever passes through neutral, the transmis-
or 1st gear (Table 8.1), then engage the clutch, sion will automatically shift from high range to
with the engine at or near idle speed, to start the low range.
vehicle moving. Accelerate to 80 percent of en- 3. With the transmission in low range, downshift
gine governed speed. through the low range gears as conditions re-
quire.
Eaton Fuller Shift Progressions
LOW RANGE
IMPORTANT: Never use the clutch brake when
TRANS. HIGH
MODEL Off-Highway On-Highway RANGE
downshifting, or as a brake to slow the vehicle.
9-Speed 5 7
Direct or
R 1 3 R 1 3 R
Eaton Fuller Splitter and
Overdrive
(RT or LOW
2 4 2 4
6 8 Range-Shift Transmissions
RTX) f260322 f260323 f260324
Refer to the Eaton website for additional information,
10-Speed 7 9 www.roadranger.com.
R 2 4 R 2 4 R
Direct or
Overdrive
(RT or 1 3 5 1 3 5
6 8 10 General Information, Eaton Fuller
RTX) f260329 f260329 f260330
Splitter and Range-Shift
Table 8.1, Eaton Fuller Range-Shift Shift Combination splitter and range-shift transmissions
Progressions
allow the choice of two splitter ratios in each lever
position as well as the additional ratio provided in
4. Shift progressively upward from low or 1st gear, each lever position after shifting to the other range.
to the top gear in low range (Table 8.1), double-
clutching between shifts, and accelerating to 80 IMPORTANT: Not all lever positions are used in
percent of engine governed speed. each range and the shift patterns vary between
transmissions. Be sure to read the shift pattern
5. While in the top gear of the low range shift pat- decal on the dash for the operating instructions
tern, and ready for the next upshift, flip the range
preselection lever up into high range. Double-
for the specific transmission installed in your ve-
clutch through neutral, and shift into the bottom hicle.
gear in high range (Table 8.1). As the shift lever
passes through neutral, the transmission will au- 13-Speed RTLO Models
tomatically shift from low range to high range. Eaton Fuller 13-speed transmissions have thirteen
6. With the transmission in high range, shift pro- forward speeds and two reverse speeds. Each trans-
gressively upward through each of the high mission consists of a 5-speed front section, and a
range gears (Table 8.1), double-clutching be- 3-speed auxiliary section. The auxiliary section con-
tween shifts. tains low- and high-range ratios, plus an overdrive
splitter gear. See Fig. 8.7 for the shift pattern.
All of the 13 speeds are controlled with one shift
lever. A range preselection lever and a splitter control

8.8
Transmissions

button are built into the shift knob. The range prese-
Hi 5 5 7 7 1
R Dir OD Dir OD lection lever controls range selection and the splitter
Lo 1 3 control button (located on the side of the shift knob)
controls gear splits.
A
N Operation, Eaton Fuller Splitter and
Range-Shift
B
LOW
6 6
Dir OD
8 8
Dir OD IMPORTANT: The shifter knob has an interlock
2 4 C D feature that prevents the splitter control button
03/13/96 f260044a
from being moved forward when the range pre-
A. High Range C. Overdrive (forward) selection lever is down (in low range); when in
B. Low Range D. Direct Drive (rearward) high range and the splitter control button is in
1. Splitter Control Button the forward position, the range preselection
Fig. 8.7, Eaton Fuller 13-Speed Transmission Shift lever cannot be moved down.
Pattern
1. When operating off-road, or under adverse condi-
button are built into the shift knob. The range prese- tions, always use low gear when starting to move
lection lever controls range selection and the splitter the vehicle forward.
control button (located on the side of the shift knob) When operating on-highway, with no load, or
controls gear splits. under ideal conditions, use 1st gear when start-
Low gear in the front section is used only as a start- ing to move the vehicle forward.
ing ratio. The remaining four forward positions are For all conditions, use the highest gear that is
used once in the low range and once in the high still low enough to start the vehicle moving with
range. However, each of the four high range gear the engine at or near idle speed, and without
positions can be split with the underdrive ratio (RT slipping the clutch excessively.
models), or overdrive ratio (RTO models) of the split-
ter gear. Ratios cannot be split while the transmis- 2. Use the clutch brake to stop gear rotation when
sion is in low range. shifting into low (or 1st) or reverse when the ve-
hicle is stationary. The clutch brake is actuated
18-Speed RTLO Splitter and Range-Shift by depressing the clutch pedal all the way to the
floor.
Models
For normal upshifts and downshifts, only a partial
Eaton Fuller 18-speed transmissions have 18 forward disengagement of the clutch is necessary to
speeds and four reverse speeds. These transmis- break engine torque.
sions consisting of a 5-speed front section and a
3-speed auxiliary section. The auxiliary section con- 3. Use double-clutching between all upshifts and
tains low and high range ratios, plus an overdrive downshifts that require movement of the shift
splitter gear. lever. Splitting of the high range gears does not
require movement of the shift lever.
One ratio in the front section (low) is used as a start-
ing ratio; it is never used when the transmission is in 4. Never move the shift lever into low gear while in
high range. Low gear can be split to provide both a high range.
direct and an overdrive ratio. 5. Never move the splitter control button while in
The other four ratios in the front section are used neutral.
once in low range and once again in high range; 6. Do not preselect with the splitter control button;
however, each of the five ratios (low1234) in low after moving the control button, complete the
range and each of the four ratios (5678) in high shift immediately.
range can be split with the overdrive splitter gear.
7. Except when downshifting from 5th direct to 4th
All of the 18 speeds are controlled with one shift gear, never push the range preselection lever
lever. A range preselection lever and a splitter control

8.9
Transmissions

down into low range while operating in high For 18-speed transmissions:
rangethe splitter will become inoperative. Press the clutch to the floor, shift into low; then
8. Do not shift from high range to low range at high engage the clutch, with the engine at or near idle
vehicle speeds. speed, to start the vehicle moving.
9. Do not make range shifts with the vehicle moving To shift from low direct to low overdrive, move
in reverse gear. the splitter control button (Fig. 8.8) into the over-
drive (forward) position, then immediately release
10. Never attempt to move the range preselection the accelerator. Press and release the clutch
lever with the gear shift lever in neutral while the pedal. After releasing the clutch, accelerate
vehicle is moving. Preselection with the range again.
preselection lever must be made prior to moving
the shift lever out of gear into neutral. 5. For 13-speed transmissions:
11. After your shifting ability improves, you may want Shift upward from low to 1st gear, 2nd, etc. until
to skip some of the ratios. This may be done 4th gear, double-clutching between shifts, and
only when operating conditions permit, depend- accelerating to 80 percent of engine governed
ing on the load, grade, and road speed. speed. See Fig. 8.7.
For 18-speed transmissions:
Upshifting
Shift upward from low overdrive to 1st direct by
1. Position the gear shift lever in neutral. Start the first moving the splitter control button into the
engine, and bring the air system pressure up to direct (rearward) position (Fig. 8.8). Move the
100 to 120 psi (689 to 827 kPa). shift lever, double-clutching, to the 1st gear posi-
2. Position the range preselection lever down, into tion.
low range. See Fig. 8.7 or Fig. 8.8. Continue upshifting through the shift pattern.
Double-clutch during lever shifts (1st to 2nd to
1 3rd to 4th); single-clutch during split shifts (1st
5 5 7 7 direct to 1st overdrive, etc.).
Dir OD Dir OD
R 1 1 3 3 6. When in 4th gear (13-speed transmissions) or
Dir OD Dir OD
A
4th overdrive (18-speed transmissions) and
N ready to shift up to 5th gear, use the range shift
lever as follows:
6 6 8 8
LOW LOW
Dir OD Dir OD B For 13-speed transmissions:
Dir OD 2 2 4 4
Dir OD Dir OD
While in 4th gear, pull the range shift preselec-
C D
03/13/96 f260157a tion lever up, into high range. The transmission
A. High Range C. Overdrive (forward)
will automatically shift from low to high range as
B. Low Range D. Direct Drive (rearward) the shift lever passes through neutral. Then, dis-
1. Splitter Control Button
engage the clutch; double-clutch through neutral;
move the shift lever to 5th gear; engage the
Fig. 8.8, Eaton Fuller 18-Speed Transmission Shift clutch, and accelerate the engine.
Pattern
For 18-speed transmissions:
3. Make sure the splitter control button is in the di- While in 4th overdrive, pull the range shift prese-
rect (rearward) position. See Fig. 8.7 or Fig. 8.8. lection lever up, into high range. The transmis-
4. For 13-speed transmissions: sion will automatically shift from low to high
range as the shift lever passes through neutral.
Press the clutch to the floor, shift into low or 1st
gear; then engage the clutch, with the engine at Move the shift lever, double-clutching, to the 5th
or near idle speed, to start the vehicle moving. gear position. Just before making final clutch en-
Accelerate to 80 percent of engine governed gagement, move the splitter control button to the
speed. direct (rearward) position; then engage the clutch

8.10
Transmissions

and accelerate. Do not move the control button the control button while the shift lever is in neu-
while the shift lever is in neutral. tral.
7. Shift up through the high range gears as follows: 5. Continue downshifting from 4th to 1st as follows:
For 13-speed transmissions: For 13-speed transmissions:
To shift from 5th direct to 5th overdrive, move the Downshift through the low range gears as condi-
splitter control button (Fig. 8.7) into the overdrive tions require.
(forward) position, then immediately release the For 18-speed transmissions:
accelerator. Press and release the clutch pedal.
After releasing the clutch, accelerate again. Continue downshifting from 4th overdrive to 4th
direct, then 4th direct to 3rd overdrive, 3rd over-
Continue upshifting through the shift pattern.
drive to 3rd direct, etc. Single-clutch when split
Double-clutch during lever shifts (6th to 7th to
shifting (direct to overdrive, overdrive to direct).
8th); single-clutch during split shifts (6th direct to
Double-clutch when making lever shifts (4th to
6th overdrive, etc.). 3rd, 3rd to 2nd, etc.).
For 18-speed transmissions:
IMPORTANT: Never use the clutch brake when
To shift from 5th direct to 5th overdrive, move the downshifting, or as a brake to slow the vehicle.
splitter control button (Fig. 8.8) into the overdrive
(forward) position, then immediately release the
accelerator. Press and release the clutch pedal. Eaton Fuller Deep-Reduction
After releasing the clutch, accelerate again. Transmissions
Continue upshifting through the shift pattern. Refer to the Eaton website for additional information,
Double-clutch during lever shifts (6th to 7th to www.roadranger.com.
8th); single-clutch during split shifts (6th direct to
6th overdrive, etc.).
General Information, Deep Reduction
Downshifting IMPORTANT: Not all lever positions are used in each
1. Downshift from 8th overdrive to 8th direct without range and the shift patterns vary between transmis-
moving the shift lever. Flip the splitter control but- sions. Be sure to read the shift pattern decal on the
ton to the direct (rearward) position, then imme- dash for the operating instructions for the specific
diately release the accelerator, and disengage transmission installed in your vehicle.
the clutch. Engage the clutch, and accelerate the
engine only after the transmission has shifted. 9-Speed RTOLL Models
2. Start the downshift from 8th direct to 7th over- Eaton Fuller 9-speed deep-reduction transmissions
drive by flipping the splitter control button to the have a 5-speed front section, and a 2-speed rear-
overdrive (forward) position; then, immediately range section, with a deep reduction gear. The deep
double-clutch through neutral, moving the shift reduction (low-low) gear is used only when operating
lever from 8th to 7th gear. under adverse conditions. Low gear in the front sec-
tion is used only for rough, off-highway conditions, as
3. Shift downward through each of the high range a starting ratio. Both the low gear and 1st gear in the
gears, alternating the procedures in steps 1 and low range can be split, using the deep reduction but-
2, above, until reaching 5th direct. ton, for another reduction ratio in those shift lever
4. While in 5th direct and ready for the downshift to positions. The remaining four forward positions are
4th (13-speed transmissions) or 4th overdrive used once in the low range and once in the high
(18-speed transmissions), push the range prese- range. Reverse in the low range can also be split
lection lever down. Then, double-clutch through with the deep reduction button for a lower ratio.
neutral and move the shift lever to the 4th gear
position. On 18-speed transmissions, move the
splitter control button to the overdrive (forward)
position beforeengaging the clutch. Do not move

8.11
Transmissions

10-Speed RTLL, RTOLL and RTXLL directly opposite in the RTO (overdrive ratio)
Models transmissions.
Eaton Fuller 10-speed deep-reduction transmissions Operation, Deep Reduction
have a 5-speed front section, and a 2-speed rear
range section, with a deep reduction button. The low- IMPORTANT: The shifter knob has an interlock
low, deep reduction gear is used only when operating feature that prevents the deep reduction button
under adverse conditions. Low gear in the front sec- from being moved forward when the range pre-
tion is used only for rough, off-highway conditions, as selection lever is up (in high range); when in low
a starting ratio. The remaining four forward positions range and the deep reduction button is in the
are used once in the low range and once in the high
range. See Fig. 8.9 for the shift pattern.
forward position, the range preselection lever
cannot be moved up.
1 1. For all driving conditions, use the highest gear
5 7 that is still low enough to start the vehicle moving
1 3 with the engine idling, and without slipping the
clutch excessively.
A
N 2. Use the clutch brake to stop gear rotation when
shifting into low-low, low-1st (whichever is used
B 6 8
as a starting ratio) or reverse, when the vehicle
2 4 is stationary. The clutch brake is actuated by de-
C D pressing the clutch pedal all the way to the floor.
12/14/1999 f261055
For normal upshifts and downshifts, only a partial
A. High Range disengagement of the clutch is necessary to
B. Low Range break engine torque.
C. Deep Reduction IN (forward)
D. Deep Reduction OUT (rearward) 3. Double-clutch between all upshifts and down-
1. Deep Reduction Button shifts.
Fig. 8.9, Eaton Fuller 10-Speed Deep-Reduction 4. Never move the shift lever into low gear while in
Transmission Shift Patterns high range.

NOTE: The 3rd/7th and 4th/8th shift positions in 5. Do not preselect with the deep reduction button.
the RT and RTX-LL transmissions are opposite When making the shift from a deep reduction
ratio to a low range ratio, move the deep reduc-
of the RTO-LL transmissions.
tion button from a forward position to a rearward
15-Speed RT/RTO Deep-Reduction position, then complete the shift immediately.
Models 6. Never move the deep reduction button from a
rearward position to a forward position when the
Eaton Fuller 15-speed deep-reduction transmissions transmission is in high range.
have a 5-speed front section, and a 2-speed rear
range section. They also have five additional deep 7. Do not shift from high range to low range at high
reduction ratios. The 5-speed front section, and the vehicle speeds.
low and high range sections provide 10 evenly and 8. Do not make range shifts with the vehicle moving
progressively spaced forward speeds. The five deep in reverse gear.
reduction ratios are also evenly and progressively
spaced; however, they do overlap the low range ra- 9. Never attempt to move the range preselection
tios, and should be used only when operating under lever with the gear shift lever in neutral while the
adverse conditions. See Fig. 8.10 for the shift vehicle is moving. Preselection with the range
patterns. preselection lever must be made prior to moving
the shift lever out of gear into neutral.
NOTE: The 4th/9th, and the 5th/10th shift posi-
tions in the RT (direct ratio) transmissions are

8.12
Transmissions

10
A B
9
Lo Hi 7 9 8 1 Lo Hi 7 10
R 2 2 4 4 R 2 2 5 5
7 DR Lo DR Lo
DR DR Lo DR Lo DR
6

5
4 4
N 3 2 N
5 2
4 1
3
5
6 8 10 6 8 9
1 1 3 3 5 5 2 1 1 3 3 4 4
DR Lo DR Lo DR Lo 1 6 7 DR Lo DR Lo DR Lo
3

03/13/96 f260045a

A. RT Models B. RTO Models


1. High Range 4. High Range 6. Forward for IN
2. Low Range 5. Low Range 7. Rearward for OUT
3. Deep Reduction

Fig. 8.10, Eaton Fuller 15-Speed Deep-Reduction Transmission Shift Patterns

10. After your shifting ability improves, you may want 5. For 9/10-speed transmissions:
to skip some of the ratios. This may be done
When ready for the next upshift, move the deep
only when operating conditions permit, depend- reduction button rearward, then break the torque
ing on the load, grade, and road speed. on the gears by momentarily releasing the accel-
erator or depressing the clutch pedal. Do not
Upshifting move the shift lever.
There are several patterns of upshifting, depending For 15-speed transmissions:
on the vehicle load and the road conditions. See
Table 8.2 for suggested shifting sequences. Deep Shift upward from 1st gear of deep reduction to
reduction gears are best suited for heavy loads and 5th gear of deep reduction, double-clutching be-
steep inclines. Low gear (in 10-speed transmissions) tween shifts and accelerating to 80 percent of
is best suited for off-highway use. engine governed speed. See Table 8.2.
The following instructions are recommended for start- When ready for the next upshift, move the deep
ing a loaded vehicle moving, under adverse condi- reduction button from the forward position to the
tions. rearward position, then double-clutch through
neutral, and move the shift lever to the 4th gear
1. Position the gear shift lever in neutral. Start the position in the low range.
engine, and bring the vehicle air system pressure
up to 100 to 120 psi (689 to 827 kPa). 6. Shift upward from low gear (9/10-speed trans-
missions) or 4th gear (15-speed transmissions),
2. Position the range preselection lever down, into to the top gear in low range (Table 8.2), double-
low range. clutching between shifts, and accelerating to 80
3. Move the deep reduction button to the forward percent of engine governed speed.
position, to engage the deep reduction gears. 7. While in the top gear of the low range shift pat-
4. Depress the clutch pedal to the floor; shift into tern, and ready for the next upshift, flip the range
low-low gear (9/10-speed transmissions) or 1st preselection lever up into high range. Double-
gear of deep reduction (15-speed transmissions); clutch through neutral, and shift into the bottom
then engage the clutch, with the engine at or gear in high range (Table 8.2). As the shift lever
near idle speed, to start the vehicle moving. Ac- passes through neutral, the transmission will au-
celerate to 80 percent of engine governed speed. tomatically shift from low range to high range.

8.13
Transmissions

Eaton Fuller Deep-Reduction and Range-Shift Shift Progressions


DEEP REDUCTION LOW RANGE HIGH RANGE
TRANSMISSION
Adverse Conditions Off-Highway and On-Highway and Ideal
MODEL All Conditions
Only Adverse Conditions Conditions
6
R 2 4 R 2 4 R 2 4 R 7
DR DR Lo Lo Lo Lo

15-Speed RT and RTX 6


1 3 5 1 3 5 1 3 5 8 10
DR DR DR Lo Lo Lo Lo Lo Lo
f260345 f260346 f260347 f260348

Table 8.2, Eaton Fuller Deep-Reduction and Range-Shift Shift Progressions

8. With the transmission in high range, shift pro-


gressively upward through each of the high
Eaton Fuller Super 10, Top 2,
range gears (Table 8.2), double-clutching be- and Lightning Semi-Automated
tween shifts.
Transmissions
Alternate Upshifting Procedures (15- Refer to the Eaton website for additional information,
Speed Transmissions Only) www.roadranger.com.
The shift from deep reduction to low range can also
be made from 2nd, 3rd, or 4th gear of deep reduc-
General Information, Super 10/Top
tion, but must be made to the next gear lower in the 2/Lightning
low range. The shift from 2nd gear of deep reduction
Super 10, Top 2, and Lightning transmissions have
to 1st gear in low range (or 3rd gear of deep reduc-
10 selective forward ratios and a 2-speed rear splitter
tion to 2nd gear in low range, and 4th gear of deep
section. Half of the 10 speed ratios are shifted with
reduction to 3rd gear in low range), is an upshift, and
the shift lever and the other half are shifted by mov-
the same procedure should be followed as that
ing the shift button. See Fig. 8.11 for the Super 10
shown for shifting from 5th gear of deep reduction to
and Top 2 shift knob, and Fig. 8.12 for the Lightning
4th gear in low range. See step 5, under "Upshifting."
shift knob.
Downshifting
1. With the transmission in high range, shift pro- B
gressively downward to the bottom gear in high Fuller
range, double-clutching between shifts.
2. When in the bottom gear of the high range shift
pattern, and ready for the next downshift, push
the range preselection lever down into low range. A
Fuller
Double-clutch through neutral, and shift into the
top gear of the low range shift pattern. As the
shift lever passes through neutral, the transmis- C
09/25/96 f260399
sion will automatically shift from high range to A. Splitter Shift Button
low range. B. Gears 2, 4, 6, 8, 10 when button is forward
3. With the transmission in low range, downshift C. Gears 1, 3, 5, 7, 9 when button is rearward
through the low range gears, as conditions re- Fig. 8.11, Super 10 and Top 2 Shift Knob
quire.
There are three types of shifts used with these trans-
IMPORTANT: Never use the clutch brake when missions. Button-only and combination button/lever
downshifting, or as a brake to slow the vehicle. shifts are both full gear changes. The lever-only shift
skips a gear.

8.14
Transmissions

HI 8
4
LO R
R 3 7
N
1
2 6 10
1 5 9
09/24/96 f260397

NOTE: The Top 2 and Lightning transmissions use the


Super 10 shift pattern when cruise control is off.
2
Fig. 8.13, Super 10 Shift Pattern

09/12/2002 f261190
1. Shift Button 2. Service Light
Fig. 8.12, Lightning Shift Knob
HI 4 8
R
LO
The button-only shift is a gear split shift that R 3 7
occurs by moving the shift button.
NEUTRAL
The lever-only shift occurs when the shift lever
is moved without moving the shift button.
The combination button/lever shift is a gear 2 6 A
U
ratio change that occurs when both the shift
1 5 T
button and the shift lever are moved. O
The small red service light on the Lightning shift 12/14/1999 f261054
knob illuminates for a few seconds when the engine
is turned on. This confirms that the transmission Fig. 8.14, Top 2 and Lightning Shift Patterns (with
electronics are operating properly. cruise control on)

NOTE: If the service light stays on or flashes, or Operation, Super 10/Top 2/Lightning
does not illuminate when the engine starts, take
the vehicle to an authorized Freightliner or
Eaton service facility as soon as possible.
CAUTION
See Fig. 8.13for the Super 10 shift pattern, which is Keep the transmission in gear at all times while
also used by Top 2 and Lightning when the cruise the vehicle in motion. Coasting in neutral could
control is off. Top 2 and Lightning transmissions are lead to transmission damage.
equipped with the Top 2 feature that allows the trans- 1. When operating off-highway, or under adverse
mission, with cruise control on, to automatically shift conditions, always use low gear (if so equipped)
between the top two gears (9th-10th) without the when starting to move the vehicle.
need for a button-only shift. See Fig. 8.14.
When operating on-highway, with no load, or
IMPORTANT: Not all lever positions are used in each under ideal conditions, use 1st gear when start-
range and the shift patterns vary between transmis- ing to move the vehicle.
sions. Be sure to read the shift pattern decal on the
dash for the operating instructions for the specific For all conditions, use the highest gear that is
transmission installed in your vehicle. still low enough to start the vehicle moving with
engine idling, and without slipping the clutch ex-
cessively.

8.15
Transmissions

2. Use the clutch brake to stop gear rotation when The lever-only shift is used to skip a full gear.
shifting into 1st or reverse when the vehicle is With the shift button rearward1st to 3rd, 3rd to
stationary. The clutch brake is actuated by de- 5th, 5th to 7th, and 7th to 9th. With the shift but-
pressing the clutch pedal all the way to the floor. ton forward2nd to 4th, 4th to 6th, 6th to 8th,
8th to 10th.
For normal upshifts and downshifts, only a partial
disengagement of the clutch is necessary to NOTE: Lever-only shifts skip an entire gear ratio
break engine torque. and will require the engine rpm to decrease
3. Do not make splitter shifts with the vehicle mov- twice the amount of a normal shift.
ing in reverse gear. 5. Combination button/lever shiftPreselect the
4. The shift lever should not be moved to the center next gear by sliding the shift button rearward.
or left rail positions at vehicle speeds above 40 Break torque by releasing the throttle and de-
mph (65 km/h). pressing the clutch pedal. Double-clutch and
move the shift lever to the next desired gear po-
5. Double-clutch between all upshifts and down- sition.
shifts.
The combination button/lever shift is used for
6. After your shifting ability improves, you may want gear changes from 2nd to 3rd, 4th to 5th, 6th to
to skip some of the ratios. This may be done 7th and 8th to 9th.
only when operating conditions permit, depend-
ing on the load, grade, and road speed. Downshifting
7. Avoid hunting for neutral by moving the gear shift
lever from the left rail to right rail. This action can CAUTION
cause excessive transmission wear.
Do not attempt a button-only downshift at too
Upshifting high an engine speed (generally above 1400
rpm). Doing so could result in damage to the en-
1. Position the gear shift lever in neutral. Start the gine, transmission, and/or driveline.
engine, and bring the air system pressure up to
100 to 120 psi (689 to 827 kPa). 1. Button-only shiftWith the throttle still applied,
preselect the next gear by sliding the shift button
2. Press the clutch pedal to the floor. Shift into 1st rearward. Break torque by releasing the throttle
gear, then engage the clutch, with the engine at or by depressing the clutch pedal. Increase en-
or near idle speed, to start the vehicle moving. gine speed to synchronize the engine speed with
3. Button-only shiftPreselect the next gear by the transmission speed. The shift will complete
sliding the shift button forward. Break torque by when the engine rpm has increased to the
releasing the throttle or by depressing the clutch proper speed.
pedal. Decrease engine speed to synchronize The button-only shift is used for gear changes
the engine speed with the transmission speed. from 10th to 9th, 8th to 7th, 6th to 5th, 4th to 3rd,
The shift will complete when the engine rpm has and 2nd to 1st.
decreased to the proper speed.
The button-only shift is used for gear changes CAUTION
from 1st to 2nd, 3rd to 4th, 5th to 6th, 7th to 8th,
and 9th to 10th. Do not attempt a lever-only downshift at too high
4. Lever-only shiftBreak torque by releasing the an engine speed (generally above 1000 rpm).
throttle and depressing the clutch pedal. Double- Doing so could result in damage to the engine,
clutching, move the shift lever to the next desired transmission, and/or driveline.
gear position. Decrease engine speed to syn- 2. Lever-only shiftBreak torque by releasing the
chronize the engine speed with the transmission throttle and depressing the clutch pedal. Double-
speed. The shift will complete when the engine clutching, move the shift lever to the next desired
rpm has decreased to the proper speed. gear position.

8.16
Transmissions

The lever-only shift is used to skip a full gear. gear in the front sections of the "A" and "B" ratio
With the shift button rearward9th to 7th, 7th to transmissions is used only as a starting ratio. The
5th, 5th to 3rd, and 3rd to 1st. With the shift but- high gear in the front section of the "R" ratio trans-
ton forward10th to 8th, 8th to 6th, 6th to 4th missions is used only as the top gear. The remaining
and 4th to 2nd. gear positions of the above transmissions are used
once in the low range and once in the high range.
IMPORTANT: Never use the clutch brake when See Fig. 8.15 for the shift patterns.
downshifting, or as a brake to slow the vehicle.
A B
CAUTION 5 7 5 8
1 3 1 4
Do not attempt a combination button/lever down- 1
shift at too high an engine speed (generally
above 1400 rpm). Doing so could result in dam- N N
age to the engine, transmission, and/or driveline.
2
3. Combination button/lever shiftWith the throttle 6 8 6 7
2 4 2 3
still applied, preselect the next gear by sliding
the shift button forward. Break torque by releas- 12/14/1999 f261046
ing the throttle and depressing the clutch pedal. A. All M and MX B. All MO Transmissions
Double-clutch and move the shift lever to the Transmissions
next desired gear position.
1. High Range 2. Low Range
The combination button/lever shift is used for
gear changes from 9th to 8th, 7th to 6th, 5th to Fig. 8.15, Meritor 9-Speed Transmission Shift Patterns
4th, and 3rd to 2nd.
NOTE: The 3rd/7th and 4th/8th shift positions in
Meritor Range-Shift the M and MX (direct ratio) are opposite of the
MO (overdrive ratio) transmissions. The MX-R
Transmissions ratio transmissions have the 1st/5th shift posi-
Refer to the Meritor website for additional informa- tions where low is in the A and B ratio transmis-
tion, www.arvinmeritor.com. sions. The top gear in the MX-R ratio transmis-
sions is called 9th gear.
General Information, Meritor Range-
10-Speed M Models
Shift
Meritor 10-speed transmissions have 10 evenly-
To operate a range-shift transmission, move the shift spaced forward ratios. Each transmission consists of
lever through all the low gear positions and then acti- a 5-speed front section, and a 2-speed auxiliary sec-
vate a range switch to provide an additional set of tion. The 10 forward speeds are obtained by twice
ratios in the high range. Using the same shift lever using a 5-speed shift pattern: the first time in low
positions as in low range, move the shift lever range; the second time in high range. See Fig. 8.16
through each position as before. On some models, for the shift pattern.
the initial low gear is often used only in low range.
IMPORTANT: Not all lever positions are used in each Operation, Meritor Range-Shift
range and the shift patterns vary between transmis-
sions. Be sure to read the shift pattern decal on the Reverse
dash for the operating instructions for the specific To drive in reverse, push the range selector lever
transmission installed in your vehicle. down to put the transmission in the low range. Push
the clutch pedal to the bottom of travel so the clutch
9-Speed M and MO Models brake slows the transmission for initial gear engage-
Meritor 9-speed transmissions have a 5-speed front ment. Holding the clutch pedal at the bottom of
section, and a 2-speed auxiliary section. The low travel, shift into reverse.

8.17
Transmissions

A B Meritor Range-Shift Shift Progressions


7 9 7 10 TRANS. LOW RANGE HIGH
2 4 2 5 MODEL Off-Highway On-Highway RANGE
C 5 7
R 1 3 R 1 3 R
N N 9-Speed
Direct (M) LOW 6 8
D 2 4 2 4
f260322 f260321 f260320
6 8 10 6 8 9
1 3 5 1 3 4 R R R
5 8
9-Speed 1 4 1 4
03/13/96 f260155a Overdrive 6 7
LOW LOW
A. All M Transmissions C. High Range (MO) 2 3 2 3
f260327 f260327 f260328
B. All MO Transmissions D. Low Range
7 9
10-Speed R 2 4 R 2 4 R
Fig. 8.16, Meritor 10-Speed Transmission Shift Patterns Direct or
Overdrive 6 8 10
Slowly release the clutch pedal to move the vehicle (M)
1 3 5 1 3 5
f260329 f260329 f260330
in reverse.
R R 7 10
2 5 2 5 R
Upshifting 10-Speed
Overdrive 6 8 9
1. To drive forward, make sure the vehicle is com- (MO) 1 3 4 1 3 4
f260331 f260331 f260332
pletely stopped and the range selector lever is
pushed down to put the transmission in the low Table 8.3, Meritor Range-Shift Shift Progressions
range.
Push the clutch pedal to the bottom of travel so 7. To upshift into high rangewith the transmission
the clutch brake slows the transmission for initial still in the highest low range gearmove the
gear engagement; holding the clutch pedal at the range selector lever up to put the transmission
bottom of travel, shift into low. into high range, then partially depress the clutch
2. Slowly release the clutch pedal to begin moving pedal and move the shift lever into neutral. As
the vehicle forward. the shift lever passes through neutral, the trans-
mission will automatically shift from low range to
3. To upshift into 1st gear, only partial depression of high range.
the clutch pedal is needed. Do not push the
8. Release the clutch pedal, and let the engine slow
clutch pedal all the way to the floor and engage
until the road speed and engine rpm match.
the clutch brake; instead, partially depress the
clutch pedal, and move the shift lever into neu- 9. Partially depress the clutch pedal, and move the
tral. shift lever into the lowest gear in the high range,
4. Release the clutch, and allow the engine to de- 5th gear in 9-speed models and 6th gear in 10-
celerate until the road speed and the engine rpm speed models.
match. 10. Double-clutch to continue upshifting.
5. Partially depress the clutch pedal, and move the
shift lever into first gear.
Downshifting
1. With the transmission in high range, shift pro-
6. Double-clutch and continue upshifting until you
gressively downward to the bottom gear in high
reach the top gear in the low range, 4th gear in
range, 5th gear in 9-speed models and 6th gear
9-speed models and 5th gear in 10-speed
in 10-speed models. Double-clutch between
models. See Table 8.3.
shifts. See Table 8.3.
2. When in the bottom gear of the high range shift
pattern, and ready for the next downshift, push
the range selection lever down into low range.

8.18
Transmissions

Double-clutch through neutral, and shift into the


top gear of the low range shift pattern. As the Hi 5 5 7 7 1
R Dir OD Dir OD
shift lever passes through neutral, the transmis- Lo 1 3
sion will automatically shift from high range to A
low range.
3. With the transmission in low range, downshift N
through the low range gears as conditions re- B
C
quire. 6 6 8 8
LOW Dir OD Dir OD
IMPORTANT: Never use the clutch brake when 2 4 D
03/13/96 f260154a
downshifting, or as a brake to slow the vehicle.
A. High Range C. Overdrive
B. Low Range D. Direct Drive
Meritor Splitter and Range- 1. Splitter Control Button
Shift Transmissions Fig. 8.17, Meritor 13-Speed Transmission Shift Pattern
Refer to the Meritor website for additional informa-
tion, www.arvinmeritor.com. The splitter control button is on the side of the shift
knob. Each of the four high range gear positions can
General Information, Meritor Splitter be split with the overdrive ratio of the splitter gear.
Ratios cannot be split while the transmission is in low
and Range-Shift range.
Combination splitter and range-shift transmissions
allow the choice of two splitter ratios in each lever Operation, Meritor Splitter and
position as well as the additional ratio provided in Range-Shift
each lever position in high range after shifting to the
other range. IMPORTANT: The shifter knob has an interlock
feature that prevents the splitter control button
IMPORTANT: Not all lever positions are used in each
from being moved up when the range selection
range and the shift patterns vary between transmis-
sions. Be sure to read the shift pattern decal on the lever is down (in the low range); when the trans-
dash for the operating instructions for the specific mission is in the high range, and the splitter
transmission installed in your vehicle. control button is up, the range selection lever
cannot be moved down.
13-Speed MO Models
Reverse
Meritor 13-speed transmissions have 13 forward
speeds and two reverse speeds. Each transmission To drive in reverse, push the range selector lever
consists of a 5-speed front section, and a 3-speed down to put the transmission in the low range. Push
auxiliary section. The auxiliary section contains low the clutch pedal to the bottom of travel so the clutch
and high range ratios, plus an overdrive splitter gear brake slows the transmission for initial gear engage-
for high range. See Fig. 8.17. ment; holding the clutch pedal at the bottom of travel,
shift into reverse.
All of the thirteen speeds are controlled with one shift
lever. Low gear in the front section is used only as a Slowly release the clutch pedal to move the vehicle
starting ratio. The remaining four forward positions in reverse.
are used once in the low range and once in the high
range. Upshifting
The range selection lever is on the back of the shift 1. To drive forward, make sure the vehicle is com-
knob. When in the top gear position of the low range, pletely stopped and the range selector lever is
toggle the range lever up just before shifting into the pushed down to put the transmission in the low
lowest gear position in the high range. range.

8.19
Transmissions

Push the clutch pedal to the bottom of travel so 12. Shift upward through each of the high range
the clutch brake slows the transmission for initial gears, alternating the procedures in steps 10 and
gear engagement; holding the clutch pedal at the 11, above.
bottom of travel, shift into low.
Downshifting
2. Slowly release the clutch pedal to begin moving
the vehicle forward. 1. Downshift from 8th overdrive to 8th direct without
moving the shift lever. Flip the splitter control but-
3. To upshift into 1st gear, only partial depression of
ton down to the direct drive position, then imme-
the clutch pedal is needed. Do not push the
diately release the accelerator, and press and
clutch pedal all the way to the floor and engage
release the clutch pedal. Accelerate the engine
the clutch brake; instead, partially depress the
only after the transmission has shifted.
clutch pedal, and move the shift lever into neu-
tral. 2. To downshift from 8th direct to 7th overdrive, flip
the splitter control button up to the overdrive po-
4. Release the clutch pedal, and allow the engine
sition, then immediately double-clutch through
to decelerate until the road speed and the engine
neutral, moving the shift lever from 8th to 7th
rpm match.
gear.
5. Partially depress the clutch pedal, and move the 3. Downshift through each of the high range gears
shift lever into 1st gear. alternating the procedures in steps 1 and 2,
6. Double-clutch to continue upshifting until in fourth above, until reaching 5th direct.
gear. See Table 8.3. 4. While in 5th direct, and ready for the next down-
7. To upshift into high rangewith the transmission shift, push the range selection lever down into
still in 4th gearpush the range selection lever low range. Double-clutch through neutral, and
up to put the transmission into high range, then shift into 4th gear. See Fig. 8.17. As the shift
partially depress the clutch pedal and move the lever passes through neutral, the transmission
shift lever into neutral. As the shift lever passes will automatically shift from high range to low
through neutral, the transmission will automati- range.
cally shift from low range to high range. 5. With the transmission in low range, downshift
8. Release the clutch pedal, and let the engine slow through the low range gears as conditions re-
until the road speed and engine rpm match. quire.
9. Partially disengage the clutch, and move the shift IMPORTANT: Never use the clutch brake when
lever into 5th gear. downshifting, or as a brake to slow the vehicle.
10. To upshift from 5th gear into 5th overdrive, flip
the splitter control button up to the overdrive po- Meritor Engine Synchro Shift
sition; then, immediately release the accelerator,
and press and release the clutch pedal. It is not
(ESS) Automated Models
necessary to move the shift lever when shifting General Information, ESS
from direct to overdrive; the transmission will
shift when synchronization with the engines 9Speed and 10Speed M, MO, RS, and
speed is reached. Accelerate the engine only RSX Models
after the transmission has shifted.
Meritor 9-speed and 10-speed automated transmis-
11. To shift from 5th overdrive to 6th direct, partially sions do not require use of the clutch except to start
disengage the clutch, shift into 6thbut before and stop the vehicle.
engaging the clutchflip the splitter control but-
ton down into the direct drive position; then en- NOTE: Meritor M and MO series ESS transmis-
gage the clutch, and accelerate the engine. sions are available only on vehicles equipped
with either Caterpillar or Cummins electronic
Do not move the control button while the shift
lever is in neutral.

8.20
Transmissions

engines. Meritor RS and RSX series ESS trans-


missions are only available on vehicles
equipped with Detroit Diesel electronic engines.
The ESS system works with the engine fuel 1
control system to automatically synchronize en-
gine rpm to road speed during gear changes.
Use the clutch only to start and stop the vehicle 2
and to shift into forward or reverse. The HI and
LO ranges are automated, so the driver does
not have to select ranges. A "break torque" fea-
ture allows the driver to move the shift lever and
take the transmission out of gear without chang-
ing throttle position. Throttle position can be
maintained while braking and downshifting 02/17/98 f270058

through the gears when stopping the vehicle, as 1. Shift-Intent Switch 2. System Switch
well as on steep grades. Fig. 8.18, ESS Shift Handle
The major components of the ESS system are
the system switch, shift-intent switch, input and
output shaft speed sensors, a Neutral position
sensor, and an electro-pneumatic solenoid.

Operation, ESS
The ESS system collects and relays information per- B
A
taining to the positions of the shift-intent and system 02/17/98 f270059
switches (Fig. 8.18), transmission input and output
shaft speeds, and shift lever position. The informa- A. Press the top portion (engage the first position) of
the shift-intent switch to begin an upshift.
tion is received by the engine Electronic Control
B. Press the top portion again (engage the second
Module (ECM) which signals the fuel control system position) to break torque.
to increase or decrease engine rpm to match road
speed. The ECM also controls HI and LO range se- Fig. 8.19, ESS Upshifting Using the Shift-Intent Switch
lection in the auxiliary case on the rear of the
transmission. the HI range on upshifts and the bottom of the
switch (Fig. 8.20) to select the LO range on
The system switch (Fig. 8.18) is the lower switch lo-
cated on the drivers side of the shift handle. It con- downshifts.
trols ESS system operation. When in the down posi-
tion, the system is operating and the word ON is WARNING
visible on the switch. In the up position, the word
OFF is visible, the system is not operating, and the Ensure that the transmission is in neutral (N)
transmission can be shifted manually. when you start the vehicle. If the vehicle is
started in gear, it will suddenly move forward or
The shift-intent switch (Fig. 8.18) is the upper switch
backward which could result in personal injury
on the drivers side of the shift handle. It has four
and damage to property and the transmission.
positions and controls upshifting and downshifting by
communicating to the ECM the drivers intention of Starting the Vehicle
changing gears.
1. Ensure that the shift lever is in the neutral (N)
NOTE: If the system switch is OFF, use the position.
shift-intent switch to select between ranges.
Push the top of the switch (Fig. 8.19) to select

8.21
Transmissions

mission returns to manual operation. To reacti-


vate the ESS system, press the shift-intent
switch again. See the following procedures for
upshifting and downshifting for instructions on
how to use the shift-intent switch.

B Upshifting
A
02/17/98 f270060 1. To upshift into the next higher gear:
A. Press the bottom portion (engage the first position) 1.1 Press the top portion of the shift-intent
of the shift-intent switch to begin a downshift.
switch.
B. Press the bottom portion again (engage the second
position) to break torque. 1.2 Apply pressure with the shift lever toward
the neutral position.
Fig. 8.20, ESS Downshifting Using the Shift-Intent
Switch 1.3 Press the top portion of the shift-intent
switch again, far enough so that the
2. Push the clutch pedal to the bottom of its travel switch goes into a second position inside
to engage the clutch brake. the body of the shift handle. Then release
3. Start the engine. the switch. See Fig. 8.19. This will break
torque.
4. Slowly release the clutch pedal.
1.4 Immediately move the shift lever to the
5. Allow the system air to build up to the range neutral position.
specified on the gauge.
1.5 Allow engine rpm to slow down enough to
6. Release the parking brake. synchronize with road speed.
Shifting Into a Starting Gear 1.6 Move the shift lever to the next higher
gear.
CAUTION 2. To upshift through the rest of the gears, repeat
the substeps above. Before each upshift, push
Always use the proper starting gear. Do not shift the top of the shift-intent switch into the shift
into neutral and coast, as this will result in dam- handle body to break torque. The range shift is
age to the transmission. automatic.
1. Press the system switch down, into the ON posi- 3. To skip a gear, press the shift-intent switch into
tion, to activate the ESS system. the shift handle body, while in Neutral, one time
2. for every gear that is skipped.
Press the top portion of the shift-intent switch.
IMPORTANT: Use the clutch brake only when Downshifting
initially engaging a gear with the vehicle stand- 1. To downshift into the next lower gear.
ing still.
1.1 Press the bottom portion of the shift-intent
3. Push the clutch pedal to the bottom of its travel switch.
so that the clutch brake stops the transmission
input shaft from rotating. 1.2 Apply pressure with the shift lever toward
the neutral position.
4. Move the shift lever and engage a starting gear.
1.3 Press the bottom portion of the shift-intent
5. Slowly release the clutch pedal. switch again, far enough so that the
NOTE: If you do not shift the transmission out of switch goes into a second position inside
neutral into a gear within two seconds, the ESS the body of the shift knob. Then release
the switch. See Fig. 8.20. This will break
system will "time out" and deactivate. The trans- torque.

8.22
Transmissions

1.4 Immediately move the shift lever to the


neutral position.
Eaton UltraShift DM
1.5 Allow engine rpm to speed up enough to General Information, UltraShift DM
synchronize with road speed. Eaton Fuller UltraShift DM is a ten-speed heavy-
1.6 Move the shift lever to the next lower duty fully automated transmission. No clutch pedal is
gear. required to operate the vehicle.
2. To downshift through the rest of the gears, re- UltraShift DM uses a dry clutch system which is of-
peat the substeps above. Before each downshift, fered only on this automated transmission system.
push the bottom of the shift-intent switch into the The UltraShift transmission uses the four-position
shift handle body to break torque. The range SmartShift lever on the steering column to select
shift is automatic. gears. To know what gear the transmission is in, look
3. To skip a gear, press the shift-intent switch into at the round current gear indicator on the right-hand
the shift handle, while in neutral, one time for control panel as shown in Fig. 8.22. All forward shifts
every gear that is skipped. can be made either manually or automatically, at the
drivers choice.
Reverse
Operation, UltraShift DM
1. Press the system switch on the shift handle so
that it is in the ON position and the ESS system Power Up
is activated. 1. With the parking brake set, select neutral (N) by
2. Push the clutch pedal to the bottom of its travel moving the selector switch to the N position.
so that the clutch brake stops the transmission 2. With the transmission in neutral, turn on the igni-
input shaft from rotating. tion switch. The "CHECK TRANS" and "TRANS
3. Move the shift lever and engage reverse. TEMP" telltale lights come on and go out again
(bulb check). See Fig. 8.23.
4. Slowly release the clutch pedal and move the
vehicle in the reverse direction. 3. After the ignition is turned on, the current gear
indicator shows the dot display, arranged in a
NOTE: If a HI reverse range is required, follow square pattern. All dots in the pattern should light
the steps below. up, without gaps or spaces. See Fig. 8.24.
5. Press the system switch on the shift handle so 4. Wait for the current gear indicator to show a solid
that it is in the OFF position and the ESS system "N." When the "N" is solid, rather than flashing,
is deactivated. the UltraShift DM TCU is powered up. Apply the
service brake and start the engine.
6. Press the top portion of the shift-intent switch to
engage the HI range. 5. Select drive (D) by pressing in the neutral lock
button and moving the selector switch downward
7. Push the clutch pedal to the bottom of its travel to the position below neutral. Release the park-
so that the clutch brake stops the transmission ing brake. The gear is displayed on the current
input shaft from rotating. gear indicator.
8. Move the shift lever and engage reverse.
NOTE: When D is selected, the transmission
9. Slowly release the clutch pedal and move the controller starts up in second gear. If desired,
vehicle in the reverse direction. the driver can select to start up in first. No other
See Fig. 8.21 for two ESS 9-speed shift patterns start gear is available.
and one ESS 10-speed shift pattern. 6. On a level grade, release the service brake and
press down on the throttle pedal to allow the ve-
hicle to move forward. The vehicle will not move
until the pedal is depressed.

8.23
Transmissions

R 5 7 R 6 8 R 7 9
R 1 3 R 2 4 R 2 4

N N N

LO 2 4 1 3 1 3 5
9
6 8 5 7 6 8 10
A B C
02/17/98 f270061
A. 9-Speed Shift Pattern with LO B. 9-Speed Shift Pattern C. 10-Speed Shift Pattern
Gear
Fig. 8.21, Meritor ESS 9- and 10-Speed Shift Patterns

1 1 2

CHECK
TRANS
2
TRANS
TEMP

BRAKE

10/27/2003 f610677
1. "CHECK TRANS" Light
2. "TRANS TEMP" Light

12/22/2003 f270079a
Fig. 8.23, Telltale Lights

To know what gear the transmission is in, look at the 7. Prevent the vehicle from rolling backwards when
current gear indicator. stopped on a hill or grade, or when the vehicle is
1. Current Gear Indicator starting from a stop on a hill or grade.
2. SmartShift Control
7.1 To start from a full stop on a hill or grade,
Fig. 8.22, Shift Controls and Indicators, UltraShift quickly move your foot from the brake
Transmissions pedal and press firmly on the throttle
pedal.
WARNING On steep hills, set the parking brake and
release it only when there is enough en-
When starting or stopping on hills and grades, gine power to prevent rollback.
use extra care to prevent the vehicle from rolling
back. A rollback accident could cause death, seri- 7.2 To stop on a hill or grade, press and hold
ous personal injury, or property damage. the brake pedal to keep the vehicle from
moving.

8.24
Transmissions

1 2

10/13/2003 f610678

Fig. 8.24, Power-Up Dot Display


01/21/2004 f270079c
On steep hills, set the parking brake. 1. Slide Switch (controls forward driving mode)
When parking, chock the tires, front and/or 2. Selector Switch (controls gear selection)
rear. Never hold a hill with the throttle 3. Neutral Lock Button (prevents accidental shift into
pedal. This will cause the clutch to over- gear)
heat. Fig. 8.25, Switches, UltraShift Transmissions
Power Down load-based shift point for an automatic shift, the
1. Apply the service brakes. UltraShift DM TCU will advance the shift.
2. Select neutral (N) by pressing in the neutral lock In either mode, the gear indicator displays the cur-
button and moving the selector switch to N. rent gear. See Fig. 8.26.
When the "N" on the current gear indicator is
solid, rather than flashing, the UltraShift DM TCU
is ready to power down.
3. With the transmission in neutral, set the parking
brake.
4. Turn off the ignition key and shut down the en-
gine.

Automatic and Manual Modes


The SmartShift control has a slide switch located on
the body of the control lever just before the paddle
widens out. See Fig. 8.25. The slide switch controls
the forward driving mode, automatic or manual.
10/13/2003 f610680
To change mode at any time, move the slide switch NOTE: The gear indicator displays the current gear. In
in the desired direction. This allows the driver to re- this example, it displays first gear.
spond to a wide range of driving conditions, such as
blind corners, tight curves, and steep hills. Fig. 8.26, Current Gear Display

IMPORTANT: Whatever the mode, it is always At the start of a shift, the current gear continues to
possible to shift manually by moving the lever display until the transmission has been pulled into
up or down as needed. When the engine speed
is within 75 revolutions per minute (rpm) of the

8.25
Transmissions

neutral. At this point, as the transmission is synchro- When reverse low is selected, the letter "R" displays
nizing for the new (target) gear, the gear indicator on the current gear indicator. When reverse high is
flashes the number of the new gear. selected, the letter "H" displays on the current gear
indicator. See Fig. 8.27.
When the shift is complete, the new gear displays
solid, without flashing.

Automatic Mode (AUTO)


In automatic drive mode (AUTO), upshifts and down-
shifts are made by the transmission without driver
intervention. Press in the neutral lock button, move
the selector switch to drive (D), and press down on
the throttle pedal. The transmission will shift auto-
matically.
If driving conditions require, it is still possible to re-
quest a manual shift. The transmission will make the
shift if the engine speed is within 75 rpm of the load-
based shift point for that gear.
10/14/2003 f610681
If the driver presses down on the throttle pedal after
a manual downshift in automatic mode, the transmis- Fig. 8.27, Reverse Gear Display
sion will upshift again if the UltraShift DM TCU re-
quires it. IMPORTANT: Under normal conditions, do not
select reverse with the vehicle moving forward.
Manual Mode (MAN)
The vehicle must be moving at less than two miles
In manual drive mode (MAN), upshifts and down- per hour (3 km/h) before selecting reverse. If reverse
shifts are made by the driver: is selected when the vehicle is moving faster, an au-
To shift up, pull the lever up (towards you). dible alert will sound and continue sounding at three-
second intervals until the control lever is returned to
To shift down, push the lever down (away from the "D" position or the vehicle slows to the proper
you). speed.
The system will hold the current gear until the driver If necessary to rock the vehicle, use the selector
requests a shift. In downhill situations in particular, switch to shift back and forth at low speed between
the driver must be alert to vehicle speed by down- reverse and drive.
shifting and/or using the service brakes as needed.
A shift request will still be refused if the selected gear Neutral
would cause engine overspeed or excessive lugging. IMPORTANT: Always start the engine with the
Selecting Gears transmission in neutral, the parking brake set,
and the service brakes applied.
Reverse
Neutral (N) is directly below R on the four-position
Reverse (R) is at the upper end of the four-position selector switch located at the end of the SmartShift
selector switch located at the end of the SmartShift control lever. To select N, press in the neutral lock
control lever. To select R, press in the neutral lock button and move the selector switch to the position
button and move the selector switch upward to the below R. When neutral is selected, the letter "N" dis-
position above neutral. plays on the current gear indicator. See Fig. 8.28.
UltraShift DM has two reverse gears, reverse low
and reverse high. To shift manually between them,
use the shift lever as described for MAN mode.
There is no AUTO mode for reverse.

8.26
Transmissions

currently selected forward gear (1 through 10) dis-


plays on the gear indicator. See Fig. 8.26.
When in drive, requests to upshift or downshift are
enabled. Either manual or automatic mode can be
selected on the slide switch.
Two starting gears are available, first and second.
The default starting gear is second, but first can be
selected by the driver, if desired. To change the start-
ing gear, press the brake pedal and select D with the
vehicle stopped. The current gear indicator will dis-
play the starting gear. Move the shift lever up or
down until the desired starting gear is displayed.
10/13/2003 f610679 The UltraShift DM TCU adapts to the working condi-
tions of each vehicle and its driver. After power up or
Fig. 8.28, Neutral Display a load change, it needs to learn the new conditions.
While learning, it may hold a gear too long before
upshifting. Start the upshift manually. It may take
WARNING three or four shifts before UltraShift succeeds in
learning the new load-based shift points, but after
Do not coast in neutral. Coasting in neutral can
that it will handle the shifting automatically.
cause an accident, possibly resulting in severe
personal injury or death.
Low
Neutral is always available during operation, what- Low (L) is at the lower end of the four-position selec-
ever the vehicle speed. When in neutral, requests to tor switch located at the end of the SmartShift control
upshift or downshift are ignored. If the selector switch lever. To select L, press in the neutral lock button
is moved from neutral to drive while the vehicle is and move the selector switch to the position below
moving, the transmission will shift into a gear within D.
the engines operating speed range.
When in low, the current gear is maintained. Re-
When shifting from neutral, always press on the quests to upshift are not enabled.
brake pedal. If the brake pedal is not pressed, the
transmission will not shift, the current gear display IMPORTANT: If the engine is approaching over-
will flash "N," and an audible alert will sound. speed, the UltraShift DM TCU will override the
NOTE: To reset the transmission, return the se- current gear setting and upshift to prevent en-
lector switch on the SmartShift lever to N and gine damage.
attempt the shift again, this time with the brake To enhance engine braking, downshifts are per-
pedal pressed. formed at higher rpm than normal.
Before shutting down the engine, return the selector If L is selected from neutral while stopped, the ve-
switch to N. When the ignition is turned off, the trans- hicle starts up in first gear and stays there until the
mission will reset to neutral in a few minutes regard- engine approaches overspeed.
less of the position of the shift lever.
Upshifting
Drive To request an upshift with the transmission in drive,
Drive (D) is directly below N on the four-position se- pull the control lever up (towards you). If the gear is
lector switch located at the end of the SmartShift available, the transmission upshifts and the new gear
control lever. To select D, press in the neutral lock displays on the gear indicator. No skip shifts are
button and move the selector switch to the position available while upshifting.
below N. When drive is selected, the number of the
No upshifts are available in low, except to prevent
engine overspeed.

8.27
Transmissions

If the transmission does not upshift quickly enough Ultrashift Diagnostics


after power-up or a load change, begin the shift
manually. The UltraShift DM TCU will learn the new Clutch Protection Fault
load-based shift conditions after three or four shifts. Excessive clutch slippage creates heat and reduces
If the gear requested is unavailable, a tone will the life of the clutch. These are some conditions
sound. An unavailable request to upshift is not stored which lead to clutch abuse:
in memory. The upshift must be requested again. Using the throttle to hold the vehicle on a
grade
Downshifting
Starting the vehicle in too high a gear
NOTE: The driver can manually downshift at
any time, even when the slide switch is set to Overloading the vehicle
AUTO mode. Using high idle with the vehicle in gear
To request a downshift with the transmission in drive The UltraShift DM TCU is programmed to prevent
or low, push the control lever down (away from you). clutch abuse. When the clutch overheats, the follow-
If the gear is available, the transmission downshifts ing alerts take place:
and the new gear displays on the gear indicator. Skip
shifts are available while downshifting. The "TRANS TEMP" light comes on

For best engine braking, select low while moving. In The current gear indicator displays "CA"
low, downshifts are performed at higher rpm than in A warning tone sounds at one-second intervals
drive.
The alerts continue until the clutch cools, the throttle
IMPORTANT: If the engine is approaching over- is released, or the clutch is fully engaged.
speed, the UltraShift DM TCU will override the
current gear setting and upshift to prevent en- System Problem
gine damage.
In the event of a problem, do the following steps:
If the gear requested is unavailable, a tone will
1. Note the driving conditions at the time the prob-
sound. An unavailable request to downshift is not
stored in memory. The downshift must be requested lem occurred.
again. 2. Record the status of the transmission at the time
of the problem (AUTO or MAN mode, gear set-
When coasting to a stop, the UltraShift DM TCU may
ting R, N, D, or L, current gear, engine speed,
not finish the downshift until the driver presses down
etc.)
on the throttle pedal again.
3. Reset the system, using the procedure below.
IMPORTANT: A downshift request can never
result in a shift into neutral, even if the vehicle is Reset Procedure
in the drive position in the lowest possible gear.
Transmission operation can sometimes be restored
Before starting down a hill, slow down. Downshift to by doing the following reset procedure:
a speed that you can control without hard pressure
on the service brakes. 1. Stop the vehicle when it is safe to do so. Set the
parking brake.
Before entering a curve, slow down to a safe speed.
Downshift if necessary. This lets you use some 2. Place the selector switch in neutral and turn off
power through the curve to help the vehicle be more the ignition.
stable on the turn. It also allows you to regain speed 3. Check all harness connectors as described in
faster as you come out of the curve. Chapter 11.
4. Wait at least two minutes with the engine shut
down.
5. Restart the engine.

8.28
Transmissions

If the problem continues, contact an authorized


Freightliner or Eaton service facility.

Locked In Gear
If the transmission becomes locked in gear, a dash
() will appear on the current gear indicator when the
vehicle is restarted during the reset procedure.
NOTE: If the transmission becomes locked in
gear while the vehicle is moving, increased
braking effort may be required to stop the ve-
hicle.
If the current gear indicator displays a dash during
power-up with the selector switch in neutral, do the
following steps:
1. Make sure the parking brake is set.
2. Turn off the ignition and wait at least two min-
utes.
3. Apply the service brakes.
4. With the service brakes applied, release the
parking brake.
5. Make sure the selector switch is in neutral and
turn on the ignition key. Do not attempt to start
the engine at this time.
6. If necessary to get the transmission to shift into
neutral, release the pressure on the brake pedal
slightly.
7. Once the UltraShift DM TCU reaches neutral, a
solid "N" will appear on the current gear indicator
and the vehicle will start. Make sure the service
brakes are applied and the parking brake is set.
If the current gear indicator continues to display a
dash, contact an authorized Freightliner or Eaton ser-
vice facility.

8.29
9
Rear Axles
Meritor Single Drive Axles with Traction Equalizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.1
Meritor Drive Axles with Main Differential Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.1
Meritor Main Differential Lock Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.1
Meritor Tandem Drive Axles with Interaxle Differential . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.2
Meritor Interaxle Differential Lockout Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.2
Dana Spicer Axles with Controlled Traction Differential . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.2
Dana Spicer Interaxle Differential Lockout Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.3
Rear Axles

Meritor Single Drive Axles WARNING


with Traction Equalizer
Be especially careful when driving under slippery
Some Meritor single drive axles are equipped with a conditions with the differential locked. Though
traction equalizer that is a load sensing, self- forward traction is improved, the vehicle can still
actuating feature. A traction equalizer provides nor- slip sideways, causing possible loss of vehicle
mal differential action where traction is good. When control, personal injury, and property damage.
one wheel begins to spin faster than the other, clutch
plates in the differential housing automatically en-
gage, delivering power to both wheels. There is no
Meritor Main Differential Lock
operator control with this feature. Operation
A traction equalizer occasionally tends to slip in a To lock the main differential and obtain maximum
jerking motion, producing irregular intervals of sharp traction under slippery conditions, move the control
noises. This generally occurs when the vehicle is op- switch to the lock position.
erating at low speeds on fairly sharp turns. This con-
dition is corrected by adding a friction modifier to the
axle lubricant. This additive tends to reduce the static WARNING
coefficient of friction to a value equal to, or lower
Lock the main differential only when the vehicle
than, the sliding coefficient.
is standing still or moving less than 25 mph (40
See Group 35 of the Columbia Maintenance km/h). Never lock the main differential when the
Manual for additional information on friction modifiers vehicle is traveling down steep grades or when
and when to add them to axle lubricants. the wheels are slipping. This could damage the
differential or lead to loss of vehicle control,
CAUTION causing personal injury and property damage.
NOTE: On some vehicles, the differential lock
Tire sizes on both rear wheels should be the system is connected through the low speed
same on axles equipped with a traction equalizer. range of the transmission. If this system is used,
If not, excessive wear may occur in the traction
equalizer.
the transmission must be in the low speed
range for the differential to fully lock.
Meritor Drive Axles with Main If the vehicle is moving, maintain a constant vehicle
speed while engaging the differential lock. Briefly let
Differential Lock up on the accelerator to relieve torque on the gear-
The Meritor main differential lock is a driver- ing, allowing the differential to fully lock. The indica-
controlled traction device operated from the vehicle tor light should come on and the buzzer should
cab. A switch allows the driver to lock or unlock the sound on vehicles so equipped. When the differential
differential. An indicator light comes on when the dif- is fully locked, the turning radius will increase be-
ferential lock is engaged. An optional buzzer can also cause the vehicle understeers. See Fig. 9.1. Drive
be used to indicate differential lock engagement. cautiously and do not exceed 25 mph (40 km/h).

The main differential lock provides maximum traction To unlock the main differential, move the control
under slippery conditions. When the differential lock switch to the unlock position. Briefly let up on the
is engaged, the clutch collar completely locks the accelerator to relieve torque on the gearing, allowing
differential case, gearing, and axle shafts together, the differential to fully unlock.
maximizing traction of both wheels and protecting NOTE: If the differential lock system is con-
against spinout. Under normal traction conditions, do nected through the low speed range of the
not engage the differential lock. Operate the axle transmission, shifting out of low speed range will
with differential action between both wheels. also unlock the differential.

9.1
Rear Axles

the rear axle, so both axles turn together at the same


A speed. The LOCK position should be used when the
vehicle encounters poor traction conditions; however,
it also increases drivetrain and tire wear and should
be used only when improved traction is required.
B
Meritor Interaxle Differential
Lockout Operation
To lock the interaxle differential and achieve maxi-
02/09/96 f350079a mum pulling power when approaching slippery or
poor road conditions, move the lockout control valve
A. Turning Radius When Differential is Locked
(engaged)Understeer Condition to LOCK while maintaining vehicle speed, before en-
B. Turning Radius When Differential is Unlocked countering the poor road conditions. Let up momen-
(disengaged) tarily on the accelerator to engage the differential
lock. Proceed over poor road conditions with caution.
Fig. 9.1, Turning Radius Do not wait until traction is lost and the tires are
spinning before locking the interaxle differential.
When the differential lock disengages, the indicator
light will go off and the buzzer will stop.
CAUTION
Meritor Tandem Drive Axles Do not actuate the interaxle differential control
with Interaxle Differential valve while the tires are slipping. Do not operate
the vehicle continuously with the interaxle differ-
Meritor tandem drive axles with an interaxle differen- ential locked during extended good road condi-
tial have a lockout feature. Differential lockout is con- tions. To do so could result in damage to the axle
trolled by a switch (Fig. 9.2) on the control panel. gearing and excessive tire wear.
To unlock the interaxle differential, move the lockout
control valve to UNLOCK while maintaining vehicle
speed, after leaving the poor road conditions. Let up
momentarily on the accelerator to allow the shift,
then resume driving at normal speed.

Dana Spicer Axles with


Controlled Traction Differential
The controlled traction differential system is a differ-
09/26/95 f350141
ential assembly designed to transfer torque from the
slipping wheel to the one with traction.
Fig. 9.2, Interaxle Differential Control A control valve (Fig. 9.3) in the cab is actuated by
In the UNLOCK position, there is differential action the driver to engage and disengage the controlled
between the two axles. The differential compensates traction feature.
for different wheel speeds and variations in tire size. Disengaged, the axle has differential action all the
Keep the interaxle differential unlocked for normal time. One wheel will spin independently of the other,
driving on roads where traction is good. if slippery conditions are encountered.
In the LOCK position, the interaxle differential is Engaged, wheel slippage and spinout are minimized.
locked out and the driveshaft becomes a solid con-
nection between the two axles. Power entering the
forward axle is also transmitted straight through to

9.2
Rear Axles

out in the UNLOCK position for normal driving on


roads where traction is good.

09/26/95 f350142

Fig. 9.3, Traction Control Differential Control

NOTE: The controlled traction differential can be


engaged at any speed, except when one wheel
is spinning.

Dana Spicer Interaxle


Differential Lockout Operation
Interaxle differential lockout systems include a lock-
out control valve (Fig. 9.2) located in the cab, and an
air-operated shift unit mounted on the forward rear
axle.
When the interaxle differential lockout control valve is
in the LOCK position, the interaxle differential is
locked out and the driveshaft becomes a solid con-
nection between the two axles. Power entering the
forward axle is also transmitted straight through to
the rear axle, so both axles turn together at the same
speed. The LOCK position should be used only when
additional traction is needed.

CAUTION
Engage the lockout only when stopped or at slow
speeds and never when the wheels are spinning.
Do not operate the axles on dry pavement with
the lockout engaged for prolonged periods. Use
only when additional traction is needed under
adverse road conditions. Disengage the interaxle
differential lockout before shifting the axle to a
higher range.
When the interaxle differential lockout control valve is
in the UNLOCK position, the interaxle differential al-
lows differential action between the axles thereby
compensating for different wheel speeds and varia-
tions in tire size. Keep the interaxle differential lock-

9.3
10
Fifth Wheels and Trailer
Couplings
Holland Fifth Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.1
ASF Simplex Series Fifth Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.6
Fontaine Fifth Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.11
Premier Trailer Couplings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.16
Holland Trailer Coupling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.18
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

Holland Fifth Wheels


General Information
The 2535 sliding fifth wheel models incorporate a
Model 3500 fifth wheel (Fig. 10.1), equipped with
either an air-operated release slide, or a manual re- 1
lease slide. Sliding fifth wheel assemblies are
mounted on a baseplate that permits forward and
rear movement along notched rails. Plungers are
meshed into teeth on the baseplate to lock the slid-
ing mechanism. Disengagement of the sliding mem-
ber is accomplished when the plungers are with-
drawn (manually or air-operated), releasing the fifth 3
wheel assembly so that it can be positioned for opti- 2
mum weight distribution over the tractor axles. 05/19/93 f310369
NOTE: Baseplate rails not shown.
1. Kingpin Lock Control Handle
2. Double-Ended Air Cylinder
3. Slide Plunger Release

Fig. 10.2, Air-Operated Release Slide Assembly


1
2

1
3

01/19/95 f310046a 2
1. Kingpin Lock Mechanism
2. Kingpin Control Handle
3. Mounting Bracket
Fig. 10.1, Holland Fifth Wheel 3

4
The air-operated release slide assembly (Fig. 10.2)
contains a double-ended air cylinder which locks and 02/01/96 f310438
unlocks both sides of the sliding member at the
NOTE: Baseplate rails not shown.
same time. The air cylinder is activated by a two-
position air-control valve in the tractor cab. 1. Kingpin Lock Control Handle
2. Plunger Release Handle
The manual release slide assembly (Fig. 10.3) is 3. Plunger Release Spring
equipped with a single release lever. Pulling on the 4. Plunger
release lever unlocks both plungers.
Fig. 10.3, Manual Release Slide
Type "B" Kingpin Lock Mechanism the shoulder and neck of the kingpin, positioning slid-
The Type "B" kingpin lock mechanism (Fig. 10.4) ing yokes between the lock halves and tapered rib
utilizes two spring-loaded lock halves. The final for- members of the fifth wheel understructure. The king-
ward motion of the kingpin into the open lock halves pin can be released only by manually operating the
forces the locks to close in a 360-degree grip around

10.1
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

2 2
A B
1
1

3
3
5
4
07/11/2000 f310841

A. Closed Position, Locked B. Open Position, Unlocked


1. Release Handle and Spring 3. Lock Halves 5. Sliding Yoke
2. Adjustment Nut 4. Lock Pivot
Fig. 10.4, Type "B" Kingpin Lock Mechanism (bottom view)

kingpin lock control handle. The adjustment nut will


compensate for wear on the lock or kingpin. WARNING
Lockguard Keep the fifth wheel plate lubricated to prevent
binding between the tractor and trailer. A binding
The Holland lockguard (Fig. 10.5) is a device that fifth wheel could cause erratic steering and loss
prevents a false lockup, and is used on all models. of vehicle control, possibly resulting in personal
The Lockguard is a spring-tensioned, smooth- injury or death.
surfaced tongue that the kingpin passes over and
depresses when entering the lock mechanism. The 2. The kingpin lock mechanism must be fully open,
Lockguard will prevent the locks from engaging be- and the fifth wheel plate must be completely lu-
fore the kingpin fully enters the locks. If the kingpin bricated with chassis grease. For lubrication in-
enters the fifth wheel incorrectly and does not de- structions, see Group 31 of the Columbia Main-
press the tongue, the locks are unable to close. tenance Manual.
3. Position the tractor so that the fifth wheel lock
Fifth Wheel Locking Operation opening is in line (both vertically and horizontally)
Locking the Fifth Wheel Mechanism with the trailer kingpin. The kingpin should be in
a position to enter the throat of the locking
mechanism, to prevent a false lockup. See
CAUTION Fig. 10.5. Adjust the trailer landing gear to give
enough alignment height so that the fifth wheel
Before attempting to lock or unlock the fifth picks up the trailer on the fifth wheel ramps.
wheel lock mechanism of a sliding type fifth
wheel, the slide release plungers must be in the 4. With the fifth wheel lock opening aligned with the
locked position. This prevents the sliding mem- trailer kingpin, back the tractor slowly toward the
ber from moving rapidly to the far forward or trailer, making sure that the kingpin correctly en-
rearward position, which could damage the fifth ters the throat of the locking mechanism. When
wheel or kingpin. the trailer is picked up by the fifth wheel, stop the
tractor, then continue slow backward motion until
1. Chock the front and rear of the trailer tires to positive lockup occurs.
prevent the trailer from moving.
5. Apply the tractor parking brakes.

10.2
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

3
2
2

3
1 B

4
4
A

11/07/94 D C f310106a

A. Locks open.
B. Locks closed.
C. Kingpin correctly entering the lock. Note how the depressed tongue allows lock halves to close completely around the
neck and shoulder of the kingpin.
D. Kingpin incorrectly entering the lock. Note how the steel tongue prevents lock halves from closing, preventing false
lockup.
1. Fifth Wheel Plate 3. Kingpin
2. Trailer 4. Lockguard
Fig. 10.5, Lockguard Mechanism (rear view)

sulting in air leaks, or exposed or broken wires,


WARNING potentially affecting trailer brake or electrical sys-
tems.
Adjust the locks correctly to a maximum clear-
ance of 1/8 inch (3 mm). Incorrect adjustment of 7. After lockup is completed, connect the tractor-to-
the lock could cause the trailer to disconnect, trailer air system lines and electrical cable to the
possibly resulting in serious personal injury or trailer. Take care to prevent dirt or foreign mate-
death. rial from entering the air lines.
6. Make a visual check for proper kingpin lockup. 8. Charge the air brake system with air. Make sure
Release the tractor parking brakes. Test for king- that the air connections do not leak.
pin lockup by pulling on the trailer against the 9. Retract the trailer landing gear and secure the
chocks. Check for correct maximum clearance ratchet handle.
between the lock halves. If more than 1/8-inch
(3.2-mm) clearance exists between the lock 10. Remove the chocks from the trailer tires.
halves, the lock must be adjusted. See Group 11. The load distribution on the front steering axle
31 of the Columbia Workshop Manual for ad- and rear drive axle(s) will have a direct effect on
justment procedures. the steering control of the vehicle.
Determine the front and rear axle weights by
NOTICE weighing the vehicle on scales designed for this
Always make sure the connect-hanger/support purpose.
keeps the trailer air hoses and electrical cables The maximum axle weight ratings are shown on
positioned so that they do not rub on anything. the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard
Rubbing may wear through hoses or cables, re- (FMVSS) label or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety

10.3
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

Standard (CMVSS) label attached to the left rear 6. Release the kingpin locking mechanism by pull-
door post of the tractor. The desired load on the ing the kingpin lock control handle (Fig. 10.1) to
axle is no less than 80 percent of the maximum the outward position.
axle weight rating, but in no instances should the
7. Slowly drive the tractor away from the trailer.
axle load exceed the maximum axle weight rat-
ing given on the FMVSS or CMVSS label.
Fifth Wheel Slide Operation
WARNING 1. Connect the trailer kingpin to the tractor fifth
wheel. For instructions, refer to Holland "Fifth
Do not overload any tractor axle by improperly Wheel Locking Operation" in this chapter.
loading the trailer. This could cause erratic steer-
2. After positive lockup of the fifth wheel lock
ing and loss of vehicle control, possibly resulting
mechanism has been accomplished, release the
in serious personal injury or death.
sliding member using one of the following meth-
Unlocking the Fifth Wheel Lock ods:
Mechanism 2.1 For air-operated models, set the cab-
operated control switch (Fig. 10.6) to
1. Apply the tractor parking brakes. UNLOCK.
2. Pull the trailer air supply valve to cut off the air
supply to the trailer.
3. Chock the front and rear of the trailer tires to
prevent the trailer from moving.

WARNING
Do not use the trailer air supply for parking trail-
ers not equipped with spring parking brakes.
This applies the trailer service brakes only. As air
bleeds from the trailer brake system, brake appli-
9/07/95 f310489
cation is lost. This could allow the unattended
vehicle to roll away, possibly resulting in serious Fig. 10.6, Cab Control, Fifth Wheel Slide
personal injury or death.
2.2 For manual release models, pull the re-
4. Lower the trailer landing gear until the weight is
removed from the fifth wheel. lease lever (Fig. 10.3) using a release
hook, or other suitable tool. Make sure
5. Disconnect the tractor-to-trailer air system lines both slide plungers have released. See
and electrical cable. Plug the air lines to prevent Fig. 10.7. If the plungers havent released
dirt or foreign material from entering the lines. (havent come out), lower the trailer land-
ing gear to relieve pressure on the
CAUTION plungers.
3. Lower the trailer landing gear just enough to re-
Before attempting to lock or unlock the fifth move the weight from the tractor.
wheel lock mechanism of a sliding type fifth
wheel, the slide release plungers must be in the 4. Pull the trailer air supply valve to cut off the air
locked position. This prevents the sliding mem- supply to the trailer.
ber from moving rapidly to the far forward or 5. Chock the front and rear of the trailer tires to
rearward position, which could damage the fifth prevent the trailer from moving.
wheel or kingpin.

10.4
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

7. Apply the tractor parking brakes.


NOTE: The fifth wheel may have to be moved
slightly to enable the locking plungers to enter
the fully locked position.
8. Lock the sliding member into position using one
of the following methods:
A
1
WARNING
Check to be sure that the slide plungers are in
the locked position. Failure to achieve complete
lockup may allow disengagement of the tractor
from the trailer, possibly resulting in serious per-
sonal injury or death.
8.1 For air-operated models, set the cab-
operated control switch to LOCK. Visually
check the slide plungers to make sure
they are engaged in the fully locked posi-
B tion. See Fig. 10.7.
1
8.2 For manual release models, trip the re-
01/24/96 f310439 lease lever (Fig. 10.3) using a release
hook or other suitable tool. Make sure that
A. Locked (engaged) B. Unlocked (released)
both plungers have locked (retracted into
1. Plunger their pockets), and are fully engaged in
Fig. 10.7, Plunger Positions the rack teeth. See Fig. 10.7. It may be
necessary to move the tractor slightly
while keeping the trailer brakes locked.
WARNING 9. The amount of load distribution on the front
Do not use the trailer air supply for parking trail- steering axle and rear drive axle(s) will have a
ers not equipped with spring parking brakes. direct effect on the steering control of the vehicle.
This applies the trailer service brakes only. As air Determine the front and rear axle weights by
bleeds from the trailer brake system, brake appli- weighing the vehicle on scales designed for this
cation is lost. This could allow the unattended purpose.
vehicle to roll away, possibly resulting in serious
personal injury or death. The maximum axle weight ratings are shown on
the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard
(FMVSS) label or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety
CAUTION Standard (CMVSS) label attached to the left rear
door post of the tractor. The desired load on the
After moving the fifth wheel to the desired posi- axle is no less than 80 percent of the maximum
tion, be sure the trailer landing gear will not, at axle weight rating, but in no instances should the
any time, come in contact with the tractor frame axle load exceed the maximum axle weight rat-
or other components. Make sure that the front of ing given on the FMVSS or CMVSS label.
the trailer will not come in contact with the rear
of the cab or with other components if they ex-
tend beyond the rear of the cab.
6. Slowly move the tractor forward or backward
until the fifth wheel is in the desired location.

10.5
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

WARNING
1
2
Do not overload any tractor axle by improperly
loading the trailer. This could cause erratic steer-
ing and loss of vehicle control, possibly resulting 3
in serious personal injury or death.

Fifth Wheel Lubrication


4
WARNING
Keep the fifth wheel plate lubricated to prevent
binding between the tractor and trailer. A binding 10/26/2010 f310353b
fifth wheel could cause erratic steering and loss 1. Lubricant Grooves 3. Operating Rod
of vehicle control, possibly resulting in personal 2. Safety Latch 4. Mounting Bracket
injury or death.
Fig. 10.8, Simplex Stationary Fifth Wheel
For lubrication instructions, see Group 31 of the
Columbia Maintenance Manual.
5
4
ASF Simplex Series Fifth
Wheels 3
6

General Information 8
The ASF Simplex series fifth wheels are used for 3
pulling trailers having the standard 2-inch (51-mm) 2
diameter kingpin. When installed as a stationary fifth
wheel (Fig. 10.8), they are bracket-mounted to the 1 7
tractor frame in a position that best distributes the
trailer load over the tractor axles. When used as a
sliding fifth wheel (Fig. 10.9), they are mounted on 10/26/2010 f310445
the Taperloc sliding mount (air-operated or manual 1. Baseplate 5. Slider Saddle Plate
release). 2. Bolted Stop 6. Safety Latch
3. Baseplate Rail 7. Operating Rod
The fifth wheel lock mechanism for the trailer kingpin 4. Fifth Wheel Mount 8. Operating Lever
consists of a rotating jaw that grips the trailer kingpin
and a spring-actuated lock. The jaw rotates on a jaw Fig. 10.9, Taperloc Slide, Manually Operated Release
pin during coupling and uncoupling operations. King-
pin lockup occurs when the kingpin is forced into the attached to the tractor frame. The baseplate rails
jaw and the operating rod handle moves to the allow forward and rear movement of the slide assem-
locked position. The kingpin is released either by ac- bly, for optimum weight distribution over the tractor
tivating a manual operating rod, or if equipped with axles.
Touchloc, by a dash-mounted release knob that ac- Tapered slots in the baseplate rails, aligned in 4-inch
tivates an air cylinder underneath the top plate. The (102-mm) increments, provide for location of the fifth
air cylinder activates the operating rod. The operating wheel along the baseplate. Retractable, spring-
rod is located on the left side of the fifth wheel for actuated lockpins are positioned through the slots to
Simplex II fifth wheels, and on the right side for the hold the fifth wheel in the desired position. The lock-
Simplex fifth wheel assembly. pins are retracted either manually or by an air-
On sliding fifth wheels, the top plate is mounted on a operated cylinder controlled from the cab.
sliding saddle plate that slides along the baseplate

10.6
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

The manually operated slide contains an operating tated to compensate for wear and maintain an
rod (Fig. 10.9) that unlocks both sides of the plate at approximate 1/16-inch (1.6-mm) clearance during
the same time. service.
The air-operated sliding saddle plate contains an air Placing the operating rod in the lockset position
cylinder that moves the operating lever to unlock moves the lock away from the jaw. This action un-
both sides of the plate at the same time. The air cyl- locks the jaw so that it can be rotated by movement
inder is activated by a two-position air-control valve of the kingpin. When the tractor is moved out from
in the tractor cab. under the trailer, the kingpin will rotate the jaw until
the jaw is in the unlocked position, allowing the king-
Fifth Wheel Lock Mechanism for Trailer pin to move out of the mechanism. With the jaw in
Kingpin the fully open position, the operating rod drops out of
the lockset position, and the fifth wheel is ready for
The Simplex Series fifth wheel lock mechanism coupling. See Fig. 10.11.
(Fig. 10.10) consists of a rotating jaw and a spring-
actuated lock that grips the trailer kingpin. The jaw
rotates on an eccentric pin during coupling and un-
coupling operations. The spring-actuated lock holds 1
the jaw in the locked position once kingpin lockup
has occurred. 2

2 4
3

1
6
5
1
3
A

11/02/2010 f310447
1. Safety Latch
B C 2. Operating Rod (locked)
3. Operating Rod (unlocked)
10/26/2010 f310446

A. Locked Position Fig. 10.11, Simplex Kingpin Locking Mechanism,


B. Jaw movement compresses spring Locking and Unlocking
C. Fully open
1. Operating Lever 4. Jaw Eccentric Pin During coupling, the kingpin contacts and rotates the
2. Safety Latch 5. Lock jaw into the locked position. This action automatically
3. Jaw 6. Spring moves the operating rod into the locked position.
This securely locks the jaw around the kingpin. In the
Fig. 10.10, ASF Simplex Series Kingpin Locking locked position the safety latch swings freely over the
Mechanism Operation operating rod. See Fig. 10.12.
In the locked position, there is approximately 1/16-
inch (1.6-mm) clearance between the jaw and king-
pin. The jaw eccentric pin can be removed and ro-

10.7
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

4. Position the tractor so that the center of the fifth


wheel is in line with the trailer kingpin. The king-
pin should be in a position to enter the throat of
the locking mechanism. See Fig. 10.10. Adjust
the trailer landing gear so that the lower front
1 trailer edge contacts the top surface of the tilted
fifth wheel plate, approximately 8 inches (20 cm)
before the fifth wheel center.
2
5. With the fifth wheel lock opening aligned with the
trailer kingpin, back the tractor slowly toward the
10/26/2010 f310448
trailer, making sure that the kingpin enters the
throat of the locking mechanism. Continue back-
1. Safety Latch 2. Operating Rod
ward motion until positive lockup occurs.
Fig. 10.12, Simplex Kingpin Locking Mechanism, Safety 6. Apply the tractor parking brakes.
Latch (locked position)
7. Make a visual check (even if equipped with the
Fifth Wheel Locking and Unlocking Touchloc air-operated system) for positive king-
pin lockup. The trailer bed plate must be flush on
Locking the Fifth Wheel Lock Mechanism the fifth wheel plate surface. When positive
1. Chock the front and rear of the trailer tires to lockup has occurred, the fifth wheel operating
prevent the trailer from moving. rod will have moved inward to the locked posi-
tion, and the safety latch will swing freely over
the operating rod. See Fig. 10.12.
CAUTION
NOTE: Only when the operating rod is fully re-
Before attempting to lock the fifth wheel lock tracted in the locked position will the safety latch
mechanism of a sliding type fifth wheel, the slide be freely rotated down.
locking handle must be in the locked position.
This prevents the sliding member from moving 8. Release the tractor parking brakes. Test for king-
rapidly to the far forward or rearward position, pin lockup by pulling on the trailer against the
which could damage the fifth wheel member or chocks.
kingpin.
2. The fifth wheel jaw must be fully open. Make NOTICE
sure that the operating rod is in the unlocked po-
Always make sure the connect-hanger/support
sition. The fifth wheel must be completely lubri-
keeps the trailer air hoses and electrical cables
cated with chassis or multi-purpose grease. For
positioned so that they do not rub on anything.
lubrication instructions, see Group 31 of the
Rubbing may wear through hoses or cables, re-
Columbia Maintenance Manual.
sulting in air leaks, or exposed or broken wires,
potentially affecting trailer brake or electrical sys-
WARNING tems.
Keep the fifth wheel plate lubricated to prevent 9. After lockup is completed, connect the tractor-to-
binding between the tractor and trailer. A binding trailer air system lines and electrical cable to the
fifth wheel could cause erratic steering and loss trailer. Take care to prevent dirt or foreign mate-
of vehicle control, possibly resulting in personal rial from entering the air system lines.
injury or death. 10. Charge the air brake system with air. Make sure
3. Make sure the fifth wheel top plate is tilted so the that the air connections do not leak.
ramps are as low as possible. If equipped with
an air suspension, make sure the air bags are
completely inflated.

10.8
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

2. Pull the trailer air supply valve to cut off the air
WARNING supply to the trailer.
Adjust the jaw pin if there is more than 1/8-inch
(3-mm) clearance between the kingpin and the WARNING
lock. Incorrect adjustment could cause the trailer
to disconnect, possibly resulting in serious per- Do not use the trailer air supply for parking trail-
sonal injury or death. ers not equipped with spring parking brakes.
This applies the trailer service brakes only. As air
11. With the trailer wheels chocked and the brakes bleeds from the trailer brake system, brake appli-
set, check for clearance between the kingpin and cation is lost. This could allow the unattended
the fifth wheel jaws by moving the tractor forward vehicle to roll away, possibly resulting in serious
and backward against the locked kingpin. A personal injury or death.
clearance of approximately 1/16 inch (1.6 mm)
3. Chock the front and rear of the trailer tires to
between the jaw and kingpin is allowable. When
prevent the trailer from moving.
clearance between the jaw and kingpin exceeds
1/8 inch (3 mm), adjust the jaw to restore the 4. Lower the trailer landing gear until the trailer
1/16-inch (1.6-mm) clearance between the jaw rises about 1/2 inch (13 mm).
and kingpin. For instructions, see Group 31 of
the Columbia Workshop Manual. 5. Disconnect the tractor-to-trailer air system lines
and electrical cable. Plug the air lines to prevent
12. Retract the trailer landing gear, and secure the dirt or foreign material from entering the lines.
ratchet handle.
13. Remove the chocks from the trailer tires. CAUTION
14. The load distribution on the front steering axle Before attempting to unlock the fifth wheel lock
and rear drive axle(s) will have a direct effect on mechanism of a sliding type fifth wheel, the slide
the steering control of the vehicle. operating rod must be in the locked position, and
Determine the front and rear axle weights by the slide lockpins must be in the locked position
weighing the vehicle on scales designed for this (fully inserted in baseplate rail slots). This pre-
purpose. vents the sliding member from moving rapidly to
the far forward or rearward position, which could
The maximum axle weight ratings are shown on damage the fifth wheel member or kingpin.
the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard
(FMVSS) label or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety 6. If equipped with a manual kingpin lock release:
Standard (CMVSS) label attached to the left rear Release the kingpin lock mechanism by raising
door post of the tractor. The desired load on the the safety latch to the rear and pulling the lock
axle is no less than 80 percent of the maximum operating rod out and up into the lockset posi-
axle weight rating, but in no instances should the tion. See Fig. 10.11. The offset of the lock con-
axle load exceed the maximum axle weight rat- trol upper rod should bottom against the plate
ings given on the FMVSS or CMVSS label. casting above the hole. If the operating rod can-
not be pulled to the lockset position, back the
WARNING tractor slightly to release the kingpin force
against the jaw.
Do not overload any tractor axle by improperly If equipped with an air-operated kingpin lock re-
loading the trailer. This could cause erratic steer- lease: Pull the air-release knob on the dash.
ing and loss of vehicle control, possibly resulting From outside the cab, visually check that the op-
in serious personal injury or death. erating rod has bottomed out against the plate
casting above the hole. See Fig. 10.11. If the
Unlocking the Fifth Wheel Lock operating rod isnt in the unlocked position, back
Mechanism the tractor slightly to release the kingpin force
against the jaw.
1. Apply the tractor parking brakes.

10.9
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

IMPORTANT: If equipped with an air-operated


lock release, you still must make a visual check CAUTION
of the operating rod to make sure it is in the un-
After moving the fifth wheel to the desired posi-
locked position tion, be sure the trailer landing gear will not, at
7. Slowly drive the tractor away from the trailer. any time, come in contact with the tractor frame
or other components. Make sure that the front of
Fifth Wheel Slide Operation the trailer will not come in contact with the rear
of the cab or with other components if they ex-
1. Chock the front and rear of the trailer tires to tend beyond the rear of the cab.
prevent the trailer from moving.
6. Slowly move the tractor forward or backward
2. Connect the trailer kingpin to the tractor fifth until the fifth wheel is in the desired location.
wheel. For instructions, refer to "Fifth Wheel
Locking Operation," in this chapter. 7. Apply the tractor parking brakes.

3. After positive lockup of the fifth wheel lock


mechanism has been accomplished, release the
WARNING
slide using one of the following methods: Check to be sure that the lockpins are seated in
3.1 For air-operated models, set the cab- the holes and that the operating rod is in the
operated control switch (Fig. 10.13) to locked position with the safety latch securing the
UNLOCK. operating rod. Failure to achieve complete lockup
may cause the trailer to detach from the tractor,
possibly resulting in serious personal injury or
death.
NOTE: The fifth wheel may have to be moved
slightly to enable the locking pins to enter the
fully locked position.
8. Lock the sliding member into position using one
of the following methods:
For air-operated models: Set the cab-operated
control switch to LOCK. Visually inspect the lock-
9/07/95 f310489 pins to make sure they have seated in the base-
plate rail holes.
Fig. 10.13, Cab Control, Fifth Wheel Slide
For manually operated models: Raise the operat-
3.2 For manually operated models, raise the ing rod so that it is free to move inward. Make
safety latch and pull the slide operating sure that the lockpins have seated in the base-
rod (Fig. 10.9) outward until the shoulder plate rail holes and the operating rod moves into
is outside of the operating rod support, the locked position. Also, the safety latch must
then lower the operating rod as far as it drop downward so that it holds the operating rod
will go. in the locked position.
4. Lower the trailer landing gear just enough to re- 9. The amount of load distribution on the front
move the weight from the tractor. steering axle and rear drive axle(s) will have a
direct effect on the steering control of the vehicle.
5. Pull the trailer air supply valve to cut off the air
supply to the trailer. Determine the front and rear axle weights by
weighing the vehicle on scales designed for this
purpose.
The maximum axle weight ratings are shown on
the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard

10.10
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

(FMVSS) label or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety The fifth wheel top plate is mounted on a slide as-
Standard (CMVSS) label attached to the left rear sembly, which is attached to slide rails that are
door post of the tractor. The desired load on the mounted on the vehicle frame. The slide rails permit
axle is no less than 80 percent of the maximum forward and rearward movement of the slide assem-
axle weight rating, but in no instances should the bly, allowing for optimum weight distribution over the
axle load exceed the maximum axle weight rat- tractor axles.
ing given on the FMVSS or CMVSS label. Slots are evenly spaced along the slide rails, and
retractable tapered wedges are positioned through
WARNING the slots to hold the fifth wheel in the desired posi-
tion. See Fig. 10.14 or Fig. 10.15.
Adjust the fifth wheel slide correctly, and do not
overload any tractor axle by incorrectly loading 1
the trailer. Incorrect slide adjustment or improper
axle loading could cause erratic steering and
loss of vehicle control, possibly resulting in seri-
ous personal injury or death.

Fifth Wheel Lubrication


WARNING
Keep the fifth wheel plate lubricated to prevent
binding between the tractor and trailer. A binding
fifth wheel could cause erratic steering and loss
of vehicle control, possibly resulting in personal
injury or death.
The fifth wheel plate must be kept well lubricated
with chassis grease to prevent friction and binding 2
07/25/95 f310189
between the tractor fifth wheel plate and the trailer.
1. Locking Wedge 2. Air Cylinder
For lubrication instructions, see Group 31 of the
Columbia Maintenance Manual. Fig. 10.14, Air-Operated Sliding Fifth Wheel Mount,
AWB Model
Fontaine Fifth Wheels The slide portion of the sliding model may be at-
General Information tached to either an air-operated release slide, or a
manual release slide.
The Fontaine sliding fifth wheel mount is designed to
provide optimum axle loading for maximum tractor The air-operated release slide contains an air cylin-
use with different lengths and types of trailers. The der that locks and unlocks the fifth wheel slide. See
sliding fifth wheel mount is used with the Fontaine Fig. 10.14. The air cylinder is activated by a two-
H5092 series fifth wheel and the Fontaine 6000/7000 position air-control valve in the tractor cab.
No-Slack II series, and is equipped with either an The manual release slide contains a slide release
air-operated release slide (HAWB or AWB model), or pull handle, located on the left side of the fifth wheel,
a manual release slide (HMWS or MWS model). which locks or unlocks the fifth wheel slide. See
On Fontaine fifth wheels, kingpin release is accom- Fig. 10.15.
plished by activating a manual lock control handle
located on either the right side or left side of the fifth
wheel. Kingpin lockup occurs when the kingpin is
forced into the jaws and the lock control handle
moves to the locked position.

10.11
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

1 2 A

3
B C

2
07/25/95 f310190 10/26/2010 f310184c
1. Locking Wedge A. Unlocked Position C. Locked
2. Slide Release Pull Handle B. Locking
1. Wedge 3. Trailer Kingpin
Fig. 10.15, Manual Release Sliding Fifth Wheel Mount, 2. Jaw
MWS Model
Fig. 10.16, Fontaine Kingpin Lock Mechanism
Fifth Wheel Lock Mechanism for Trailer
Kingpin During coupling (Fig. 10.16), the motion of the king-
pin entering the jaw will actuate the jaw and wedge.
The Fontaine fifth wheel lock mechanism for the The jaw will move behind the kingpin, followed by the
trailer kingpin (Fig. 10.16) consists of a spring-loaded wedge. The purpose of the wedge is to reinforce the
jaw and a sliding wedge. jaw and take up slack around the pin. Any wear on
The jaw and wedge each have a pin permanently the jaw is immediately taken up by the wedge so
attached. The pin on the jaw and the pin on the there is no slack in the connection.
wedge fit into elongated notches in the lock control
handle. The notches in the handle control the limit of Fifth Wheel Locking Operation
movement for both the jaw and wedge. The notches Locking the Fifth Wheel Lock Mechanism
are arranged so that the wedge is actuated first dur-
ing release of the kingpin.
CAUTION
During lockup, the jaw is moved first with the spring-
loaded wedge being allowed to slip in place against Before attempting to lock or unlock the fifth
the jaw. A timing bracket ensures that the wedge and wheel lock mechanism of a sliding type fifth
jaw are moved at the proper time. wheel, the slide release pull handle, if so
Placing the lock control handle in the unlocked posi- equipped, and the slide locking wedges must be
tion moves the wedge away from the jaw. This action in the locked position. This prevents the sliding
unlocks the jaw so that it can be moved by the trailer member from moving rapidly to the far forward or
kingpin. When the tractor is moved out from under rearward position, which could damage the fifth
the trailer, the kingpin moves the jaw until the kingpin wheel member or kingpin.
is out of the mechanism. With the jaw in the un- 1. Chock the front and rear of the trailer tires to
locked position, the lock control handle will remain in prevent the trailer from moving.
the unlocked position until manually moved by the
operator.

10.12
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

WARNING
Keep the fifth wheel plate lubricated to prevent 1
binding between the tractor and trailer. A binding
fifth wheel could cause erratic steering and loss
of vehicle control, possibly resulting in personal
injury or death. A
2. The kingpin lock mechanism must be fully open,
the fifth wheel plate must be completely lubri- 2
cated with chassis grease. For lubrication in-
structions, see Group 31 of the Columbia Main-
tenance Manual.
1
3. Position the tractor so that the fifth wheel lock
opening is in line (both vertically and horizontally)
with the trailer kingpin. The kingpin should be in
a position to enter the throat of the locking
mechanism (Fig. 10.16). Adjust the trailer landing B
gear to give enough alignment height for positive 2
kingpin lockup. 10/26/2010 f310110a

4. With the fifth wheel lock opening aligned with the NOTE: Make sure the safety latch is down when the
control handle is locked.
trailer kingpin, back the tractor slowly toward the
trailer, making sure that the kingpin enters the A. Unlocked B. Locked
throat of the locking mechanism. Continue back- 1. Safety Latch 2. Lock Control Handle
ward motion until positive lockup occurs.
Fig. 10.17, Fontaine Fifth Wheel, Locking and
5. Apply the tractor parking brakes. Unlocking
6. Make a visual and physical check for positive the trailer. Take care to prevent dirt or foreign
kingpin lockup. When lockup has occurred, the material from entering the air system lines.
fifth wheel control handle will have moved to the
locked position. Make sure that the safety latch 9. Charge the air brake system with air. Make sure
is down over the lock control handle. See that the air connections do not leak.
Fig. 10.17. This will hold the control handle in
the locked position. WARNING
7. Release the tractor parking brakes. Test for king-
Incorrect fifth wheel lock adjustment could cause
pin lockup by pulling on the trailer against the the trailer to disconnect, possibly resulting in se-
chocks. rious personal injury or death.

NOTICE 10. With the trailer wheels chocked and the brakes
set, check for clearance between the kingpin and
Always make sure the connect-hanger/support the fifth wheel jaws by moving the tractor forward
keeps the trailer air hoses and electrical cables and backward against the locked kingpin. There
positioned so that they do not rub on anything. should be no slack between the tractor and the
Rubbing may wear through hoses or cables, re- trailer. If slack is present, uncouple the trailer.
sulting in air leaks, or exposed or broken wires, For adjustment instructions, refer to the appli-
potentially affecting trailer brake or electrical sys- cable manufacturers service information.
tems.
11. Retract the trailer landing gear, and secure the
8. After lockup is completed, connect the tractor-to- ratchet handle. Remove the chocks from the
trailer air system lines and the electrical cable to trailer tires.

10.13
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

12. The load distribution on the front steering axle


and rear drive axle(s) will have a direct effect on CAUTION
the steering control of the vehicle.
Before attempting to lock or unlock the fifth
Determine the front and rear axle weights by wheel lock mechanism of a sliding type fifth
weighing the vehicle on scales designed for this wheel, the slide release pull handle, if so
purpose. equipped, and the slide locking wedges must be
The maximum axle weight ratings are given on in the locked position. This prevents the sliding
the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard member from moving rapidly to the far forward or
(FMVSS) label or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety rearward position, which could damage the fifth
Standard (CMVSS) label attached to the left rear wheel member or kingpin.
door post of the tractor. The desired load on the 6. Release the kingpin locking mechanism by lifting
axle is no less than 80 percent of the maximum the safety latch and pulling the lock control
axle weight rating, but in no instances should the handle to the unlocked position. See Fig. 10.17.
axle load exceed the maximum axle weight rat-
ing given on the FMVSS or CMVSS label. 7. Slowly drive the tractor away from the trailer.

WARNING Fifth Wheel Slide Operation


1. Connect the trailer kingpin to the tractor fifth
Do not overload any tractor axle by improperly wheel. For instructions, refer to Fontaine "Fifth
loading the trailer. This could cause erratic steer- Wheel Locking Operation," in this chapter.
ing and loss of vehicle control, possibly resulting
in serious personal injury or death. 2. After positive lockup of the fifth wheel lock
mechanism has been accomplished, release the
Unlocking the Fifth Wheel Lock slide using one of the following methods:
Mechanism 2.1 For air-operated release models, set the
1. Apply the tractor parking brakes. cab-operated control switch (Fig. 10.18) to
UNLOCK.
2. Pull the trailer air supply valve to cut off the air
supply to the trailer.

WARNING
Do not use the trailer air supply for parking trail-
ers not equipped with spring parking brakes.
This applies the trailer service brakes only. As air
bleeds from the trailer brake system, brake appli-
cation is lost. This could allow the unattended
vehicle to roll away, possibly resulting in serious
personal injury or death.
9/07/95 f310489
3. Chock the front and rear of the trailer tires to
prevent the trailer from moving. Fig. 10.18, Cab Control, Fifth Wheel Slide

4. Lower the trailer landing gear until the weight is 2.2 For manual release models, lift the slide
removed from the fifth wheel. release pull handle to disengage it from
the guide plate. Then, pull out the handle
5. Disconnect the tractor-to-trailer air system lines (Fig. 10.19) until it is in the unlocked posi-
and electrical cable. Plug the air lines to prevent tion and can be positioned against the
dirt or foreign material from entering the lines.

10.14
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

6. Slowly move the tractor forward or backward


until the fifth wheel is in the desired location.
7. Apply the tractor parking brakes.
NOTE: The fifth wheel may have to be moved
slightly to enable the locking wedges to enter
the fully locked position.
8. Lock the sliding member in position using one of
the following methods:

WARNING
Check that the locking wedges have seated in the
slots. Failure to achieve complete lockup may
10/26/2010 f310050 allow disengagement of the tractor from the
trailer, possibly resulting in serious personal in-
Fig. 10.19, Fontaine Sliding Fifth Wheel Manual Release jury or death.
guide plate to hold it out. The slide re- 8.1 For air-operated release models, set the
lease pull handle will stay in the unlocked cab-operated slide control switch to
position until it is manually disengaged LOCK. Visually inspect the locking
from the guide plate. wedges to make sure that they are fully
inserted in the slide rail slots.
3. Lower the trailer landing gear just enough to re-
move the weight from the tractor. 8.2 For manual release models, disengage
the slide release pull handle from the
4. Pull the trailer air supply valve to cut off the air guide plate. The slide release pull handle
supply to the trailer. is spring-loaded in the locked position and
will seek the locked position when disen-
WARNING gaged from the guide plate. The fifth
wheel may have to be moved slightly to
Do not use the trailer air supply for parking trail- enable the locking wedges to fully enter
ers not equipped with spring parking brakes. the locked position. When the slide re-
This applies the trailer service brakes only. As air lease pull handle returns to the fully
bleeds from the trailer brake system, brake appli- locked position, visually and physically
cation is lost. This could allow the unattended check the locking wedges to make sure
vehicle to roll away, possibly resulting in serious they are fully inserted into the slots in the
personal injury or death. slide rails. Make sure the slide release pull
5. Chock the front and rear of the trailer tires to handle is locked in position against the
prevent the trailer from moving. guide plate.
9. The amount of load distribution on the front
CAUTION steering axle and rear drive axle(s) will have a
direct effect on the steering control of the vehicle.
After moving the fifth wheel to the desired posi- Determine the front and rear axle weights by
tion, be sure the trailer landing gear will not, at weighing the vehicle on scales designed for this
any time, come in contact with the tractor frame purpose.
or other components. Make sure that the front of
the trailer will not come in contact with the rear The maximum axle weight ratings are given on
of the cab or with other components if they ex- the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard
tend beyond the rear of the cab. (FMVSS) label or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety
Standard (CMVSS) label attached to the left rear
door post of the tractor. The desired load on the

10.15
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

axle is no less than 80 percent of the maximum Operation


axle weight rating, but in no instances should the
axle load exceed the maximum axle weight rat-
ing given on the FMVSS or CMVSS label. WARNING
If at any time the 690 coupling is bound up (jack-
WARNING knifed), the 294 bolt MUST be replaced immedi-
ately! Do not use the coupling until the bolt has
Adjust the fifth wheel slide correctly, and do not been replaced. In addition, carefully inspect the
overload any tractor axle by incorrectly loading 690 coupling, drawbar, drawbar eye, front end
the trailer. Incorrect slide adjustment or improper assembly, and tail board for damage. Failure to
axle loading could cause erratic steering and do so may result in trailer separation from the
loss of vehicle control, possibly resulting in seri- truck while in use, resulting in serious personal
ous personal injury or death. injury or property damage.
Fifth Wheel Lubrication Trailer Hookup
1. Chock the front and rear tires of the trailer.
WARNING
2. Open the coupling.
Keep the fifth wheel plate lubricated to prevent Models 260 and 460 (Fig. 10.20): Pull up on the
binding between the tractor and trailer. A binding pawl lock; then, while squeezing the pawl
fifth wheel could cause erratic steering and loss wedges together, lift up the pawl assembly. Lift
of vehicle control, possibly resulting in personal up the latch, and push it up against the pawl as-
injury or death. sembly, locking the latch in place.
For lubrication instructions, see Group 31 of the Model 690 (Fig. 10.21): Remove the linch pin
Columbia Maintenance Manual. from the handle, then push in on the handle and
turn it toward you. Open the pintle hook by pull-
Premier Trailer Couplings ing it down and toward you. Release the handle,
locking the pintle hook open.
General Information
3. Models 260 and 460: Back up the vehicle until
IMPORTANT: Before operating the Premier cou- the drawbar eye is over the pintle hook, then
pling, refer to the Premier web site at lower the trailer.
www.premier-mfg.com for complete safety,
Model 690: Back up the vehicle until the drawbar
operation, and maintenance instructions. eye enters the open jaw, contacts the back of the
Trailer couplings, used only on trucks, are attached pintle hook, and closes the coupling.
to the rear closing crossmember.
4. Close the coupling.
The Premier 260 and 460 trailer couplings
Models 260 and 460: Push in on the pawl
(Fig. 10.20) have a rigid pintle hook, and are air-
wedges and lift the pawl assembly. The latch will
adjusted. An air chamber, mounted forward of the
drop into the closed position. Lock the latch by
coupling, operates a pushrod, which pushes against
lowering the pawl assembly.
a shoe inside the coupling. The shoe maintains con-
stant pressure on the eye of the trailer drawbar when Model 690: The pintle hook will automatically
its over the pintle hook. This takes up any slack in close and lock from the pressure of the drawbar
the trailer connection, providing smoother towing and eye against it. Install the linch pin.
less wear on the pintle hook. The air pressure is acti-
vated when the trailer brakes are released. NOTICE
The Premier 690 trailer coupling (Fig. 10.21) has a
moveable pintle hook, and is non-air adjusted. It is Always make sure the connect-hanger/support
used for heavy-duty applications. keeps the trailer air hoses and electrical cables
positioned so that they do not rub on anything.

10.16
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

4
4 5
3 5
3
2

2
6 6
1
1

A
B
01/20/95 f310312a
A. Model 260 B. Model 460
1. Pintle Hook 3. Pawl Assembly 5. Pawl Wedge
2. Latch 4. Pawl Lock 6. Shoe
Fig. 10.20, Premier 260 and 460 Trailer Couplings

1 2
WARNING
Do not use the trailer air supply for parking trail-
ers not equipped with spring parking brakes.
This applies the trailer service brakes only. As air
bleeds from the trailer brake system, brake appli-
cation is lost. This could allow the unattended
3 vehicle to roll away, possibly resulting in serious
personal injury or death.
2. Chock the front and rear tires of the trailer.
4
07/13/2010 f310313a 3. Disconnect the trailer air and electrical lines.
1. Linch Pin 3. Pintle Hook Plug the air lines to keep out dirt.
2. Handle 4. 294 Bolt 4. Take the weight of the trailer drawbar eye off the
Fig. 10.21, Premier 690 Trailer Coupling pintle hook.
5. Open the coupling.
Rubbing may wear through hoses or cables, re-
sulting in air leaks, or exposed or broken wires, Models 260 and 460: Pull up on the pawl lock;
potentially affecting trailer brake or electrical sys- then, while squeezing the pawl wedges together,
tems. lift up the pawl assembly. Lift up the latch, and
push it up against the pawl, locking the latch in
5. Hook up the trailers electrical and air lines. place.
6. Remove the chocks from the trailers tires. Model 690: Remove the linch pin from the
handle, then push in on the handle and turn it
Trailer Release toward you. Open the pintle hook by pulling it
1. Apply the truck and trailer parking brakes. down and toward you. Release the handle, lock-
ing the pintle hook open.
6. Slowly drive the vehicle away from the trailer.

10.17
Fifth Wheels and Trailer Couplings

Holland Trailer Coupling 6. Hook up the trailers electrical and air lines.
7. Remove the chocks from the trailers tires.
General Information
The Holland PHT60AL trailer coupling is de- Trailer Release
signed for use with trailers having a maximum gross 1. Apply the truck and trailer parking brakes.
weight of 10,000 lbs. See Fig. 10.22. It is a rigid type
pintle hook, used only on truck applications, and is
fastened to the rear closing crossmember of the ve- WARNING
hicle. It is a non-air adjusted coupling.
Do not use the trailer air supply for parking trail-
ers not equipped with spring parking brakes.
1 2 This applies the trailer service brakes only. As air
3 bleeds from the trailer brake system, brake appli-
cation is lost. This could allow the unattended
vehicle to roll away, possibly resulting in serious
personal injury or death.
2. Chock the front and rear tires of the trailer.
3. Disconnect the trailer air and electrical lines.
4 Plug the air lines to keep out dirt.
4. Take the weight of the trailer drawbar off the
pintle hook.
01/20/95 f310314a

1. Lock 3. Latch 5. Open the latch by first removing the cotter pin;
2. Cotter Pin 4. Pintle Hook then lift up the lock and raise the latch.
Fig. 10.22, Holland PH-T-60-AL Trailer Coupling 6. Slowly drive the vehicle away from the trailer.

Operation
Trailer Hookup
1. Chock the front and rear tires of the trailer.
2. Remove the cotter pin, then lift the lock and raise
the latch.
3. Back up the vehicle until the drawbar eye is over
the pintle hook.
4. Lower the trailer until the drawbar eye rests on
the pintle hook.
5. Close the latch, then insert the cotter pin.

NOTICE
Always make sure the connect-hanger/support
keeps the trailer air hoses and electrical cables
positioned so that they do not rub on anything.
Rubbing may wear through hoses or cables, re-
sulting in air leaks, or exposed or broken wires,
potentially affecting trailer brake or electrical sys-
tems.

10.18
11
Pretrip and Post-Trip
Inspections and
Maintenance
Pretrip and Post-Trip Inspection Checklists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.1
Daily Pretrip Inspection and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.3
Weekly Post-Trip Inspection and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.9
Monthly Post-Trip Inspection and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.12
Pretrip and Post-Trip Inspections and Maintenance

Pretrip and Post-Trip Saddle Tank Areas Comp.


3 Frame rails and crossmembers
Inspection Checklists 4 Visible exhaust components
Periodic Inspections and
Engine Compartment Comp.
Maintenance, General Information 1 Leakage under engine
Regulations in Canada and the U.S. clearly indicate 2 Air intake system
that it is the drivers responsibility to perform an in- 3 Engine oil level
spection, and ensure the complete road-worthiness 4 Power steering reservoir level
of a vehicle, before placing it into service. Commer- 5 Engine coolant level
cial vehicles may be subject to inspection by autho- 6 Visible engine wiring
rized inspectors, and an unsafe vehicle can be taken 7 Frame rails
out of service until the driver or owner repairs it.
Use the following checklists to ensure that vehicle Cab Comp.
components are in good working condition before 1
Reset dash-mounted air intake restriction
each trip. Careful inspections eliminate stops later to indicator
fix overlooked or forgotten items. 2 Air-pressure warning systems
The checklists in this chapter can be copied and kept 3 Air governor cut-in and cut-out pressures
as a record that the procedures have been com- 4 Air pressure build-up time
pleted. For details on how to inspect each item on 5 Air system leakage
the checklists, see the corresponding procedure later 6 Air pressure reserve
in this chapter. 7 Mirrors, windows, windshield
8 Horn, windshield wipers, windshield washers
Checklists 9 Heater and defroster
Daily Pretrip Inspection Checklists 10 Interior lights
11 Exterior lights
See the following tables for a list of procedures that 12 Seat belts and tether belts
should be performed daily, before the first trip. Place 13 Fuel level
a check mark in the complete (Comp.) column to 14 Mirror adjustment
indicate a procedure has been performed. 15 Service brakes
16 Backup alarm
Inspector Date

Suspension and Slack Adjusters Comp.


1 Suspension components
2 Slack adjusters

Wheels and Tires Comp.


1 Tire condition
2 Tire inflation
3 Rim and wheel components
4 Wheel bearing oil seals and lubrication levels
6 Mud Flaps

Saddle Tank Areas Comp.


Drain air reservoirs (without automatic drain
1
valves)
2 Fuel tank(s) secure

11.1
Pretrip and Post-Trip Inspections and Maintenance

Weekly Post-trip Inspection Checklist Fluids Added


See the following table for procedures that should be Use the following table to note any fluids that were
performed weekly, post-trip. Place a check mark in added during the inspection and maintenance proce-
the complete (Comp.) column to indicate a proce- dures.
dure has been performed.
Fluids Added During Inspection
Inspector Date Fluid Amount Added
Wheel Bearing Lubricant
Engine Oil
Engine Compartment Comp. Power Steering Fluid
1 Windshield washer reservoir level Engine Coolant
2 Air intake restriction indicator Windshield Washer Fluid
3 Automatic transmission fluid level Automatic Transmission
4 Water in fuel/water separator Fluid
5 Steering components Hydraulic Clutch Fluid (DOT
4 brake fluid)
6 Serpentine drive belts

Monthly Post-trip Inspection Checklists


See the following tables for procedures that should
be performed monthly, post-trip. Place a check mark
in the complete (Comp.) column to indicate a proce-
dure has been performed.

Inspector Date

Brake Components Comp.


1 Brake system components
2 Brake chambers
3 Air brake lines
4 Flex air lines
5 Brake linings and brake drums
6 Brake lining thickness

Saddle Tank Areas Comp.


Drain air reservoirs (with automatic drain
1
valves)
2 Batteries (location may vary)

Engine Compartment Comp.


1 Hydraulic clutch reservoir
2 Radiator and heater hoses
3 Steering wheel play

11.2
Pretrip and Post-Trip Inspections and Maintenance

Daily Pretrip Inspection and


Maintenance 4
5
Complete the following inspection and maintenance
6
procedures to ensure that vehicle components are in
good working condition before each trip. A driver who 7
3
is familiar with the vehicle and drives it regularly can 8
perform the daily inspections, then add the weekly
and monthly post-trip inspections as scheduled. 2 9
If the driver does not operate the vehicle on a con-
sistent basis, all daily, weekly, and monthly inspec- 1
tion and maintenance procedures should be per-
formed before the trip. 10

IMPORTANT: The pre- and post-trip checklists,


inspections, and maintenance procedures de- 06/17/2003 f421398
tailed in this chapter are not all-inclusive. 1. 7/16-inch Adjusting 6. Clevis
Refer to other component and body manufactur- Nut 7. -inch Clevis Pin
ers instructions for specific inspection and 2. Grease Fitting 8. -inch Clevis Pin
maintenance instructions, as well as local, state, 3. Boot 9. Grease Relief
and federal guidelines. 4. Link Opening
5. Brake Chamber Piston 10. Slack Adjuster Spline
NOTE: If any system or component does not Rod
pass this inspection, it must be corrected before Fig. 11.1, Gunite Automatic Slack Adjuster
operating the vehicle. Whenever equipment re-
quires adjustment, replacement, and/or repair, Inspect slack adjuster boots, if equipped,
see the Columbia Workshop Manual for proce- for cuts or tears.
dures and specifications. Inspect anchor straps, if equipped, for
damage.
Suspension and Slack Adjuster
Look for worn clevis pins on brake cham-
Inspection ber pushrods.
Walk around the vehicle and visually inspect suspen- Look for missing or damaged cotter pins
sion and slack adjuster components. on the clevis pins.
1. Inspect the following suspension components for Ensure chamber piston rods are in line
signs of structural damage, cracks, or wear. with the slack adjusters.
springs
spring hangers
Wheel and Tire Inspection
Walk around the vehicle and visually inspect each
shocks
wheel and tire assembly.
suspension arms
1. Inspect tire condition for the following:
suspension brackets
valve stem caps on every tire, screwed on
axle seats finger-tight
bushings bulges, cracks, cuts, and penetrations
2. Inspect slack adjusters for signs of damage. See oil contamination (petroleum derivatives will
Fig. 11.1, Fig. 11.2, or Fig. 11.3. soften the rubber and destroy the tire)

11.3
Pretrip and Post-Trip Inspections and Maintenance

1
2
3
4
3
5

6
7
4 8 9
8
7
6

2
5
10/11/2005 A f421397
A. Rotate the control arm toward the brake chamber
until it can be felt contacting the internal stop.
1. Clevis 6. Control-Arm Washers
2. Slack Adjuster and Nut
3. Clevis Pin 7. Anchor Strap Slot
4. Manual Adjusting Nut 8. Anchor Strap
9
5. Control Arm 9. Brake Chamber
1 10
01/31/2011 f422530
Fig. 11.2, Haldex Automatic Slack Adjuster
1. Grease Fitting (if 5. Clevis Pin (large)
tread depthif tread is less than 4/32 inch equipped) 6. Clevis Pin (small)
2. Slack Adjuster 7. Actuator Rod
(3 mm) on any front tire, or less than 2/32
Housing 8. Boot
inch (1.5 mm) on any rear tire, replace the 3. Brake Chamber 9. Manual Adjusting Nut
tire Pushrod 10. Camshaft Splines
debris lodged between duel tire sets 4. Clevis

2. Check tire inflation. Fig. 11.3, Meritor Automatic Slack Adjuster

For inflation pressures and maximum loads, see tire failure and loss of vehicle control, resulting
the tire manufacturers guidelines. Inflate the tires in serious personal injury or death.
to the applicable pressures if needed.
If a tire has been run flat or under-inflated, check NOTICE
the wheel and tire for damage before adding air.
A weekly pressure loss of 4 psi (28 kPa) or more
Keep compressed air reservoirs and lines dry
in a tire may indicate damage. The tire should be
during tire inflation. Use well-maintained inline
inspected and, if necessary, repaired or replaced
moisture traps and service them regularly.
by a qualified tire service facility.

WARNING IMPORTANT: The load and cold inflation pres-


sure must not exceed the rim or wheel manu-
Do not operate the vehicle with underinflated or facturers recommendations, even though the
overinflated tires. Incorrect inflation can stress tire may be approved for a higher load inflation.
the tires and make the tires and rims more sus- Consult the rim or wheel manufacturer for the
ceptible to damage, possibly leading to rim or

11.4
Pretrip and Post-Trip Inspections and Maintenance

correct tire inflation pressure for the vehicle


load. 1
10 8
3. Examine each rim and wheel component.
3.1 Remove all dirt and debris from the as-
sembly. Rust streaks or metal build-up 3 6
around stud holes, or out-of-round or worn
stud holes, may be caused by loose wheel
nuts.

5 4
WARNING
Have any worn or damaged wheel components
replaced by a qualified person using the wheel 7 9
manufacturers instructions and the wheel indus-
trys standard safety precautions and equipment. 2
Otherwise a vehicle or workshop accident could 04/30/2007 f400268

occur, possibly resulting in serious personal in-


Fig. 11.4, Tightening Pattern, 10-Stud Disc Wheel
jury or death.
3.2 Inspect for broken, cracked, badly worn,
bent, rusty, or sprung rings and rims. 1 2

NOTICE 4
7
Use the recommended torque values and follow
the proper tightening sequence. Insufficient
wheel nut torque can cause wheel shimmy, re-
sulting in wheel damage, stud breakage, and ex-
treme tire tread wear. Excessive wheel nut torque 5 6
can break studs, damage threads, and crack
discs in the stud hole area.
3.3 Make sure all wheel nuts are tightened. If 3 8
tightening is necessary, use the tightening 03/08/2012 f400052a
pattern in Fig. 11.4 or Fig. 11.5 to initially
tighten the flange nuts 50 to 100 lbfft (68 Fig. 11.5, Tightening Pattern, 8-Stud Disc Wheel
to 136 Nm). Then tighten the flange nuts
450 to 500 lbfft (610 to 678 Nm). Saddle Tank Areas Inspection
4. Inspect the outboard side of all wheel hubs and
the hub oil seal area on the inboard side of each WARNING
wheel for signs of oil leakage. If any oil is found
on wheel and tire or brake components, remove When draining the air reservoir, do not look into
the vehicle from service until the leak has been the air jets or direct them toward anyone. Dirt or
fixed. sludge particles may be in the airstream and
could cause injury.
If needed, fill the hubs to the level indicated on
the hub cap. See Group 35 of the Columbia
Maintenance Manual for recommended lubri- NOTICE
cants.
If the water drained from the air reservoirs is
5. Check that mud flaps are undamaged and hang cloudy or oily, it may indicate a problem with the
10 inches (25 cm) or less from the ground. compressor. If oil is allowed to contaminate the

11.5
Pretrip and Post-Trip Inspections and Maintenance

air dryer, it will not remove the water from the air 2.2 Check the air intake duct from the air
brake system, which could adversely affect brak- cleaner to the engine intake. Make sure
ing. the duct components are secure and air-
tight.
1. Drain the brake system air reservoirs (reservoirs
without automatic drain valves only). 3. Check the engine oil level.

WARNING NOTICE
Never operate the engine with the fuel tank shut- Operating the engine with the oil level below the
off valves partially closed. This could damage the minimum fill (or "add") mark or above the maxi-
fuel pump, causing sudden loss of engine power, mum fill (or "full") mark could result in engine
possibly resulting in serious personal injury due damage.
to reduced vehicle control.
3.1 Check the oil level with the vehicle parked
2. Ensure that fuel tanks are secured to their on a level surface. See the engine manu-
mounting brackets and that the mounting facturers guidelines for engine shutdown
brackets are secured to the frame. time requirements prior to checking the oil
If equipped with fuel tank shutoff valves, be sure level.
the valves are fully open. IMPORTANT: On engines that comply with
3. Inspect visible frame rails for missing bolts, shiny EPA07 regulations, use CJ-4 engine oil with
areas, or rust streaks. Check all visible cross- less than 1% sulfated ash. Failure to use
members for damage or signs of looseness. CJ-4 oil may void the warranty on emission
aftertreatment components.
4. Inspect visible components of the exhaust sys-
tem to ensure connections are tight. 3.2 If the oil level is at or below the minimum
Inspect upstream of the aftertreatment device fill (or "add") mark on the dipstick, add
(ATD), if equipped, for cracking or signs of leaks, enough oil to maintain the level between
such as soot trails. Inspect downstream of the the minimum and maximum fill marks. See
ATD for signs of exhaust leaks, such as blister- the engine operation manual for recom-
ing or warping of nearby components. mended lubricants.
4. Check the power steering reservoir fluid level.
Engine Compartment Inspection The power steering fluid level should be between
1. Check the ground underneath the engine for fuel, the MIN COLD mark and the middle mark just
oil, or coolant leaks. above it. See Fig. 11.6. If needed, fill the reser-
voir with automatic transmission fluid that meets
2. Inspect the air intake system for leaks or dam- Dexron III or TES-389 specifications.
age.
NOTICE
NOTICE
Low coolant could result in engine overheating,
Failure to maintain a sealed air intake system which could cause engine damage.
could allow the entry of dirt and contaminants
into the engine. This could adversely affect en- IMPORTANT: The surge tank must be cool to
gine performance and result in engine damage. check the coolant level.
2.1 Push the reset button on the air intake 5. Check the engine coolant level in the radiator
restriction indicator located on the air surge tank. See Fig. 11.7.
cleaner, if equipped.

11.6
Pretrip and Post-Trip Inspections and Maintenance

5.2 If the surge tank was empty, start the en-


gine after refilling and check the level
again when the engine is at operating
temperature.
1 6. Inspect visible engine wiring for damage or
looseness. Check for loose wiring, chafed insula-
tion, and damaged or loose hold-down clamps.
7. Inspect visible frame rails for missing bolts, shiny
areas, or rust streaks.

05/21/2007 f462079 Cab Inspection


NOTE: Typical reservoir shown; configurations may 1. Push the reset button on the dash-mounted air
vary. intake restriction indicator, if equipped.
1. Filler Cap
2. With the ignition switch in the OFF position,
Fig. 11.6, Power Steering Fluid Reservoir check the air-pressure warning system.
2.1 If not previously drained, drain the air res-
2 ervoirs using moderate brake applications
until pressure in both reservoirs is less
than 70 psi (483 kPa).
2.2 Turn the ignition to the ON position. The
3 instrument cluster will complete a full
4 gauge sweep and bulb check, and an au-
dible warning will sound. Ensure the low
air pressure lamp (BRAKE AIR) remains
1 illuminated and an audible warning contin-
ues to sound after the gauge sweep is
4 complete.
3. Check air governor cut-in and cut-out pressures.
06/13/2007 f500390
3.1 Start the engine and ensure the BRAKE
1. Pressure Relief Cap 3. COLD MAX Fill Line AIR lamp goes out and the buzzer si-
2. Filler Cap 4. COLD MIN Fill Line lences when pressure reaches approxi-
Fig. 11.7, Coolant Surge Tank mately 70 psi (483 kPa) in both air reser-
voirs.
The air governor should cut out at ap-
NOTICE proximately 120 psi (827 kPa). For ve-
hicles with an optional dryer reservoir
Coolant must be filled to the COLD MAX line of
module (DRM), the cut-out pressure is
the surge tank. Low coolant could result in en-
approximately 130 psi (896 kPa).
gine overheating, which could cause engine dam-
age. 3.2 With the engine idling, apply the brake
5.1 pedal several times. The air governor
If the coolant is low, fill the surge tank to
should cut in when pressure in the primary
the MAX line with a 50/50 mixture of water
air reservoir (top air gauge) reaches ap-
and the type of antifreeze currently in-
proximately 100 psi (690 kPa).
stalled in the vehicle.
4. Check air pressure build-up time.

11.7
Pretrip and Post-Trip Inspections and Maintenance

4.1 With the air system fully charged, make


one full brake application and note the air WARNING
pressure reading on the primary air
gauge. When cleaning windshields and windows, always
stand on the ground or on a secure ladder or
4.2 Further reduce air pressure using moder- platform. Use a long-handled window cleaner. Do
ate brake applications, then run the en- not use the cab steps, tires, fenders, fuel tanks,
gine at governed rpm. engine, or under-hood components to access the
4.3 Note the time that the pressure reaches windshield or windows. Doing so could cause a
the previously noted reading on the pri- fall and result in an injury.
mary air gauge, then note the time that 7. Inspect the mirrors, window glass, and wind-
the air pressure reaches cut-out pressure. shield for cracks or other damage.
4.4 If it takes longer than 30 seconds to reach 8. Ensure that the horn, windshield wipers, and
cut-out pressure after the primary air windshield washers are operating properly.
gauge passes the previously noted pres- These devices must be in good working order for
sure (noted after one full brake applica- safe vehicle operation.
tion), eliminate any leaks or replace the air
compressor before operating the vehicle. 9. Ensure the heater and defroster are operating
properly.
5. Check air leakage in the system.
10. Check the operation of all interior lights.
5.1 With the parking brake applied, the trans-
mission out of gear, and the air system 10.1 Turn on the headlights and leave them on.
fully charged, release the service brakes Ensure all equipped gauge bulbs illumi-
and shut down the engine. nate in the dash message center.
5.2 Wait one minute and note the air pressure 10.2 Ensure all equipped driver control
drop in psi (kPa) per minute from the pri- switches illuminate.
mary air reservoir. 10.3 Ensure both turn signal indicator bulbs
If the pressure drop exceeds the limits illuminate in the dash message center
shown in Table 11.1, eliminate any leaks when the turn signal switch is activated.
before operating the vehicle. 11. Check the operation of all exterior lights. See
6. Check the air pressure reserve. Fig. 11.8.
With the engine still off, make one full brake ap- 11.1 Activate the high-beam headlights and
plication and observe the pressure drop on the hazard warning lights.
primary air gauge. If pressure drops more than 11.2 Exit the cab and check that all exterior
25 psi (172 kPa), eliminate any leaks before op-
lights and reflectors are clean and intact.
erating the vehicle.
11.3 Check that the brake lights, taillights,
Maximum Allowable Air Leakage headlights, turn signals, marker lights,
Pressure Drop: identification lights, and clearance lights
Description psi (kPa) Per Minute are working properly.
Released Applied 12. Inspect the seat belts and tether belts.
Truck or Tractor Only 2 (14) 3 (21)
Truck or Tractor w/Single Trailer 3 (21) 4 (28) WARNING
Truck or Tractor w/Two Trailers 5 (34) 6 (41)
Table 11.1, Maximum Allowable Air Leakage Inspect and maintain seat belts. When any part of
a seat belt system needs replacement, the entire
seat belt must be replaced, both retractor and
buckle side. Any time a vehicle is involved in an
accident, and the seat belt system was in use,

11.8
Pretrip and Post-Trip Inspections and Maintenance

likely to rupture from impact, possibly causing


2 fire and resulting in serious personal injury or
3
death by burning.
Do not mix gasoline or alcohol with diesel fuel.
This mixture could cause an explosion, possibly
resulting in serious personal injury or death. Do
not fill the fuel tanks in the presence of sparks,
open flames, or intense heat. These could ignite
1 the fuel, possibly causing severe burns.
5

4 IMPORTANT: On engines that comply with


EPA07 regulations, use ultralow-sulfur diesel
(ULSD) with 15 ppm sulfur content or less. Fail-
ure to use ULSD fuel may void the warranty on
emission components.
13. Check the fuel level in the fuel tank(s). To keep
7 7 condensation to a minimum, fuel tanks should be
11/09/1999 6 f000999
filled at the end of each day.
1. Marker Lights 5. Headlights
2. Identification Lights 6. Turn Signals 14. Adjust the rearview and down view mirrors as
3. Clearance Lights 7. Road Lights necessary.
4. Side-Marker Lights 15. Test the service brakes.
Fig. 11.8, Exterior Lights 15.1 With the engine running and air system
the entire vehicle seat belt system must be re- fully charged, set the parking brake.
placed before operating the vehicle. Do not at- 15.2 Put the vehicle in the lowest gear and
tempt to modify the seat belt system; doing so gently attempt to move it forward. The ve-
could change the effectiveness of the system. hicle should not move.
Failure to replace worn or damaged seat belts, or
making any modifications to the system, may re- If the vehicle moves, the parking brakes
sult in personal injury or death. are not operating correctly and must be
repaired before the vehicle is operated.
12.1 Check the web for fraying, cuts, extreme
16. Test the backup alarm.
dirt and dust, or for severe fading from
exposure to sunlight, especially near the 16.1 Release the parking brake and put the
buckle latch plate and in the D-loop guide transmission in reverse.
area.
16.2 Move the vehicle slightly backward to en-
12.2 Check operation of the buckle, latch, Kom- sure that the backup alarm is operating
fort Latch or Sliding Komfort Latch (if correctly.
equipped), web retractor, and upper seat
belt mount on the door pillar. Check all Weekly Post-Trip Inspection
visible components for wear or damage.
12.3 Check the seat belt and tether belt con-
and Maintenance
nection points and tighten any that are Engine Compartment Inspection
loose.

WARNING WARNING
Washer fluids may be flammable and poisonous.
Never fill fuel tanks to more than 95 percent of Do not expose washer fluid to an open flame or
their liquid capacity. This could make them more any burning material, such as a cigarette. Always

11.9
Pretrip and Post-Trip Inspections and Maintenance

comply with the washer fluid manufacturers rec- NOTE: A hose may be used to direct water
ommended safety precautions. into the container. Use a hose with a -inch
1. Check the windshield washer reservoir fluid level. pipe thread on DAVCO models.
2. After resetting the air intake restriction indicator 4.2 If the engine is equipped with a built-in
during the daily pretrip inspection, check the indi- water separator, loosen the drain valve,
cator again with the engine off. and allow the water to run out. Close the
drain valve, taking care not to overtighten
2.1 Check an indicator with graduations to see it.
if air restriction exceeds the value shown
in Table 11.2. 4.3 Alliance/Racor Models: Turn the drain plug
counterclockwise to open it. See Fig. 11.9.
Check a go/no-go indicator without gradu-
ations to see if the colored bar shows DAVCO Models: Remove the vent cap
through the clear window. and open the drain. See Fig. 11.10.

Air Intake Maximum Restriction Values: (inH 2O) 6


5
Pre-EPA07
Engine Make EPA07 Engines
Engines 4
Caterpillar 25 3
Cummins 25 25 7
Detroit 20 22
2
Mercedes-Benz 22 22
Table 11.2, Air Intake Maximum Restriction Values

2.2 If air restriction exceeds the maximum al- 8


lowable value, operate the vehicle for one 1
more day, making sure not to run the en-
9
gine over rated rpm. Refer to the engine
operation manual for more information on
rated rpm for your engine. 10
2.3 If air restriction exceeds the maximum
value again, replace the air cleaner ele- 11
ment. For instructions, refer to Group 09
of the Columbia Workshop Manual. 02/03/2010 f470552
3. If the vehicle is equipped with an Allison auto- 1. Washers (qty 2) 7. Mounting Head
matic transmission, check the automatic trans- 2. Nuts (qty 2) 8. Mounting Bolts (qty 2)
mission fluid level. 3. Frame Rail 9. Filter Element
4. Fuel Outlet Port 10. Sight Bowl
4. Check for water in the fuel/water separator, if 5. Fuel Inlet Port 11. Drain Plug
equipped. 6. Priming Pump
IMPORTANT: When draining fluid from a Fig. 11.9, Alliance Fuel/Water Separator Assembly and
fuel/water separator, drain the fluid into an Installation
appropriate container and dispose of it prop-
erly. Many jurisdictions now issue fines for IMPORTANT: Water in the fuel/water separa-
draining fuel/water separators onto the tor will appear as beads. Drain the fuel/water
ground. separator only enough to remove the water.
Stop draining fluid when fuel begins to drain
4.1 Place a suitable container under the fuel/ out. If the fuel/water separator is drained of
water separator. fuel, it will be necessary to prime the fuel

11.10
Pretrip and Post-Trip Inspections and Maintenance

system before the vehicle can be started


again.
10
4.4 Stop draining fluid when fuel begins to
drain out.
9 Alliance/Racor Models: Turn the drain plug
clockwise to close it.
8 DAVCO Models: Close the drain valve.
Install and hand-tighten the vent cap.
5. Inspect the steering components.
7 5.1 Inspect tie rods, steering arms, and the
drag link for signs of looseness (i.e., shiny
spots or rust tracks). See Fig. 11.11.

4 1

11 2 1
3
12 3

3
2

10/11/2001 f461916

1. Steering Gear Mounting Bolts


2. Pitman Arm Pinch Bolt Nut
3. Drag Link Nut

Fig. 11.11, Integral Steering Gear Fasteners


1 13
05/05/2009 f470530 5.2 Check the steering gear mounting bolts
1. Inlet Port/Check Valve 8. Vent Cap O-Ring and pitman arm nut, if equipped, for signs
2. Lower Housing 9. Vent Cap of looseness.
3. Bypass Valve 10. Collar 5.3 Check the drag link nuts for missing cotter
4. Filter Element 11. 120VAC Pre-Heater
5. Spring 12. 12VDC Pre-Heater pins.
6. Cover O-Ring 13. Drain Valve 5.4 Inspect the steering intermediate shaft and
7. Clear Cover end yokes for excessive looseness or
Fig. 11.10, DAVCO Fuel/Water Separator (Fuel Pro 482 other damage.
shown)

11.11
Pretrip and Post-Trip Inspections and Maintenance

NOTICE Saddle Tank Areas Inspection


Do not drive with a drive belt that is visibly worn WARNING
or damaged. If it fails, the lack of coolant flow
could rapidly cause damage to engine compo- When draining the air reservoir, do not look into
nents. the air jets or direct them toward anyone. Dirt or
sludge particles may be in the airstream and
6. Inspect the serpentine drive belts for signs of could cause injury.
glazing, frayed edges, breaks, cracks, or oil con-
tamination.
NOTICE
Monthly Post-Trip Inspection If the water drained from the air reservoirs is
and Maintenance cloudy or oily, it may indicate a problem with the
compressor. If oil is allowed to contaminate the
Brake Component Inspection air dryer, it will not remove the water from the air
brake system, which could adversely affect brak-
Walk around the vehicle and inspect brake system ing.
components for visible damage.
1. Drain the brake system air reservoirs (reservoirs
1. Inspect all visible brake system components for with automatic drain valves only).
missing fasteners or signs of looseness, such as
rust tracks. NOTE: Battery locations vary between vehicles.
2. Inspect the batteries.
NOTICE
If the external breather tube or breather cap is
WARNING
missing or incorrectly installed, road dirt and de-
Battery posts, terminals, and related accessories
bris can adversely affect the operation of the
contain lead and lead compounds, chemicals
brake chamber. Once inside of the chamber, dirt
known to the State of California to cause cancer
and debris can cause the internal parts of the
and reproductive harm. To prevent possible per-
chamber to deteriorate faster.
sonal injury, always wash your hands after han-
2. Inspect the exterior surfaces of brake chambers dling battery parts and related accessories.
for damage. Make sure that breather holes are 2.1 Remove the battery box cover and inspect
open and free of debris.
all visible battery cables for loose wiring or
NOTE: Do not route air brake lines on top of damage.
anything likely to be stepped on. 2.2 Check that the battery hold-down is se-
3. Inspect air brake lines for dents, swelling, kinks, cure.
twisting, abrasion, and damage, especially near
moving parts. Engine Compartment Inspection and
4. Inspect flex air lines for deterioration or signs of Adjustments
abrasion. 1. Check the hydraulic clutch reservoir, if equipped.
5. Inspect for cracked, worn, or oil-contaminated If necessary, add DOT 4 brake fluid.
brake linings and brake drums (or rotors). 2. Inspect the radiator and heater hoses, including
6. Check the thickness of the brake linings. Re- the clamps and support brackets.
place brake linings on all brake assemblies on 2.1 Inspect the radiator and charge air cooler
the axle if any brake linings are worn to less than for damage and accumulated debris.
approximately 1/4 inch (6.4 mm) at the thinnest Straighten bent or damaged fins to permit
point. airflow across all areas of the cores.

11.12
Pretrip and Post-Trip Inspections and Maintenance

NOTE: When traveling through areas of high


insect concentration, it may be necessary to
clean the exterior of the radiator or the
charge air cooler core as often as every 200
miles (322 km).
2.2 Make sure the radiator inlet and outlet
hoses are pliable and are not cracking or
ballooning.
2.3 Make sure the heater hoses are pliable
and are not cracking or ballooning.
2.4 Tighten hose clamps as necessary.
IMPORTANT: Do not overtighten hose
clamps, as hose life can be adversely af-
fected.
2.5 Ensure hose support brackets are se-
curely fastened. Make sure hoses are not
located near sources of wear, abrasion, or
high heat.
IMPORTANT: When replacing hoses, install
service-type knitted or braided-yarn reinforced
neoprene hose. Extended-service-life silicone
hoses may also be used. See the Alliance Parts
Catalog at www.alliancebrandparts.com or
contact a Freightliner Dealer.
3. Check the steering wheel for excessive play.
3.1 Start the engine. With the front tires
straight ahead, turn the steering wheel
until motion is observed at the front
wheels.
3.2 Align a reference mark on the steering
wheel to a rule, then slowly turn the steer-
ing wheel in the opposite direction until
motion is again detected at the wheels.
3.3 Measure the lash (free play) at the rim of
the steering wheel. Excessive lash exists
if steering wheel movement exceeds 2-1/2
inches (64 mm) with a 20-inch (508-mm)
steering wheel, or 2-1/4 inches (57 mm)
with an 18-inch (457-mm) steering wheel.
3.4 If there is excessive lash, check the steer-
ing system for wear or incorrect adjust-
ment before operating the vehicle.

11.13
12
Cab Appearance
Cab Washing and Polishing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.1
Care of Fiberglass Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.1
Care of Chrome Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.1
Care of Exterior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.1
Dashboard Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.1
Vinyl Upholstery Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.1
Velour Upholstery Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.2
Cab Appearance

Cab Washing and Polishing Care of Chrome Parts


To protect the finish of your new vehicle, follow these To prevent rust, keep chrome parts clean and pro-
guidelines carefully: tected at all times. This is especially important during
winter driving and in coastal areas where there is
During the first 30 days, rinse your vehicle fre-
exposure to salt air.
quently with water. If the vehicle is dirty, use a
mild liquid soap. Do not use detergent. When cleaning chrome parts, use clean water and a
soft cloth or sponge. A mild detergent may also be
During the first 30 days, do not use anything
used.
abrasive on your vehicle. Brushes, chemicals,
and cleaners may scratch the finish. Sponge gently, then rinse. If necessary, use a non-
abrasive chrome cleaner to remove stubborn rust or
During the first 120 days, do not wax your
other material. Do not use steel wool.
vehicle.
To help protect the chrome after cleaning, apply a
To extend the life of your vehicles finish, follow these coat of polishing wax to the surface. Never use wax
guidelines: on parts that are exposed to high heat, such as ex-
Avoid washing your vehicle in the hot sun. haust pipes.
Always use water. After the cab is completely
washed, dry it with a towel or chamois. Care of Exterior Lights
Do not dust painted surfaces with a dry cloth, Clean the headlight lenses by hand only, using a
as this will scratch the paint. flannel cloth with mild, non-caustic soap or detergent,
and water.
Do not remove ice or snow from a painted sur-
face with a scraper of any sort.
CAUTION
To prevent damage to the finish, wax it regu-
larly. Before waxing, if the finish has become Do not use a power buffer, paper towels, chemi-
dull, remove oxidized paint using a cleaner cal solvents, or abrasive cleaners on the head-
specifically designed for this purpose. Remove light lens, all of which can remove the UV coating
all road tar and tree sap before waxing. from the surface, and result in yellowing of the
Freightliner recommends that a quality brand of lens.
cleaner or cleaner-polish and polishing wax be
used.
Dashboard Care
Do not let diesel fuel or antifreeze stand on a
painted surface. If either should occur, rinse Periodically wipe the dashboard with a water-
the surface off with water. dampened cloth. A mild detergent can be used, but
avoid using strong detergents.
To prevent rust, have any nicks or other dam-
age on the finish touched up as soon as pos-
sible.
CAUTION
Park your vehicle in a sheltered area whenever Do not use Armor-All Protectant, STP Son-of-a-
possible. Gun, or other equivalent treatments. These
cleaners contain vinyl plasticizers that can cause
stress crazing in the interior plastic panels,
Care of Fiberglass Parts which can result in cracking of the panels.
Wash unpainted fiberglass air fairings and shields
monthly with a mild detergent, such as dishwashing Vinyl Upholstery Cleaning
liquid. Avoid strong alkaline cleansers.
To prevent soiling, frequent vacuuming or light brush-
Apply a wax specifically designed for fiberglass. ing to remove dust and dirt is recommended. Harsh
cleaning agents can cause permanent damage to

12.1
Cab Appearance

vinyl upholstery. To preserve the upholstery and pre- drogen peroxide onto the cloth. Allow the saturated
vent damage, carefully review the following sections cloth to remain on the spot for 30 to 60 minutes. For
for recommended cleaning procedures. Waxing or stubborn spots, allow the hydrogen-peroxide satu-
refinishing improves soil resistance and cleanability rated cloth to remain on the area overnight. Use cau-
for all vinyls. Any hard wax, such as that used on tion to prevent the solution from seeping into the
automobiles, may be used. seams, or it will weaken the cotton thread.

Ordinary Dirt Nail Polish and Nail Polish Remover


Wash the upholstery with warm water and mild soap, Prolonged contact with these substances causes per-
such as saddle or oil soap. Apply soapy water to a manent damage to vinyl. Careful blotting immediately
large area and allow to soak for a few minutes, then after contact minimizes damage. Do not spread the
rub briskly with a cloth to remove the dirt. This can liquid during removal.
be repeated several times, as necessary.
If dirt is deeply imbedded, use a soft bristle brush Shoe Polish
after applying the soap. Most shoe polishes contain dyes which penetrate
If dirt is extremely difficult to remove, wall-washing vinyl and stain it permanently. Shoe polish should be
preparations normally found around the home can be wiped off as quickly as possible using naphtha or
used. Powdered cleaners, such as those used for lighter fluid. If staining occurs, try the procedure used
sinks and tiles, are abrasive and must be used with for sulfide stains.
caution as they can scratch the vinyl or give it a per-
manent dull appearance. Ball Point Ink
Ball point ink can sometimes be removed if rubbed
Chewing Gum immediately with a damp cloth, using water or rub-
Harden the gum with an ice cube wrapped in a plas- bing alcohol. If this does not work, try the procedure
tic bag, then scrape it off with a dull knife. Any re- used for sulfide stains.
maining traces of gum can be removed with an all-
purpose light oil (peanut butter will also work) and Miscellaneous
wiped off.
If stains do not respond to any of the treatments de-
scribed above, it is sometimes helpful to expose the
Tars, Asphalts, and Creosote vinyl to direct sunlight for up to 30 hours. Mustard,
Each of these items stains vinyl after prolonged con- ball point ink, certain shoe polishes, and dyes often
tact. They should be wiped off immediately and the bleach out in direct sunlight, leaving the vinyl undam-
area carefully cleaned, using a cloth dampened with aged.
naphtha.
Velour Upholstery Cleaning
Paint, Shoe Heel Marks
To prevent soiling, frequent vacuuming or light brush-
Paint should be removed immediately. Do not use ing to remove dust and dirt is recommended. Spot
paint remover or liquid-type brush cleaner on vinyl. clean with a mild solvent or an upholstery shampoo,
An unprinted cloth, dampened with naphtha or tur- or the foam from a mild detergent. When using a sol-
pentine may be used. Use care to prevent contact vent or a dry-cleaning product, follow the instructions
with parts of the upholstery that are not vinyl. carefully, and clean only in a well-ventilated area.
Avoid any product that contains carbon tetrachloride
Sulfide Stains or other toxic materials. With either method, pretest a
small area before proceeding. Use a professional
Sulfide compounds, such as those found in eggs and
upholstery cleaning service when extensive cleaning
some canned goods, can stain after prolonged con-
is needed.
tact with vinyl. These stains can be removed by plac-
ing a clean, unprinted piece of cloth over the spotted
area and pouring a liberal amount of 6 percent hy-

12.2
Cab Appearance

Grease and Oil-Based Stains


Dampen a small absorbent cloth with dry-cleaning
solvent or spot remover. Apply the cloth carefully to
the spot from the outer edge to the center. Pat and
blot the spot with a clean, dry cloth. Repeat several
times, as necessary, turning the cloths so that the
stain does not redeposit on the fabric.

Sugar and Water-Based Stains


Apply water-based detergent or cleaner, working in
circular motions. Pat and blot as dry as possible. Re-
peat, if necessary, before drying thoroughly.

Chewing Gum or Wax


Harden the gum or wax with an ice cube wrapped in
a plastic bag, then scrape it off with a dull knife. Ex-
cess wax can be absorbed by placing a thick white
blotter over the wax and heating with a warm (not
hot) iron. Remove the remainder by using the proce-
dure for grease and oil-based stains.

Mildew
Brush the dry fabric with a soft brush. Sponge with
detergent, and blot. If the fabric is colorfast, dilute a
teaspoon of bleach in one quart (one liter) of cool
water. Apply with a swab, directly on the mildew
stain. Dab repeatedly with clear, cool water, and blot
dry.

12.3
13
In an Emergency
Hazard Warning Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.1
Fire Extinguisher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.1
Emergency Kit, Optional . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.1
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.1
Emergency Starting with Jumper Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3
Fire in the Cab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.4
In an Emergency

Hazard Warning Lights WARNING


The hazard warning light switch tab is located on the
turn signal control lever. See Fig. 13.1.To operate the Use extreme care when placing flares in emer-
hazard lights, pull the tab out. All of the turn signal gency situations that involve exposure to flam-
lights and both of the indicator lights on the control mable substances such as fuel. An explosion or
panel will flash. fire could occur causing serious personal injury.

Towing
When it is necessary to tow the vehicle, make sure
the instructions below are closely followed to prevent
damage to the vehicle.

WARNING
Do not tow an unbraked vehicle if the combined
weight of both vehicles is more than the sum of
the gross axle weight ratings (GAWR) of the tow-
ing vehicle. Otherwise brake capacity will be in-
9/26/95 f541098
adequate, which could result in personal injury or
Fig. 13.1, Hazard Warning Light Switch Tab (left-hand
death.
drive shown)
CAUTION
To cancel the hazard warning lights, push the turn
signal control lever either up or down, then return the If the vehicle is equipped with the AirLiner front
lever to its neutral position. suspension or the Hendrickson STEERTEK axle,
it is required that tow straps be used when tow-
Fire Extinguisher ing the vehicle. A tow strap should be connected
to the tow hooks, if equipped, or wrapped around
A fire extinguisher is located in the cab by the driv- the front axle. Using a tow chain around the front
ers door. axle will damage the axle.

Emergency Kit, Optional Front Towing Hookup


An optional emergency kit package is located be- 1. Disconnect the battery ground cables.
tween the seats, at the front of the center console, if
the vehicle does not have a sleeper compartment. If CAUTION
there is a sleeper compartment, the emergency kit is
located elsewhere, depending on vehicle configura- Failure to remove the axle shafts when towing
tion. The package includes one or more of each of the vehicle with the rear wheels on the ground
the following: first aid kit, a reflective vest, and a tri- could result in damage to the transmission and
angular reflector and flare kit. other parts.
If there is an emergency while driving, cautiously pull 2. Remove both drive axle shafts. On dual drive
off the road, paying attention to other traffic. Turn on axles, if the vehicle is to be lifted and towed, re-
the hazard warning lights. Place the flares and reflec- move only the rearmost drive axle shafts.
tor along the side of the road, to alert other drivers
On vehicles equipped with an air fairing, remove
that an emergency situation exists.
both the forward and rearmost drive axle shafts if
there is insufficient towing clearance.

13.1
In an Emergency

3. Cover the ends of the hubs with metal plates or 10. On vehicles equipped with an air fairing, repeat
plywood cut to fit the axle opening, and drilled to the measurement taken in step 8. The difference
fit the axle shaft studs. This prevents lubricant between the two measurements must not exceed
from leaking out, and will keep contaminants 14 inches (36 cm). If necessary, lower the ve-
from getting into and damaging the wheel bear- hicle.
ings and axle lubricant.
11. Connect the clearance lights, taillights, and sig-
nal lights. Connect any special towing lights re-
CAUTION quired by local regulations.
Failure to protect the frame rails from the chains
could cause damage, leading to eventual frame WARNING
failure.
Failure to chock the tires or connect the tow
4. On dual drive axles, if the vehicle is to be lifted trucks air brake system before releasing the
and towed, chain the forward rear-axle assembly spring parking brakes could allow the disabled
to the vehicle frame. Use protection to keep the vehicle to suddenly roll. This could cause prop-
chains from damaging the frame. erty damage or personal injury.
5. Remove the bumper extension and chrome 12. Chock the disabled vehicles tires, and connect
bumper, if so equipped. Remove the bumper fair- the towing vehicles air brake system to the ve-
ing, if so equipped. hicle being towed. Then, release the spring park-
ing brakes and remove the chocks.
6. On vehicles equipped with an air fairing, adjust
the trim tab to the lowest position.
Rear Towing Hookup
CAUTION CAUTION
Do not pass a sling (for example, a rope or chain)
from one tow hook to another to fasten for tow- Using a rear towing hookup on a vehicle
ing (see Fig. 13.2). Known as reeving, this prac- equipped with a cab-mounted aerodynamic de-
tice is not permissible in most industrial applica- vice could cause damage to the cab structure
tions of towing and hoisting. Reeving can because of the possibility of excessive wind
overload the hooks and result in damage to the force.
vehicle. 1. Place the front tires straight forward, and secure
7. Attach the towing device. Due to the many vari- the steering wheel in this position.
ables that exist in towing, positioning the lifting 2. Disconnect the battery ground cables.
and towing device is the sole responsibility of the
towing-vehicle operator.
CAUTION
8. On vehicles equipped with an air fairing, mea-
sure the distance from the ground to the bumper, Failure to protect the frame rails from the chains
or from the ground to a frame bracket. could cause damage, leading to eventual frame
failure.
9. Lift the vehicle, and secure the safety chains. If
extra towing clearance is needed, remove the 3. On dual drive axles, using protection to keep the
front wheels. chains from damaging the vehicle frame, chain
the forward-rear drive axle to the frame.
WARNING 4. Attach the towing device. Due to the many vari-
ables that exist in towing, positioning the lifting
Failure to lower the vehicle could result in the air and towing device is the sole responsibility of the
fairing striking an overhead obstruction, such as towing-vehicle operator.
a bridge or overpass, and causing vehicle dam-
age or personal injury.

13.2
In an Emergency

OK

2 1

1
OK
01/11/2006 f880694

IMPORTANT: Do not reeve when towing.


1. Tow Hook 2. Chain
Fig. 13.2, Reeving

5. Lift the vehicle, and secure the safety chains. If NOTE: On vehicles equipped with an optional
extra clearance is needed, remove the bumper jump-start post, attach the positive cable clamp
extension, if equipped. to that post instead of to the battery.
6. Connect the clearance lights, taillights, and sig- 1. Apply the parking brakes and turn off the lights
nal lights. Also connect any special towing lights and all other electrical loads.
required by local regulations.
2. Connect an end of one jumper cable to the posi-
tive terminal of the booster battery (or jump-start
Emergency Starting with post, if equipped), and connect the other end of
Jumper Cables the cable to the positive terminal of the dis-
charged battery (or jump-start post, if equipped).
When using jumper cables, follow the instructions See Fig. 13.3.
below.
WARNING
WARNING
Do the next step exactly as instructed and do not
Batteries release explosive gas. Do not smoke allow the clamps of one cable to touch the
when working around batteries. Put out all flames clamps of the other cable. Otherwise, a spark
and remove all sources of sparks or intense heat could occur near a battery, possibly resulting in
in the vicinity of the battery. Do not allow the ve- severe personal injury from explosion or acid
hicles to touch each other. Do not lean over the burns.
batteries when making connections, and keep all
other persons away from the batteries. Failure to 3. Connect one end of the second jumper cable to
follow these precautions could lead to severe the negative terminal of the booster battery, and
personal injury as a result of an explosion or connect the other end of the cable to a ground at
acid burns.

13.3
In an Emergency

C Fire in the Cab


A The incidence of fire in heavy- and medium-duty
B D trucks is rare, according to data from the National
+ +
Highway Traffic Safety Administration. Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standard #302 limits the flammability
E of specified materials used inside the cab, but de-
G
+ + spite this, most materials will burn. The cab of this
E vehicle contains urethane foam, which is flammable.
+ +

F
WARNING
A
1 2 Urethane foam is flammable! Do not allow any
10/18/94 f540027b flames, sparks, or other heat sources such as
A. To Ground E. To Starter cigarettes or light bulbs to contact urethane
B. Connect 3rd F. Connect 2nd foam. Urethane foam in contact with such heat
C. To Frame (ground) G. Connect 1st sources could cause a serious, rapid fire, which
D. Connect Last could result in death, severe burns, or gas poi-
1. Booster Battery 2. Discharged Battery soning, as well as damage to the vehicle.
Fig. 13.3, Jumper Connections
In Case of a Cab Fire
least 12 inches (300 mm) away from the batter- As quickly as possible, bring the vehicle to a safe
ies of the vehicle needing the start. The vehicle stop, apply the parking brake, turn off the ignition,
frame is usually a good ground. Do not connect and get out of the vehicle.
the cable to or near the discharged batteries.
4. Start the engine of the vehicle with the booster
batteries, and let the engine run a few minutes to
charge the batteries of the other vehicle.
5. Attempt to start the engine of the vehicle with the
batteries receiving the charge. Do not operate
the starter longer than 30 seconds, and wait at
least two minutes between starting attempts to
allow the starter to cool.
6. When the engine starts, let it idle a few minutes.

WARNING
Do the next step exactly as instructed and do not
allow the clamps of one cable to touch the
clamps of the other cable. Otherwise, a spark
could occur near a battery, possibly resulting in
severe personal injury from explosion or acid
burns.
7. Disconnect the grounded cable from the frame or
other non-battery location, then disconnect the
other end of the cable.
8. Disconnect the remaining cable from the newly
charged battery (or jump-start post, if equipped)
first, then disconnect the other end.

13.4
14
Headlight Aiming
Preliminary Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.1
Checking Headlight Aim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.1
Adjusting Headlight Aim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2
Headlight Aiming

Preliminary Checks Checking Headlight Aim


Before checking or adjusting the headlight aim, com- 1. Park the vehicle on a level surface, 25 ft (7.6 m)
plete the following inspection: away from, and perpendicular to, a vertical
screen or wall. Shut down the engine and set the
Remove any large amounts of mud or ice from
parking brake. Chock the tires.
the underside of the fenders.
2. Each headlight has a small, clear height adjust-
Check the springs for sagging or broken
ing dot. Measure the distance from the ground to
leaves. the center of each height adjusting dot.
Check the suspension for proper functioning of (Fig. 14.1, Item A). Note those distances.
the leveling mechanism. If the vehicle is 3. Mark the vertical distances found in step 2 on
equipped with an air suspension, make sure
the screen or wall, directly in front of the head-
that the height is properly adjusted.
lights. These marks represent the desired loca-
With the vehicle unloaded, check that the tires tions of each headlight bulb center in the follow-
are inflated to the recommended air pressure. ing steps. See Fig. 14.1, Items 2 and 3.
Clean the headlight lenses. Use a soft cloth 4. Turn on the low-beam headlights.
with mild, non-caustic soap or detergent, and 5. Identify the center of each beam projection by
water.
marking the area of brightest intensity on the
wall. The area of brightest intensity should fall on
or very near the marks made during step 3. See
Fig. 14.2.

2
3

A
A

B
B

7.6 m)
25 ft (
1
08/01/2012 f545850e
A. Measure the distance from the ground to the center of each headlight bulb.
B. Mark where the center of each headlight projection should appear.
1. Screen or Wall 3. Center of Left-Hand Headlight Projection
2. Center of Right-Hand Headlight Projection

Fig. 14.1, Headlight Aiming Screen/Wall

14.1
Headlight Aiming

1
2

08/01/2012 f545851e
A. Park the vehicle on a level surface 25 ft (7.6 m) away from a vertical screen or wall
1. Low-Beam Angle Upper Limit 3. Low-Beam Angle Lower Limit
2. Ideal Low-Beam Projection
Fig. 14.2, Vertical Low-Beam Headlight Variation Limits

6. Use Table 14.1 to determine the maximum verti-


cal distance allowable between the marks made 1 2
in step 3 and the marks made in step 5. If the
vertical distance between the marks made in
steps 3 and 5 is greater than the maximum dis-
tance given in Table 14.1, adjust the vertical po-
sitioning of that headlight.

Adjusting Headlight Aim


NOTE: Freightliner vehicles are offered with
various headlight assembly options. Because of
the various options, the location of adjustment 04/12/2000 f543079
screws on your vehicles headlight assembly NOTE: The right-hand side headlight bucket is shown.
may vary from what is shown here. The left-hand side is opposite.
1. Horizontal (inboard) Adjusting Knob
1. Lift the flap over the rear end of the headlight 2. Vertical (outboard) Adjusting Knob
bucket to expose the two plastic adjusting knobs.
See Fig. 14.3. Fig. 14.3, Headlight Adjusting Knobs
2. If necessary, adjust the horizontal positioning of
the headlights so that each projection points di-
rectly forward.
3. Turn the vertical adjustment knob to adjust the
headlight beam to meet the desired height. See
Table 14.1. Turn the knob clockwise to raise the
beam; turn the knob counterclockwise to lower it.
4. Adjust the other headlight.

14.2
Headlight Aiming

Vertical Low-Beam Headlight Variation Limits


Distance Between Ground Desired Variation (Fig. 14.3, Upper Limit (Fig. 14.3, Item Lower Limit (Fig. 14.3, Item
and Headlight: in (mm) Item 2): in (mm) 1): in (mm) up 3): in (mm) down
2236 (560900) 0 3.9 (100) 3.9 (100)
3648 (9001200) 2 (50) down 2 (50) 6 (150)
4854 (12001400) 2.5 (64) down 1.6 (40) 6.5 (165)
Table 14.1, Vertical Low-Beam Headlight Variation Limits

14.3
Index

Subject Page Subject Page


A Cab-to-Sleeper Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3
Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety
Adjusting Headlight Aim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2 Standard (CMVSS) Labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
Air Bag, Optional . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.8 Care of Chrome Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.1
Air Bag Safety Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.8 Care of Exterior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.1
Air Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.5 Care of Fiberglass Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.1
ASF Simplex Series Fifth Checking Headlight Aim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.1
Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.6 Circuit Breaker/Relay Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3
Fifth Wheel Locking and Clutches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.20
Unlocking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.8 Clutch Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.22
Fifth Wheel Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.11 Clutch Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.20
Fifth Wheel Slide Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.10 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.20
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.6 Cold-Weather OperationCAT,
Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.13
B Caterpillar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.13
Cummins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.14
Back-of-Cab Grab Handles, DDE S60 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.14
Steps, and Deck Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.4
Mercedes-Benz . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.15
Climbing Down from Back-
of-Cab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 Constant Discharge
Temperature Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1
Entering Back-of-Cab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5
Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.21
Baggage Compartment Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.4
Axle Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.21
Battery Box Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5
Brake Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.22
Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.22
Automatic Slack Adjusters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6
Engine Fan Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.23
Brake System Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.2
Ignition Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.23
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1
Lighting Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.24
Meritor WABCO Electronic
Braking System (EBS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.5 PTO Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.27
Meritor WABCO Antilock Steering Column Tilt/
Braking System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.4 Telescope Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.27
Suspension/Trailer
Connection Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.27
C Windshield Wiper/Washer
Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.28
Cab Amenities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6
Ash Tray and Cigar Lighter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6
Cup Holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6 D
Dash Storage Bin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6 Daily Pretrip Inspection and
Footwell Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.7 Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.3
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6 Cab Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.7
Map Holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6 Engine Compartment
Overhead Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6 Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.6
Waste Bin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6 Saddle Tank Areas
Cab Climate Control Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1 Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.5
Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2 Suspension and Slack
Air Selection Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1 Adjuster Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.3
Bunk Override Switch, Wheel and Tire Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.3
Optional . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3 Dana Spicer Axles with
Fan Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1 Controlled Traction Differential . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.2
Recirculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3 Dana Spicer Interaxle
Differential Lockout Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.3
Temperature Control Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2
Dashboard Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.1
Cab Door Locks and Handles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1
DD15 Heavy-Duty Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.3
Cab Washing and Polishing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.1

I-1
Index

Subject Page Subject Page


DDEC VI Driving Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.4 Turbo Brake (MBE4000 only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.18
Engine Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.3 Engine Break-InCAT,
Door Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3 Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.10
Driver Message Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.7 Caterpillar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.10
ICU3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.7 Cummins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.10
ICU4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.8 Detroit Diesel S60 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.10
ICU4M . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.10 Mercedes-Benz . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.10
Engine OperationCAT,
Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.10
E General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.11
Eaton Fuller AutoShift Safety and Environmental
Automated Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.1 Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.10
General Information, Engine ShutdownCAT,
AutoShift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.1 Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.15
Operation, AutoShift with Caterpillar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.15
SmartShift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.2 Detroit Diesel S60 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.16
Eaton Fuller Deep-Reduction Mercedes-Benz . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.16
Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.11 Engine StartingCAT,
General Information, Deep Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.6
Reduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.11 Cold-Weather Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.8
Operation, Deep Reduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.12 Normal Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.6
Eaton Fuller Range-Shift EPA Emission Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.6 EPA07 Exhaust Emissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
General Information, Eaton Vehicle Noise Emission
Fuller Range-Shift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.6 Control Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
Operation, Eaton Fuller EPA07 Aftertreatment System
Range-Shift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.7 (ATS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.1
Eaton Fuller Splitter and Exhaust Brake SystemCAT,
Range-Shift Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.8 Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.19
General Information, Eaton General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.19
Fuller Splitter and Range-
Shift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.8
Operation, Eaton Fuller
Splitter and Range-Shift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.9
F
Eaton Fuller Super 10, Top 2, Federal Motor Vehicle Safety
and Lightning Semi- Standard (FMVSS) Labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1
Automated Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.14 Fire Extinguisher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.1
General Information, Super Fire in the Cab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.4
10/Top 2/Lightning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.14 In Case of a Cab Fire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.4
Operation, Super 10/Top Fontaine Fifth Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.11
2/Lightning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.15 Fifth Wheel Locking
Eaton UltraShift DM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.23 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.12
General Information, Fifth Wheel Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.16
UltraShift DM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.23 Fifth Wheel Slide Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.14
Operation, UltraShift DM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.23 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.11
Ultrashift Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.28 Freightliner SmartShift Shift
Emergency Kit, Optional . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.1 Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.1
Emergency Starting with General Information,
Jumper Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3 SmartShift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.1
Engine Braking SystemsCAT,
Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.16
BrakeSaver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.18 G
Constant-Throttle Engine Grab Handles and Access
Brake (MBE4000 only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.19 Steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1
Jacobs Engine Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.16 Entering the Drivers Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2

I-2
Index

Subject Page Subject Page


Entering the Passengers
Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2
M
Exiting the Drivers Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 Meritor Engine Synchro Shift
Exiting the Passengers Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3 (ESS) Automated Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.20
General Information, ESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.20
Operation, ESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.21
H Meritor Range-Shift
Hazard Warning Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.1 Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.17
High-Altitude OperationCAT, General Information, Meritor
Cummins, DDE S60, M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.15 Range-Shift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.17
Holland Fifth Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.1 Operation, Meritor Range-
Shift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.17
Fifth Wheel Locking
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.2 Meritor Splitter and Range-Shift
Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.19
Fifth Wheel Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.6
General Information, Meritor
Fifth Wheel Slide Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.4 Splitter and Range-Shift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.19
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.1 Operation, Meritor Splitter
Holland Trailer Coupling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.18 and Range-Shift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.19
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.18 Meritor Drive Axles with Main
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.18 Differential Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.1
Hood Tilting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 Meritor Interaxle Differential
To Return the Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 Lockout Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.2
To Tilt the Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5 Meritor Main Differential Lock
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.1
Meritor Single Drive Axles with
I Traction Equalizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.1
Ignition and Lock Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1 Meritor Tandem Drive Axles
with Interaxle Differential . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.2
Instrumentation Control Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.1
Monthly Post-Trip Inspection
Ignition Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.1 and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.12
Instruments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.17 Brake Component Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.12
Air Intake Restriction Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.17 Engine Compartment
Application Air Pressure Inspection and
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.18 Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.12
Coolant Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.19 Saddle Tank Areas
Drive Axle Oil Temperature Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.12
Gauges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.19
Engine Oil Pressure Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.19
Engine Oil Temperature
P
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.20 Parked HVAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4
Fuel Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.20 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4
Primary and Secondary Air Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4
Pressure Gauges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.20 Preliminary Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.1
Pyrometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.20 Premier Trailer Couplings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.16
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.20 General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.16
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.20 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.16
Transmission Fluid Pretrip and Post-Trip Inspection
Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.20 Checklists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.1
Turbocharger Boost Checklists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.1
Pressure Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.21
Fluids Added . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.2
Voltmeter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.21
Periodic Inspections and
Maintenance, General
Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.1

I-3
Index

Subject Page Subject Page


R V
Roll Stability Advisor and Vehicle Specification Decal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1
Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.28 Velour Upholstery Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.2
Hard-Braking Advisor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.29 Chewing Gum or Wax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.3
Roll Stability Advisor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.28 Grease and Oil-Based Stains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.3
Roll Stability Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.29 Mildew . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.3
Trip/Leg Totals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.30 Sugar and Water-Based
Stains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.3
S Vinyl Upholstery Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.1
Ball Point Ink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.2
Seat Belts and Tether Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 Chewing Gum . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.2
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 Miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.2
Seat Belt Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.5 Nail Polish and Nail Polish
Seat Belt Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.5 Remover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.2
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1 Ordinary Dirt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.2
EzyRider Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2 Paint, Shoe Heel Marks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.2
Freightliner/Bostrom Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3 Shoe Polish . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.2
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1 Sulfide Stains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.2
National 2000 Series Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 Tars, Asphalts, and Creosote . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.2
Sleeper Bunk Latches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3
Sleeper Climate Control Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3
Fan Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3
W
Temperature Control Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3 Warning and Indicator Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3
Sleeper Compartment Engine Protection System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3
Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7 Weekly Post-Trip Inspection
Bunk Restraint Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7 and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.9
Bunk Restraint Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7 Engine Compartment
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7 Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.9
Sleeper Compartment Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3 Windshield Washer Reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.7
Sleeper Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3
SPACE System, Optional . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.9 Z
Safety Guidelines for the
SPACE System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.10 ZF-FreedomLine Automated
Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.4
Starting After Extended
Shutdown or Oil Change General Information,
CAT, Cummins, DDE S60, FreedomLine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.4
M-B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.9 Operation, FreedomLine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.5
Steering System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1
Power Steering System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1
Supplemental Restraint System,
Optional . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.8

T
Tire and Rim Labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.1
Front Towing Hookup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.1
Rear Towing Hookup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.2

I-4

You might also like